FORM 10-K
Table of Contents

 
 
UNITED STATES SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549
 
Form 10-K
 
     
þ   ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2008
or
     
o   TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
For the transition period from                to
Commission File No. 001-16427
 
Fidelity National Information Services, Inc.
(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)
     
Georgia
(State or other jurisdiction
of incorporation or organization)
  37-1490331
(I.R.S. Employer
Identification No.)
     
601 Riverside Avenue
Jacksonville, Florida

(Address of principal executive offices)
  32204
(Zip Code)
(904) 854-5000
(Registrant’s telephone number, including area code)
Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:
     
Title of each class:   Name of each exchange on which registered:
     
Common Stock, par value $0.01 per share   New York Stock Exchange
Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act: None
(Title of Class)
     Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act. Yes þ No o
     Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act. Yes o No þ
     Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days. Yes þ No o
     Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K. o
     Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act. (Check one):
             
Large accelerated filer þ    Accelerated filer o    Non-accelerated filer   o
(Do not check if a smaller reporting company)
  Smaller reporting company o 
     Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act) Yes o No þ
     As of June 30, 2008, the last business day of the registrant’s most recently completed second fiscal quarter, the aggregate market value of the registrant’s common stock held by nonaffiliates was $6,785,962,978 based on the closing sale price of $36.91 on that date as reported by the New York Stock Exchange. For the purposes of the foregoing sentence only, all directors and executive officers of the registrant were assumed to be affiliates. The number of shares outstanding of the registrant’s common stock, $0.01 par value per share, was 190,920,746 as of January 31, 2009.
     The information in Part III hereof is incorporated herein by reference to the registrant’s Proxy Statement on Schedule 14A for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2008, to be filed within 120 days after the close of the fiscal year that is the subject of this Report.
 
 

 


 

FIDELITY NATIONAL INFORMATION SERVICES, INC.
2008 FORM 10-K ANNUAL REPORT
TABLE OF CONTENTS
         
    Page  
       
    3  
    8  
    14  
    14  
    15  
    15  
 
       
       
    15  
    17  
    18  
    29  
    31  
    68  
    68  
    68  
 
       
       
    68  
    68  
    68  
    68  
    68  
 
       
       
    68  
    73  
 EX-10.50
 EX-10.51
 EX-10.57
 EX-10.58
 EX-10.59
 EX-21.1
 EX-23.1
 EX-31.1
 EX-31.2
 EX-32.1
 EX-32.2

2


Table of Contents

     Unless stated otherwise or the context otherwise requires all references to “FIS,” “we”, the “Company” or the “registrant” are to Fidelity National Information Services, Inc., a Georgia corporation formerly known as Certegy Inc. (“Certegy”), which was the surviving legal entity in the Certegy Merger; all references to “eFunds” are to eFunds Corporation, and its subsidiaries, as acquired by FIS on September 12, 2007; all references to “Old FNF” are to Fidelity National Financial, Inc., which owned a majority of the Company’s shares through November 9, 2006; all references to “FNF” are to Fidelity National Financial, Inc. (formerly known as Fidelity National Title Group, Inc. (“FNT”)), formerly a subsidiary of Old FNF but now an independent company that remains a related entity from an accounting perspective; and all references to “LPS” are to Lender Processing Services, Inc., a former wholly owned subsidiary of FIS, which was spun-off as a separate publicly traded company on July 2, 2008.
PART I
Item 1. Business.
General Development of the Business
     Our business operations and organizational structure result from the February 1, 2006, business combination of FIS and Certegy (the “Certegy Merger”), pursuant to which FIS was merged into a wholly-owned subsidiary of Certegy. Immediately after the Certegy Merger, the stockholders of FIS, including its then-majority stockholder Old FNF, owned approximately 67.4% of the Company’s outstanding common stock. Accordingly, for accounting and financial reporting purposes, the Certegy Merger was treated as a reverse acquisition of Certegy by FIS using the purchase method of accounting pursuant to U.S. generally accepted accounting principles. Under this accounting treatment, although Certegy was the legal entity that survived the merger, FIS was viewed as the acquirer for accounting purposes, and our financial statements and other disclosures for periods prior to the Certegy Merger treat FIS as our predecessor company. Also, as a result of the Certegy Merger, the registrant’s name changed from “Certegy Inc.” to “Fidelity National Information Services, Inc.” and our New York Stock Exchange trading symbol from “CEY” to “FIS”. On November 9, 2006, Old FNF (after other transactions in which it distributed all of its assets other than its ownership in FIS) merged with and into FIS (the “FNF Merger”). Upon completion of the FNF Merger, FIS became an independent publicly traded company, and Old FNF ceased to exist as an independent publicly traded company. The assets distributed by Old FNF prior to the FNF Merger included its ownership in FNT, which following the FNF Merger renamed itself Fidelity National Financial, Inc.
     We are incorporated under the laws of the State of Georgia, where Certegy was initially incorporated on March 2, 2001. Although many of these acquisitions added important applications and services to the offerings of FIS, our long-term objectives have been driven primarily by internal growth and the following acquisitions:
    The financial services division of ALLTEL Information Services, Inc., a provider of core banking services;
 
    Aurum Technology, a provider of software and outsourcing solutions to community banks and credit unions;
 
    Kordoba, a provider of information technology solutions for the financial services industry with a focus on services and solutions for the German banking market;
 
    Sanchez Computer Associates, Inc., a provider of software and outsourcing solutions to banks and other financial institutions;
 
    InterCept, Inc., a provider of outsourced and in-house core banking solutions, as well as item processing and check imaging services;
 
    Certegy, a provider of card issuer services to financial institutions and check risk management services in the U.S. and internationally; and
 
    eFunds Corporation, a provider of risk management services, EFT services, prepaid/gift card processing, and global outsourcing solutions to financial services companies in the U.S. and internationally.
Financial Information About Operating Segments and Geographic Areas
     On July 2, 2008, we completed the spin-off of our former lender processing services segment into a separate publicly traded company, Lender Processing Services, Inc., referred to as LPS. The results of operations of the lender processing services segment are reflected as discontinued operations in the Consolidated Statements of Earnings, in accordance with Statement of Financial Accounting Standards (“SFAS”) No. 144, Accounting for the Impairment or Disposal of Long-Lived Assets (“SFAS 144”), for all

3


Table of Contents

periods presented. Subsequent to the LPS spin-off, we reviewed our reporting and management structure, and beginning with this Form 10-K, are reporting the results of our operations in four new reporting segments: 1) Financial Solutions, 2) Payment Solutions, 3) International and 4) Corporate and Other. All periods presented have been conformed to reflect the segment changes.
Narrative Description of the Business
     FIS is a leading provider of technology solutions, processing services and information-based services to the financial services industry. We offer a diversified service mix and benefit from the opportunity to cross-sell multiple services across our broad customer base. FIS is a member of Standard and Poor’s (S&P) 500 Index.
     As of December 31, 2008 we have over 14,000 customers in over 90 countries spanning all segments of the financial services industry. These customers include 40 of the top 50 world banks, including nine of the top 10, as ranked by Bankalmanac.com as of April 30, 2008, as well as mid-tier and community banks, credit unions, commercial lenders, automotive financial institutions, retailers and international customers. Additionally, we provide services to numerous retailers via our check processing services. No individual customer represents more than 10% of our revenues.
Revenues by Segment
     The table below summarizes the revenues by our reporting segments (in millions):
                         
    2008     2007     2006  
Financial Solutions
  $ 1,158.8     $ 1,007.6     $ 882.2  
Payment Solutions
    1,530.2       1,298.8       1,120.5  
International
    759.5       618.1       430.3  
Corporate & Other
    (2.5 )     (3.5 )     (16.5 )
 
                 
Total Consolidated Revenues
  $ 3,446.0     $ 2,921.0     $ 2,416.5  
 
                 
     Financial Solutions
     The primary focus of our Financial Solutions segment is servicing the core and related ancillary processing needs of U.S. banks, credit unions, automotive financial companies, commercial lenders, independent community and savings institutions. Our product and service offerings in this segment include:
    Core Processing Applications. Our core processing software applications are designed to run critical banking processes for our financial institution clients. These critical processes include deposit and lending systems, customer systems and most other central systems that a financial institution must utilize to manage the products and services it provides to its customers.
 
    Channel Solutions. Our comprehensive suite of retail delivery applications enable financial institutions to integrate and streamline customer-facing operations and back-office processes, thereby improving customer interaction across all channels (e.g., branch offices, Internet, ATM, call centers).
 
    Decision Solutions. Our decision solutions offer a full spectrum of options that cover the account lifecycle from helping to identify qualified account applicants to managing mature customer accounts and fraud. Our applications include know your customer, new account decisioning, new account opening, account and transaction management, fraud management and collections.
 
    Syndicated Loan Applications. Our syndicated loan applications are designed to support wholesale and commercial banking requirements necessary for all aspects of syndicated commercial loan origination and management.
 
    Automotive Finance Applications. Our primary automotive finance applications include an application suite that assists automotive finance institutions in evaluating loan applications and credit risk, and allows automotive finance institutions to manage their loan and lease portfolios. We also offer dealer wholesale finance and other ancillary services to the automotive industry.

4


Table of Contents

    Commercial Technology. Our commercial technology includes solutions designed to meet the technology challenges facing any client, large or small. Our technology solutions range in scope from consulting engagements to application development projects and from operations support for a single application to full management of information technology infrastructures.
 
    Global Solutions. Our global solutions business provides outsourcing teams, both onshore and offshore, to manage costs, improve operational efficiency, transform processes and deliver world-class customer service all around the world.
 
    Risk Management. Our risk management services utilize our proprietary risk management models and data sources to assist in detecting fraud and assessing the risk of opening a new account or accepting a check at either the point-of-sale, a physical branch location, or through the Internet. Our systems utilize a combination of advanced authentication procedures, predictive analytics, artificial intelligence modeling, neural networks and proprietary and shared databases to assess and detect fraud risk for deposit transactions for financial institutions.
 
    Ancillary Solutions. We offer a number of services that are ancillary to the primary products and services listed above including branch automation, back office support systems and compliance support.
     We employ several business models to provide our solutions to our customers. We typically deliver the highest value to our customers when we combine our software applications and deliver them in one of several types of outsourcing arrangements, such as an application service provider, facilities management processing or an application management arrangement. We are also able to deliver individual applications through a software licensing arrangement. Based upon the expertise gained through the foregoing arrangements, some clients also use us to manage their IT operations without providing any of our proprietary software.
     Payment Solutions
     Our Payment Solutions segment is focused on servicing the payment and electronic funds transfer needs of U.S. banks, credit unions, automotive financial companies, commercial lenders, independent community and savings institutions. Our product and service offerings in this segment include:
    Debit & Electronic Funds Transfer. Our debit and electronic funds transfer processing options include multiple authorization options, settlement and card management.
 
    Electronic Banking and Bill Payment. Our electronic banking services are utilized by more than 1,700 financial institutions to offer Internet banking and bill payment services to their customers. Our bill payment solution is designed to ease online banking by providing a robust bill payment solution including paying bills online, scheduling payments, setting up recurring payments, using various accounts, and viewing payment history.
 
    Merchant Processing. Our merchant processing provides everything a financial institution needs to manage its merchant portfolio including point-of-sale equipment, transaction authorization, draft capture, settlement, charge-back processing and reporting.
 
    Item Processing Services. Our item processing equip financial institutions with the equipment needed to capture and sort items, process exceptions through keying, balancing, archiving and the production of statements. Our item processing services are utilized by more than 1,400 financial institutions and are performed at one of our 33 item processing centers located throughout the U.S. or on-site at customer locations.
 
    Credit Card Services. Over 6,000 financial institutions utilize a combination of our technology and or/services to issue VISA, MasterCard or American Express branded credit and debit cards or other electronic payment cards for use by both consumer and business accounts, from card production and activation to an extensive range of fraud management services to value-added loyalty programs designed to increase card usage and fee-based revenues. The majority of our programs are full service, including most of the operations and support necessary for an issuer to operate a credit card program. We do not make credit decisions for our card issuing customers, nor do we fund their receivables.
 
    Prepaid Card Services. We are one of the largest and most comprehensive provider of prepaid card services, including gift cards and reloadable cards, with end-to-end solutions for development, processing and administration of stored value programs.

5


Table of Contents

    Check Authorization. Our check authorization system utilizes artificial intelligence modeling, neural networks and other state-of-the-art technology to deliver accuracy, convenience and simplicity to retailers.
 
    Ancillary Solutions. We offer a number of services that are ancillary to the primary products and services listed above, including print and mail capabilities. Our print and mail services offer complete computer output solutions for the creation, management and delivery of print and fulfillment needs.
     International
     We provide core banking applications, item processing, card services and check risk management solutions to financial institutions, card issuers, and retailers in over 90 countries outside the United States. Our international operations leverage existing domestic applications and provide services for the specific business needs of our customers in targeted international markets. Our product and service offering includes a comprehensive range of financial and payment processing software and services. Our payment solutions services include fully outsourced card issuer services and customer support, item processing and retail point-of-sale check authorization services. Our financial solutions services include fully outsourced core bank processing arrangements, application management, software licensing and maintenance, facilities management and consulting services.
     Corporate and Other Segment
     The Corporate and Other segment consists of the corporate overhead costs that are not allocated to any operating segments. These include costs related to human resources, finance, accounting, domestic sales and marketing and amortization of acquisition related intangibles and other costs that are not considered when management evaluates segment performance.
Sales and Marketing
     We have teams of experienced sales personnel with expertise in particular services or the needs of particular types of customers. We target the majority of our potential customers via direct and/or indirect field sales, as well as inbound and outbound telemarketing efforts. Marketing activities include direct marketing, print advertising, media relations, public relations, tradeshow and convention activities, seminars and other targeted activities. Our sales force also targets existing customers to promote the cross-selling of additional products and services to our existing client base. Our strategy is to use the most efficient delivery system available to successfully acquire clients and build awareness of our products and services.
Patents, Trademarks and Other Intellectual Property
     We rely on a combination of contractual restrictions, internal security practices, and applicable law to establish and protect our software, technology and expertise worldwide. Further, we have developed a number of brands that have accumulated substantial goodwill in the marketplace, and we rely on trademark law to protect our rights in those brands. While we intend to continue taking appropriate measures to protect our intellectual property rights, these legal protections and arrangements afford only limited protection, and there is no assurance that our competitors will not independently develop or license products, services, or capabilities that are substantially equivalent or superior to ours. In general, we own the proprietary rights necessary for the conduct of our business, although we do license certain items from third parties under arms-length agreements for varying terms.
Competition
     Our primary competitors include internal technology departments within financial institutions and retailers, data processing or software development departments of large companies or large computer manufacturers, third-party payment processors, independent computer services firms, companies that develop and deploy software applications, companies that provide customized development, implementation and support services and companies that market software for the financial services industry. Some of these competitors possess substantially greater financial, sales and marketing resources than we do. Competitive factors impacting the success of our products and services include the quality of the technology-based application or service, application features and functions, ease of delivery and integration, ability of the provider to maintain, enhance, and support the applications or services, and price. We believe that we compete favorably in each of these categories. In addition, we believe that our financial institution industry expertise, combined with our ability to offer multiple applications, services and integrated solutions to individual customers, enhances our competitiveness against companies with more limited offerings. Specific competitors for both financial and payment solutions include:

6


Table of Contents

     Fiserv, Inc., Jack Henry and Associates, Inc. and Metavante Corporation. In the core processing market, we also compete with Open Solutions, Inc., International Business Machines Corporation (IBM), Accenture Ltd., and in certain non-U.S. markets, Alnova Technologies Corporation, I-Flex Solutions Limited n/k/a Oracle Financial Services Software Limited and Temenos Group AG. Our competitors in the card services market include third-party credit and debit card processors such as First Data Corporation, Total System Services, Inc., Electronic Data Systems Corporation (EDS) and Payment Systems for Credit Unions (PSCU). Competitors in the check risk management services market include First Data Corporation’s TeleCheck Services division, and Global Payments, Inc.
Research and Development
     Our research and development activities have related primarily to the design and development of processing systems and related software applications and risk management platforms. We expect to continue our practice of investing an appropriate level of resources to maintain, enhance and extend the functionality of our proprietary systems and existing software applications, to develop new and innovative software applications and systems in response to the needs of our customers, and to enhance the capabilities surrounding our outsourcing infrastructure. In addition, we intend to offer services that are compatible with new and emerging delivery channels.
     As part of our research and development process, we evaluate current and emerging technology for compatibility with our existing and future software platforms. To this end, we engage with various hardware and software vendors in evaluation of various infrastructure components. Where appropriate, we use third-party technology components in the development of our software applications and service offerings. Third-party software may be used for highly specialized business functions, which we may not be able to develop internally within time and budget constraints. Additionally, third-party software may be used for commodity type functions within a technology platform environment. In the case of nearly all of our third-party software, enterprise license agreements exist for the third-party component and either alternative suppliers exist or transfer rights exist to ensure the continuity of supply. As a result, we are not materially dependent upon any third-party technology components. We work with our customers to determine the appropriate timing and approach to introducing technology or infrastructure changes to our applications and services. In the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006 we recorded expense of approximately $84.8 million, $70.4 million, and $70.9 million, respectively, on research and development efforts (excluding amounts capitalized).
Government Regulation
     Our products and services are subject to a broad range of complex federal, state, and foreign regulation, including federal truth-in-lending and truth-in-savings rules, Regulation AA (Unfair or Deceptive Acts or Practices), privacy laws, usury laws, the Equal Credit Opportunity Act, the Electronic Funds Transfer Act, the Fair Credit Reporting Act, the Fair Debt Collection Practices Act the Bank Secrecy Act, the USA Patriot Act, the Internal Revenue Code, the Employee Retirement Income Security Act, the Health Insurance Portability and Accountability Act and the Community Reinvestment Act. The compliance of our products and services with these and other applicable laws and regulations depends on a variety of factors, including the manner in which our clients use them. Our clients are contractually responsible for determining what is required of them under applicable laws and regulations so that we can assist them in their compliance efforts. The failure of our products and services to comply with applicable laws and regulations could result in restrictions on our ability to provide them, as well as the imposition of civil fines and/or criminal penalties. The four principal areas of regulation impacting our business are:
    Privacy. Our financial institution clients are required to comply with privacy regulations imposed under the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act. These regulations place restrictions on the use of non-public personal information. All financial institutions must disclose detailed privacy policies to their customers and offer them the opportunity to direct the financial institution not to share information with third parties. The new regulations, however, permit financial institutions to share information with non-affiliated parties who perform services for the financial institutions. As a provider of services to financial institutions, we are required to comply with the privacy regulations and are bound by the same limitations on disclosure of the information received from our customers as apply to the financial institutions themselves.
 
    Consumer Reporting. Our retail check authorization services (Certegy Check Services) and account opening services (ChexSystems) maintain databases of consumer information and, as a consequence, are subject to the Federal Fair Credit Reporting Act and similar state laws. Among other things, the Fair Credit Reporting Act imposes requirements on us concerning data accuracy, and provides that consumers have the right to know the contents of their files, to dispute their accuracy, and to require verification or removal of disputed information. In furtherance of our objectives of data accuracy, fair treatment of consumers, protection of consumers’ personal information, and compliance with these laws, we maintain a high level of security for our computer systems in which consumer data resides, and we maintain consumer relations call

7


Table of Contents

      centers to facilitate efficient handling of consumer requests for information and handling disputes.
 
    Debt Collection. Our collection services are subject to the Federal Fair Debt Collection Practices Act and various state collection laws and licensing requirements. The Federal Trade Commission, as well as state attorneys general and other agencies, have enforcement responsibility over the collection laws, as well as the various credit reporting laws.
 
    Money Transfer. Elements of our cash access and money transmission businesses are registered as a Money Services Business and are subject to the USA Patriot Act and reporting requirements of the Bank Secrecy Act and U.S. Treasury Regulations. This business is also subject to various state, local and tribal licensing requirements. The Financial Crimes Enforcement Network, state attorneys general, and other agencies have enforcement responsibility over laws relating to money laundering, currency transmission, and licensing. In addition, most states have enacted statutes that require entities engaged in money transmission and the sale of stored value cards to register as a money transmitter with that jurisdiction’s banking department.
     As a provider of electronic data processing and back-office services to financial institutions we are also subject to regulatory oversight and examination by the Federal Financial Institutions Examination Council, an interagency body of the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation, the Office of Thrift Supervision, the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency, the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System, the National Credit Union Administration and various state regulatory authorities. In addition, independent auditors annually review several of our operations to provide reports on internal controls for our customers’ auditors and regulators. We are also subject to review by state and foreign laws and rules that regulate many of the same activities that are described above, including electronic data processing and back-office services for financial institutions and use of consumer information.
     The foregoing list of laws and regulations to which our company is subject is not exhaustive, and the regulatory framework governing our operations changes continuously. Although we do not believe that compliance with future laws and regulations related to our businesses will have a material adverse effect on our company, enactment of new laws and regulations may increasingly affect the operations of our business, directly and indirectly, which could result in substantial regulatory compliance costs, litigation expense, adverse publicity, and/or loss of revenue.
Employees
     As of December 31, 2008, we had approximately 26,000 employees, including approximately 15,000 employees principally employed outside of the U.S. None of our U.S. workforce currently is unionized. We have not experienced any work stoppages, and we consider our relations with employees to be good.
Available Information
     Our Internet website address is www.fidelityinfoservices.com. We make our Annual Reports on Form 10-K, Quarterly Reports on Form 10-Q, and Current Reports on Form 8-K, and amendments to those reports, available, free of charge, on that website as soon as reasonably practicable after we file or furnish them to the Securities and Exchange Commission. Our Corporate Governance Policy and Code of Business Conduct and Ethics are also available on our website and are available in print, free of charge, to any shareholder who mails a request to the Corporate Secretary, Fidelity National Information Services, Inc., 601 Riverside Avenue, Jacksonville, FL 32204 USA. Other corporate governance-related documents can be found at our website as well. However, the information found on our website is not a part of this or any other report.
Item 1A. Risk Factors.
     In addition to the normal risks of business, we are subject to significant risks and uncertainties, including those listed below and others described elsewhere in this Annual Report on Form 10-K. Any of the risks described herein could result in a significant adverse effect on our results of operation and financial condition.
If we fail to adapt our services to changes in technology or in the marketplace, or if our ongoing efforts to upgrade our technology are not successful, we could lose customers and have difficulty attracting new customers for our services.
     The markets for our services are characterized by constant technological changes, frequent introductions of new services and evolving industry standards. Our future success will be significantly affected by our ability to enhance our current services, and develop and introduce new services that address the increasingly sophisticated needs of our customers and their clients. These

8


Table of Contents

initiatives carry the risks associated with any new service development effort, including cost overruns, delays in delivery, and performance issues. There can be no assurance that we will be successful in developing, marketing and selling new services that meet these changing demands, that we will not experience difficulties that could delay or prevent the successful development, introduction, and marketing of these services, or that our new services and their enhancements will adequately meet the demands of the marketplace and achieve market acceptance.
We may experience defects, development delays, installation difficulties and system failures with respect to our technology solutions, which would harm our business and reputation and expose us to potential liability.
     Many of our services are based on sophisticated software and computing systems, and we may encounter delays when developing new technology solutions and services. Further, the technology solutions underlying our services have occasionally contained and may in the future contain undetected errors or defects when first introduced or when new versions are released. In addition, we may experience difficulties in installing or integrating our technologies on platforms used by our customers. Finally, our systems and operations could be exposed to damage or interruption from fire, natural disaster, power loss, telecommunications failure, unauthorized entry and computer viruses. Defects in our technology solutions, errors or delays in the processing of electronic transactions, or other difficulties could result in: (i) interruption of business operations; (ii) delay in market acceptance; (iii) additional development and remediation costs; (iv) diversion of technical and other resources; (v) loss of customers; and (vi) negative publicity; or exposure to liability claims.
     Any one or more of the foregoing could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations. Although we attempt to limit our potential liability through disclaimers and limitation-of-liability provisions in our license and customer agreements, we cannot be certain that these measures will always be successful in limiting our liability.
We operate in a competitive business environment, and if we are unable to compete effectively our results of operations and financial condition may be adversely affected.
     The market for our services is intensely competitive. Our competitors vary in size and in the scope and breadth of the services they offer. Some of our competitors have substantial resources. We face direct competition from third parties, and since many of our larger potential customers have historically developed their key applications in-house and therefore view their system requirements from a make-versus-buy perspective, we often compete against our potential customers’ in-house capacities. In addition, we expect that the markets in which we compete will continue to attract new competitors and new technologies. There can be no assurance that we will be able to compete successfully against current or future competitors or that competitive pressures we face in the markets in which we operate will not materially adversely affect our business, financial condition, and results of operations.
Our revenues from the sale of services to members of VISA, MasterCard, American Express and other similar organizations are dependent upon our continued certification and sponsorship, and the loss or suspension of certification or sponsorship could adversely affect our business.
     In order to provide our card processing services, we must be certified by Visa, MasterCard, American Express and other similar organizations. These certifications are dependent upon our continued adherence to the standards of the issuing bodies. The member financial institutions, some of which are our competitors, set the standards with which we must comply. If we fail to comply with these standards, our certifications could be suspended or terminated. The termination of our certifications, or any changes in the rules and regulations governing VISA, MasterCard, American Express or other similar organizations could prevent our registration or otherwise limit our ability to provide services, which could result in a reduction in revenue or increased costs of operation, which in turn could have a material adverse effect on our business.
Potential customers may be reluctant to switch to a new vendor, which may adversely affect our growth, both in the U.S. and internationally.
     For banks and other potential customers of our financial information software and services, switching from one vendor of bank core processing or related software and services (or from an internally-developed system) to a new vendor is a significant undertaking. Many potential customers worry about potential disadvantages such as loss of accustomed functionality, increased costs and business disruption. As a result, potential customers, both in the U.S. and internationally, often resist change. We seek to overcome this resistance through strategies such as making investments to enhance the functionality of our software. However, there can be no assurance that our strategies for overcoming potential customers’ reluctance to change vendors will be successful, and this resistance may adversely affect our growth, both in the U.S. and internationally.

9


Table of Contents

Demand for many of our services is sensitive to the level of consumer transactions generated by our customers, and accordingly, our revenues could be impacted negatively by the current recession or any other event causing a material slowing of consumer spending.
     A significant portion of our revenue is derived from transaction processing fees. Any changes in economic factors, such as the current recession, that adversely affect consumer spending and related consumer debt, or lead to a reduction in check writing or credit and debit card usage, could reduce the volume of transactions that we process, and have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.
We have a long sales cycle for many of our applications and if we fail to close sales after expending significant time and resources to do so, our business, financial condition, and results of operations may be adversely affected.
     The implementation of many of our applications often involves significant capital commitments by our customers, particularly those with smaller operational scale. Potential customers generally commit significant resources to an evaluation of available software and require us to expend substantial time, effort, and money educating them as to the value of our software and services. We incur substantial costs in order to obtain each new customer. We may expend significant funds and management resources during the sales cycle and ultimately fail to close the sale. Our sales cycle may be extended due to our customers’ budgetary constraints or for other reasons. If we are unsuccessful in closing sales after expending significant funds and management resources or we experience delays, it could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, and results of operations.
Many of our customers are subject to a regulatory environment and to industry standards that may change in a manner that reduces the number of transactions in which our customers engage and therefore reduces our revenues.
     Our customers are subject to a number of government regulations and industry standards with which our services must comply. For example, our services are affected by VISA, MasterCard, American Express and electronic payment standards that are generally updated twice annually. In addition, action by regulatory authorities relating to credit availability, data usage, privacy, or other related regulatory developments could have an adverse effect on our customers and therefore could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, and results of operations.
Security breaches or our own failure to comply with privacy regulations imposed on providers of services to financial institutions could harm our business by disrupting our delivery of services and damaging our reputation.
     As part of our business, we electronically receive, process, store and transmit sensitive business information of our customers. In addition, we collect personal consumer data, such as names and addresses, social security numbers, driver’s license numbers and payment history records. Unauthorized access to our computer systems or databases could result in the theft or publication of confidential information or the deletion or modification of records or could otherwise cause interruptions in our operations. These concerns about security are increased when we transmit information over the Internet.
     Additionally, as a provider of services to financial institutions, we are bound by the same limitations on disclosure of the information we receive from our customers as apply to the financial institutions themselves. If we fail to comply with these regulations, we could be exposed to suits for breach of contract or to governmental proceedings. In addition, if more restrictive privacy laws or rules are adopted in the future on the federal or state level, that could have an adverse impact on us. Any inability to prevent security or privacy breaches could cause our existing customers to lose confidence in our systems and terminate their agreements with us, and could inhibit our ability to attract new customers and/or adversely impact our relationship with administrative agencies.
Misappropriation of our intellectual property and proprietary rights could impair our competitive position.
     Our ability to compete depends upon proprietary systems and technology. Despite our efforts to protect our proprietary rights, unauthorized parties may attempt to copy aspects of our services or to obtain and use information that we regard as proprietary. Policing unauthorized use of our proprietary rights is difficult. We cannot make any assurances that the steps we have taken will prevent misappropriation of technology or that the agreements entered into for that purpose will be enforceable. Effective trademark, service mark, copyright, and trade secret protection may not be available in every country in which our applications and services are made available online. Misappropriation of our intellectual property or potential litigation concerning such matters could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations or financial condition.

10


Table of Contents

We face liability to our merchant customers if checks that we have guaranteed are dishonored by the check writer’s bank.
     If a check that we have guaranteed is dishonored by the check writer’s bank, we must reimburse our merchant customer for the check’s face value and pursue collection of the amount from the check writer. In some cases, we recognize a liability to our merchant customers for estimated check returns and a receivable for amounts we estimate we will recover from the check writers, based on historical experience and other relevant factors. The estimated check returns and recovery amounts are subject to the risk that actual amounts returned may exceed our estimates and actual amounts recovered may be less than our estimates.
If our applications or services are found to infringe the proprietary rights of others, we may be required to change our business practices and may also become subject to significant costs and monetary penalties.
     As our information technology applications and services develop, we may become increasingly subject to infringement claims. Any claims, whether with or without merit, could: (i) be expensive and time-consuming to defend; (ii) cause us to cease making, licensing or using applications that incorporate the challenged intellectual property; (iii) require us to redesign our applications, if feasible; (iv) divert management’s attention and resources; and (v) require us to enter into royalty or licensing agreements in order to obtain the right to use necessary technologies.
Our business is subject to the risks of international operations, including movements in foreign currency exchange rates.
     We derive a significant portion of our revenue and earnings from international operations. As a result, our financial condition and operating results could be significantly affected by risks associated with international activities, including economic and labor conditions, political instability, tax laws (including U.S. taxes on foreign subsidiaries), and changes in the value of the U.S. Dollar versus local currencies. In addition, we are less well-known internationally than in the United States, have less experience with local business conditions and will face challenges in successfully managing small operations located far from our headquarters, because of the greater difficulty in overseeing and guiding operations from a distance.
     As we expand our international operations, more of our customers may pay us in foreign currencies. Conducting business in currencies other than U.S. Dollars subjects us to fluctuations in currency exchange rates. Our primary exposure to movements in foreign currency exchange rates relate to foreign currencies in Brazil, Europe, Australia and parts of Asia. The U.S. Dollar value of our net investments in foreign operations, the periodic conversion of foreign-denominated earnings to the U.S. Dollar (our reporting currency), our results of operations and, in some cases, cash flows, could be adversely affected in a material manner by movements in foreign currency exchange rates. During the twelve months ended December 31, 2008, approximately 17% of our revenues were denominated in currencies other than the U.S. Dollar, including the Brazilian Real, British pound and Euro. These risks could cause a material adverse effect on our business, financial position and results of operations and could cause the market value of our common stock to decline.
Our existing levels of leverage and debt service requirements may adversely affect our financial and operational flexibility.
     As of December 31, 2008, we had total debt of approximately $2.5 billion. This level of debt could have important consequences to us, including the following: (i) the debt level may cause us to have difficulty borrowing money in the future for working capital, capital expenditures, acquisitions or other purposes and limits our ability to pursue other business opportunities and implement certain business strategies; (ii) we use a large portion of the money we earn to pay principal and interest on our senior credit facilities, which reduces the amount of money available to finance operations, acquisitions and other business activities, repay other indebtedness and pay shareholder dividends; (iii) some of our debt has a variable rate of interest, which exposes us to the risk of increased interest rates; and (iv) we have a higher level of debt than some of our competitors, which may cause a competitive disadvantage and may reduce flexibility in responding to changing business and economic conditions, including increased competition.
     In addition, the terms of our senior credit facilities may restrict us from taking actions, such as making significant acquisitions or dispositions or entering into certain agreements, which we might believe to be advantageous to us.
If we are unable to successfully consummate and integrate acquisitions, our results of operations may be adversely affected.
     We have made numerous acquisitions in recent years as a part of our growth strategy. We anticipate that we will continue to seek to acquire complementary businesses and services. This strategy will depend on the ability to find suitable acquisitions and finance them

11


Table of Contents

on acceptable terms. We may require additional debt or equity financing for future acquisitions, and doing so will be made more difficult by our existing debt. If we are unable to acquire suitable acquisition candidates, we may experience slower growth. Further, after successfully completing acquisitions, we face challenges in integrating acquired businesses. These challenges include eliminating redundant operations, facilities and systems, coordinating management and personnel, retaining key employees, managing different corporate cultures, and achieving cost reductions and cross-selling opportunities. There can be no assurance that we will be able to fully integrate all aspects of acquired businesses successfully or fully realize the potential benefits of bringing them together, and the process of integrating these acquisitions may disrupt our business and divert our resources.
We may be unable to achieve some or all of the benefits that we expect from the LPS spin-off.
     We may not be able to achieve the strategic and financial benefits we expected to result from the LPS spin-off or such benefits may be delayed. These outcomes may occur due to, among other things, the loss of synergies, excess costs the two companies will incur as stand-alone entities, or the obligations imposed on us to avoid certain transactions in respect of our capital stock in order to preserve the planned tax-free nature of the transactions.
If any part of the LPS spin-off is determined to be a taxable transaction, then additional taxes could be imposed on us and our shareholders.
     On June 20, 2008, we received a favorable private letter ruling from the Internal Revenue Service (“IRS”) regarding the contribution of our interest in the assets, liabilities, businesses and employees related to our lender processing services operations in exchange for the receipt by us of LPS common stock and LPS debt obligations, which we refer to as the contribution, the exchange by us of LPS debt obligations for certain outstanding FIS debt, which we refer to as the debt exchange, and the distribution of LPS common stock to our shareholders, which we refer to as the spin-off. The IRS ruling was to the effect that: (i) the contribution taking into account the spin-off will qualify as a reorganization within the meaning of Section 368(a) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, which we refer to as the Code, in which neither we nor LPS will recognize any gain or loss; (ii) no gain or loss will be recognized by us in the debt exchange, pursuant to Section 361 of the Code; and (iii) no gain or loss will be recognized by us or our shareholders on the spin-off, pursuant to Section 355 and related provisions of the Code (including Section 361(c) of the Code), except that any gain that our shareholders realize on cash received in lieu of any fractional shares of our common stock to which such shareholders may be entitled in the spin-off generally will be taxable to our shareholders.
     Notwithstanding our receipt of the IRS private letter ruling, the IRS could determine that the contribution, debt exchange and/or spin-off constitute taxable transactions if it determines that there was a misstatement or omission of any of the facts, representations, or undertakings that were included in the request for the private letter ruling, or if it disagrees with our conclusions reached regarding certain factual requirements that, consistent with the IRS’ standard ruling policy, were not covered by the IRS ruling.
     If one or more of the contribution, debt exchange or spin-off transactions ultimately were determined to be subject to tax, we would recognize gain and the amount of that gain would be up to the excess of the fair market value of the LPS stock and debt obligations we received in the contribution over our basis in the assets we contributed to LPS in the contribution. The amount of such gain could be substantial. Further, if the spin-off transaction were subject to tax, in addition to tax imposed on us, our shareholders generally would be treated as if they received a taxable distribution equal to the full fair market value of LPS stock on the distribution date. In addition, we could be subject to tax on certain of the preliminary asset transfers that were made in connection with the contribution transaction.
     Notwithstanding the favorable IRS ruling that the spin-off qualified for tax-free treatment, it would become taxable to us, pursuant to Section 355(e) of the Code, if 50% or more of the shares of either our common stock or LPS common stock were acquired, directly or indirectly, as part of a plan or series of related transactions that included the spin-off. If the IRS were to determine that acquisitions of our common stock or of LPS common stock, either before or after the spin-off, were part of a plan or series of related transactions that included the spin-off, this determination could result in the recognition of substantial gain by us under Section 355(e).
     Although the taxes resulting from the contribution, debt exchange or spin-off not qualifying for tax-free treatment for United States Federal income tax purposes generally would be imposed on us and our shareholders, under the tax disaffiliation agreement entered into by us and LPS in connection with the distribution, LPS would be required to indemnify us and our affiliates against all tax related liabilities caused by the failure of any of those transactions to qualify for tax-free treatment for United States Federal income tax purposes (including as a result of Section 355(e) of the Code) to the extent these liabilities arise as a result of any action taken by LPS or any of LPS’ affiliates following the spin-off or otherwise result from any breach of any representation, covenant or obligation of LPS or any of LPS’ affiliates under the tax disaffiliation agreement.

12


Table of Contents

     There is no guaranty that LPS will have financial resources to satisfy any such indemnification obligation described above.
The executive chairman of our board of directors and other officers and directors have interests and positions that could present potential conflicts.
     We and certain of our subsidiaries are parties to a variety of related party agreements with FNF and LPS. William P. Foley, II, who is our Executive Chairman, is currently the Chairman of the board of directors of both FNF and LPS. Lee A. Kennedy, who serves as President and Chief Executive Officer of our company, is also a director of LPS. Brent B. Bickett, who is an officer of FIS, is also an officer of FNF and LPS. William P. Foley, II and Brent B. Bickett also own or hold substantial amounts of LPS and FNF stock and stock options. Thomas M. Hagerty and Richard N. Massey, who are both directors of FIS, are also directors of FNF. As a result of the foregoing, there may be circumstances where certain of our executive officers and directors may be subject to conflicts of interest with respect to, among other things: (i) our past and ongoing relationships with FNF and LPS, including related party agreements and other arrangements with respect to the administration of tax matters, employee benefits and indemnification; (ii) the quality, pricing and other terms associated with services that we provide to FNF and LPS, or that they provide to us, under related party agreements; (iii) business opportunities arising for either us, FNF or LPS, that could be pursued by either us, or by FNF or LPS; and (iv) conflicts of time with respect to matters potentially or actually involving or affecting FIS.
     We seek to manage these potential conflicts through, abstention, oversight by independent members of our board of directors and provisions in our agreements with FNF and LPS. However, there can be no assurance that such measures will be effective or that we will be able to resolve all potential conflicts with FNF and LPS, or that the resolution of any such conflicts will be no less favorable to us than if we were dealing with an unaffiliated third party.
We have substantial investments in recorded goodwill and other intangible assets as a result of prior acquisitions, and a further more severe or continued economic downturn could cause these investments to become impaired, requiring write-downs that would reduce our operating income.
     As of December 31, 2008, goodwill aggregated to approximately $4,194.0 million, 55.8% of total assets, and other indefinite lived intangible assets aggregated to approximately $152.0 million, 2.0% of total assets. Current accounting rules require goodwill and other indefinite lived intangible assets to be assessed for impairment at least annually or whenever changes in circumstances indicate potential impairment. Factors that may be considered a change in circumstance include significant underperformance relative to historical or projected future operating results, a significant decline in our stock price and market capitalization, and negative industry or economic trends. The results of our fiscal year 2008 annual assessment of the recoverability of goodwill indicated that the fair value of the Company’s reporting units were in excess of the carrying value of those reporting units, and thus no goodwill impairment existed as of December 31, 2008. Additionally, other than with respect to our Certegy Check business, where we recorded an impairment charge of $52.0 million in the fourth quarter of 2008, the fair value of indefinite lived intangible assets was in excess of the carry value of those assets. However, if the current worldwide economic downturn continues, the carrying amount of our goodwill and other indefinite lived intangible assets may no longer be recoverable, and we may be required to record an impairment charge, which would have a negative impact on our results of operations and financial condition. We will continue to monitor the fair value of our other indefinite lived intangible assets as well as our market capitalization and the impact of the current economic downturn on our business to determine if there is an impairment in future periods.
Consolidations and failures in the banking and financial services industry could adversely affect our business by eliminating some of our existing and potential customers and making us more dependent on a more limited number of customers.
     There has been and continues to be substantial consolidation activity in the banking and financial services industry. In addition, many financial institutions that experienced negative operating results, including some of our customers, have failed.
     The failures and consolidations reduce the number of our customers and potential customers, which could adversely affect our revenues even if the events do not reduce the aggregate activities of the consolidated entities. Further, if our customers fail and/or merge with or are acquired by other entities that are not our customers, or that use fewer of our services, they may discontinue or reduce use of our services. It is also possible that larger financial institutions resulting from consolidations would have greater leverage in negotiating terms or could decide to perform in-house some or all of the services which we currently provide or could provide. Any of these developments could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition.

13


Table of Contents

Losses, consolidations and failures in the financial services industry may impact our ability to borrow funds or the ability of our lenders to fulfill their obligations under our interest rate swap agreements.
     Many financial institutions are currently experiencing negative operating results. In some cases, these negative operating results have led to financial institution failures and/or consolidations, including, in some cases, lenders that are parties to our Credit Agreement and interest rate swap agreements. As a result, lenders may become insolvent or tighten lending standards, which could in turn make it more difficult or impossible for lenders to perform their obligations under our interest rate swap agreements or for us to borrow under our Credit Agreement, obtain financing on favorable terms, or obtain financing or interest rate swap agreements at all. Our financial condition and results of operations could be adversely affected if a financial institution fails to fulfill its obligations under our interest rate swap agreements or we are unable to draw funds under our Credit Agreement or obtain other cost-effective financing.
Statement Regarding Forward-Looking Information
     The statements contained in this Form 10-K or in our other documents or in oral presentations or other statements made by our management that are not purely historical are forward-looking statements within the meaning of Section 27A of the Securities Act of 1933 and Section 21E of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, including statements regarding our expectations, hopes, intentions, or strategies regarding the future. These statements relate to, among other things, our future financial and operating results. In many cases, you can identify forward-looking statements by terminology such as “may,” “will,” “should,” “expect,” “plan,” “anticipate,” “believe,” “estimate,” “predict,” “potential,” or “continue,” or the negative of these terms and other comparable terminology. Actual results could differ materially from those anticipated in these statements as a result of a number of factors, including, but not limited to:
    general political, economic, and business conditions, including the possibility of intensified international hostilities, acts of terrorism, and general volatility in the capital markets;
 
    failures to adapt our services to changes in technology or in the marketplace;
 
    consolidation or failures in the banking industry;
 
    consolidation or failures in the retail industry;
 
    security breaches of our systems and computer viruses affecting our software;
 
    the impact of competitive services and pricing;
 
    the ability to identify suitable acquisition candidates and the ability to finance such acquisitions, which depends upon the availability of adequate cash reserves from operations or of acceptable financing terms and the variability of our stock price;
 
    our ability to integrate any acquired business’ operations, services, clients, and personnel;
 
    the effect of our substantial leverage, which may limit the funds available to make acquisitions and invest in our business;
 
    changes in, or the failure to comply with, government regulations, including privacy regulations; and
 
    other risks detailed elsewhere in this Risk Factors section and in our other filings with the Securities and Exchange Commission.
     We are not under any obligation (and expressly disclaim any such obligation) to update or alter our forward-looking statements, whether as a result of new information, future events or otherwise. You should carefully consider the possibility that actual results may differ materially from our forward-looking statements.
Item 1B. Unresolved Staff Comments.
     None.
Item 2. Properties.

14


Table of Contents

     FIS’ corporate headquarters is located at 601 Riverside Avenue, Jacksonville, Florida in a facility leased from LPS. In addition, FIS owns or leases support centers, data processing facilities and other facilities at over 190 locations. We believe our facilities and equipment are generally well maintained and are in good operating condition. We believe that the computer equipment that we own and our various facilities are adequate for our present and foreseeable business needs. We maintain our own, and contract with multiple service providers to provide, processing back-up in the event of a disaster.
Item 3. Legal Proceedings.
     See discussion of Litigation in Note 17 to the Consolidated Financial Statements included in Item 8 of Part II of this Report, which is incorporated by reference into this Part I, Item 3.
Item 4. Submission of Matters to a Vote of Security Holders.
     None.
PART II
Item 5. Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities.
     Our common stock trades on the New York Stock Exchange under the ticker symbol “FIS.” The table set forth below provides the high and low sales prices of the common stock and the cash dividends declared per share of common stock for each quarter of 2008 and 2007. On July 2, 2008 (the “spin-off date”), all of the shares of the common stock, par value $0.0001 per share of LPS, previously a wholly-owned subsidiary of FIS, were distributed to FIS shareholders through a stock dividend (the “spin-off”). In the spin-off, FIS contributed to LPS all of FIS’ interest in the assets, liabilities, businesses and employees related to FIS’ Lender Processing Services segment in exchange for shares of LPS common stock and $1,585.0 million aggregate principal amount of LPS debt obligations, which we exchanged with the holders of our $1,585.0 Term Loan B and retired the latter debt. Upon the distribution, FIS shareholders received one-half share of LPS common stock for every share of FIS common stock held as of the close of business on June 24, 2008. FIS’ shareholders collectively received 100% of the LPS Common Stock, which became a separate public company trading under the symbol “LPS” on the New York Stock Exchange.
                         
    High     Low     Dividend  
2008
                       
First Quarter
  $ 43.50     $ 36.31     $ 0.05  
Second Quarter
  $ 42.16     $ 34.90     $ 0.05  
Third Quarter (a)
  $ 37.25     $ 18.09     $ 0.05  
Fourth Quarter (a)
  $ 18.18     $ 12.47     $ 0.05  
2007
                       
First Quarter
  $ 47.55     $ 40.34     $ 0.05  
Second Quarter
  $ 55.09     $ 47.35     $ 0.05  
Third Quarter
  $ 57.67     $ 44.28     $ 0.05  
Fourth Quarter
  $ 47.86     $ 41.50     $ 0.05  
 
(a)   The sales prices of our common stock for the third and fourth quarter of 2008 reflect the LPS spin-off. As of January 31, 2009, there were approximately 8,947 shareholders of record of our common stock.
     We currently pay a $0.05 dividend on a quarterly basis, and expect to continue to do so in the future. The declaration and payment of future dividends is at the discretion of our Board of Directors, and depends on, among other things, our investment policy and opportunities, results of operations, financial condition, cash requirements, future prospects, and other factors that may be considered relevant by our Board of Directors, including legal and contractual restrictions. Additionally, the payment of cash dividends may be limited by covenants in our debt agreements. A regular quarterly dividend of $0.05 per common share is payable March 30, 2009 to shareholders of record as of the close of business on March 16, 2009.
     Item 12 of Part III contains information concerning securities authorized for issuance under our equity compensation plans.
     On October 25, 2006, our Board of Directors approved a plan authorizing repurchases of up to $200.0 million worth of our common stock (the “Old Plan”). On April 17, 2008, our Board of Directors approved a plan authorizing repurchases of up to an additional

15


Table of Contents

$250.0 million worth of our common stock (the “New Plan”). Under the New Plan we repurchased 5.8 million shares of our common stock for $226.2 million, at an average price of $38.97, for the year ended December 31, 2008. There were no stock repurchases during the 2008 fourth quarter. During the year ended December 31, 2008, we also repurchased an additional 0.2 million shares of our common stock for $10.0 million at an average price of $40.56 under the Old Plan. Total shares repurchased during the year ended December 31, 2008 were 6.0 million shares for $236.2 million at an average price of $39.04.

16


Table of Contents

Item 6. Selected Financial Data.
     The selected financial data set forth below constitutes historical financial data of FIS and should be read in conjunction with Item 7, Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations, and Item 8, Financial Statements and Supplementary Data, included elsewhere in this report.
     On February 1, 2006, we completed the Certegy merger. For accounting and financial reporting purposes, the merger was treated as a reverse acquisition of Certegy by FIS under the purchase method of accounting pursuant to generally accepted accounting principles. Accordingly, our historical financial information for periods prior to the Certegy Merger is the historical financial information of FIS.
     On July 2, 2008, we completed the LPS spin-off. For accounting purposes the results of LPS are presented as discontinued operations. Accordingly all prior periods have been restated to present the results of FIS on a stand alone basis and include the results of LPS up to July 1, 2008 as discontinued operations.
                                         
    Year Ended December 31,  
    2008(1)(2)     2007(1)(2)     2006(2)     2005     2004  
    (In millions, except per share data)  
Statement of Earnings Data:
                                       
Processing and services revenues
  $ 3,446.0     $ 2,921.0     $ 2,416.5     $ 1,258.8     $ 981.8  
Cost of revenues
    2,636.9       2,265.8       1,872.2       939.0       733.1  
 
                             
Gross profit
    809.1       655.2       544.3       319.8       248.7  
 
                             
Selling, general and administrative expenses
    389.4       302.9       279.8       179.9       186.3  
Research and development costs
    84.8       70.4       70.9       85.7       40.3  
 
                             
Operating income
    334.9       281.9       193.6       54.2       22.1  
Other income (expense)
    (155.7 )     102.1       (188.4 )     (127.3 )     19.3  
 
                             
Earnings before income taxes, equity in earnings (loss) of unconsolidated entities and minority interest
    179.2       384.0       5.2       (73.1 )     41.4  
Provision for income taxes
    57.6       136.2       (2.9 )     (36.9 )     12.7  
Equity in earnings (loss) of unconsolidated entities
    (0.2 )     2.8       5.8       5.0       (3.3 )
Minority interest
    (4.0 )     0.1       1.7       (6.7 )     (3.7 )
 
                             
Net earnings from continuing operations
    117.4       250.7       15.6       (37.9 )     21.7  
Earnings from discontinued operations, net of tax
    97.4       310.5       243.5       238.5       167.7  
 
                             
Net earnings
  $ 214.8     $ 561.2     $ 259.1     $ 200.6     $ 189.4  
 
                             
Net earnings per share — basic from continuing operations(3)
  $ 0.61     $ 1.30     $ 0.08     $ (0.30 )   $ 0.17  
Net earnings per share — basic from discontinued operations(3)
    0.51       1.61       1.31       1.86       1.31  
 
                             
Net earnings per share — basic(3)
  $ 1.12     $ 2.91     $ 1.39     $ 1.57     $ 1.48  
 
                             
Weighted average shares — basic
    191.6       193.1       185.9       127.9       127.9  
Net earnings per share — diluted from continuing operations(3)
  $ 0.61     $ 1.28     $ 0.08     $ (0.30 )   $ 0.17  
Net earnings per share — diluted from discontinued operations(3)
    0.50       1.58       1.29       1.86       1.31  
 
                             
Net earnings per share — diluted(3)
  $ 1.11     $ 2.86     $ 1.37     $ 1.56     $ 1.48  
 
                             
Weighted average shares — diluted
    193.5       196.5       189.2       128.4       127.9  
 
(1)   eFunds’ results of operations are included in earnings from September 12, 2007, the eFunds acquisition date.
 
(2)   Certegy’s results of operations are included in earnings from February 1, 2006, the Certegy Merger date.
 
(3)   Net earnings per share are calculated, for all periods prior to 2006, using the shares outstanding following FIS’ formation as a holding company, adjusted as converted by the exchange ratio (0.6396) in the Certegy Merger.

17


Table of Contents

                                         
    As of December 31,
    2008 (1)   2007   2006   2005(2)   2004
    (In millions, except per share data)
Balance Sheet Data:
                                       
Cash and cash equivalents
  $ 220.9     $ 355.3     $ 211.8     $ 133.2     $ 190.9  
Goodwill
    4,194.0       5,326.8       3,737.5       244.8       232.9  
Other intangible assets
    924.3       1,030.6       1,010.0       15.5       25.5  
Total assets
    7,514.0       9,794.6       7,630.6       4,189.0       4,002.9  
Total long-term debt
    2,514.5       4,275.4       3,009.5       2,564.1       431.2  
Minority interest
    164.2       14.2       13.0       13.1       13.6  
Total stockholders’ equity
    3,532.8       3,781.2       3,142.7       694.6       2,754.8  
Cash dividends declared per share
  $ 0.20     $ 0.20     $ 0.20     $     $  
 
(1)   Our LPS business was spun-off as of July 2, 2008.
 
(2)   On March 8, 2005, the Company paid a dividend to Old FNF, its former parent, of $2.7 billion as part of a recapitalization transaction.
Selected Quarterly Financial Data
     Selected unaudited quarterly financial data is as follows:
                                 
    Quarter Ended (1)
    March 31,   June 30,   September 30,   December 31,
    (In millions, except per share data)
2008
                               
Processing and services revenues
  $ 830.3     $ 869.7     $ 884.0     $ 862.0  
Gross profit
    181.6       195.7       222.2       209.6  
Earnings before income taxes, equity in earnings (loss) of unconsolidated entities and minority interest
    14.0       17.1       73.0       75.1  
Net earnings
    70.5       71.9       43.6       28.8  
Net earnings per share — basic
  $ 0.36     $ 0.37     $ 0.23     $ 0.15  
Net earnings per share — diluted
  $ 0.36     $ 0.37     $ 0.23     $ 0.15  
2007
                               
Processing and services revenues
  $ 665.0     $ 695.3     $ 705.4     $ 855.3  
Gross profit
    145.8       160.7       141.8       206.9  
Earnings before income taxes, equity in earnings (loss) of unconsolidated entities and minority interest
    (12.6 )     122.0       200.7       73.9  
Net earnings
    59.5       148.0       245.3       108.4  
Net earnings per share — basic
  $ 0.31     $ 0.77     $ 1.27     $ 0.56  
Net earnings per share — diluted
  $ 0.30     $ 0.75     $ 1.25     $ 0.55  
 
(1)   The fourth quarter of 2007 and each quarter of 2008 includes a full quarter of revenues relating to the eFunds acquisition.
Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations
     The following section discusses management’s view of the financial condition and results of operations of FIS and its consolidated subsidiaries as of December 31, 2008 and 2007 and for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006.
     This section should be read in conjunction with the audited Consolidated Financial Statements and related Notes of FIS included elsewhere in this Annual Report. This Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations contains forward-looking statements. See “Forward-Looking Statements” and “Risk Factors” for a discussion of the uncertainties, risks and assumptions associated with these forward-looking statements that could cause future results to differ materially from those reflected in this section.
Overview
     We are one of the largest global providers of processing services to financial institutions and businesses, serving customers in over 90 countries throughout the world. We are among the market leaders in core processing, card issuing services and check point-of-sale verification and guarantee. We offer a diversified service mix, and benefit from the opportunity to cross-sell multiple services across

18


Table of Contents

our broad customer base. We have four reporting segments: Financial Solutions, Payment Solutions, International and Corporate and Other. A description of these segments is included above in Item 1. Revenues by Segment and the results of operations of our segments are discussed below in Segment Results of Operations.
Business Trends and Conditions
     Increases in deposit and card transactions can positively affect our business and thus the condition of the overall economy can have an effect on growth.
     We compete for both licensing and outsourcing business, and thus are affected by the decisions of financial institutions to utilize our services under an outsourced arrangement or to process in-house under a software license and maintenance agreement. As a provider of outsourcing solutions, we benefit from multi-year recurring revenue streams. Generally, demand for outsourcing solutions has increased over time as service providers such as us realize economies of scale and improve their ability to provide services that improve customer efficiencies and reduce costs.
     Card transactions continue to increase as a percentage of total point-of-sale payments, which fuels continuing demand for card-related services. We continue to launch new services aimed at accommodating this demand. In recent years, we have introduced a variety of stored-value card types, Internet banking, and electronic bill presentment/payment services, as well as a number of card enhancement and loyalty/reward programs. The common theme among these offerings continues to be convenience and security for the consumer coupled with value to the financial institution.
     Consolidation within the banking industry may be beneficial or detrimental to our businesses. When consolidations occur, merger partners often operate disparate systems licensed from competing service providers. The newly formed entity generally makes a determination to migrate its core systems to a single platform. When a financial institution processing client is involved in a consolidation, we may benefit by expanding the use of our services if such services are chosen to survive the consolidation and support the newly combined entity. Conversely, we may lose market share if a customer of ours is involved in a consolidation and our services are not chosen to survive the consolidation and support the newly combined entity.
     We believe that we are facing one of the most difficult times that has ever existed for financial institutions, retailers and other businesses in the United States and internationally. We expect there to be a significant number of bank failures in the next few years, which may be offset to a degree by somewhat decreased bank acquisition activity. However, we believe that our potential exposure to bank failures and forced government actions that have occurred to date is less than one half of one percent of our revenues. Additionally this exposure does not consider any incremental revenues we may generate from potential license fees or service associated with assisting surviving institutions with integrating acquired assets resulting from financial failures. We believe that software sales will be the most at risk as far as discretionary purchases that financial institutions may defer. However, software sales represent approximately 5% of our revenues and thus any decrease should not have a significant impact on our results of operations. While we believe that we are well positioned to withstand the current financial crisis, there are factors outside our control that might impact our operating results that we may not be able to fully anticipate as to timing and severity, including but not limited to adverse effects if banks are nationalized, continued global economic conditions worsening, causing further slowdown in consumer spending and lending and the impact on our ability to access capital should any or our lenders fail.
Critical Accounting Policies
     The accounting policies described below are those we consider critical in preparing our Consolidated Financial Statements. These policies require management to make estimates, judgments and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosures with respect to contingent liabilities and assets at the date of the Consolidated Financial Statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting periods. Actual amounts could differ from those estimates. See Note 3 of Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements for a more detailed description of the significant accounting policies that have been followed in preparing our Consolidated Financial Statements.
     Revenue Recognition
     The Company generates revenues from the delivery of bank processing and credit and debit card processing services, professional services, software licensing and software related services and products. Revenues are recognized when evidence of an arrangement exists, delivery has occurred, fees are fixed or determinable and collection is considered probable. Occasionally, we are party to multiple concurrent contracts with the same customer. These situations require judgment to determine whether the individual contracts should be aggregated or evaluated separately for purposes of revenue recognition. In making this determination we consider the timing of negotiating and executing the contracts, whether the different elements of the contracts are interdependent and whether any of the payment terms of the contracts are interrelated. Due to the large number, broad nature and average size of individual

19


Table of Contents

contracts we are party to, the impact of judgements and assumptions that we apply in recognizing revenue for any single contract is not likely to have a material effect on our consolidated operations or financial position. However the broader accounting policy assumptions that we apply across similar arrangements or classes of customers could significantly influence the timing and amount of revenue recognized in our historical and future results of operations or financial position. Additional information about our revenue recognition policies is included in Note 3 to the Consolidated Financial Statements.
     Allowance for Doubtful Accounts
     The Company analyzes trade accounts receivable by considering historical bad debts, customer creditworthiness, current economic trends, changes in customer payment terms and collection trends when evaluating the adequacy of the allowance for doubtful accounts. Any change in the assumptions used in analyzing a specific account receivable may result in an additional allowance for doubtful accounts being recognized in the period in which the change occurs. The allowance for doubtful accounts was $40.6 million and $53.4 million at December 31, 2008 and 2007, respectively. The decrease in the allowance for doubtful accounts from 2007 is primarily related to the LPS spin-off.
     Reserves for Check Guarantee Losses
     In our check guarantee business, if a guaranteed check presented to a merchant customer is dishonored by the check writer’s bank, we reimburse our merchant customer for the check’s face value and pursue collection of the amount from the delinquent check writer. Loss reserves and anticipated recoveries are primarily determined by performing a historical analysis of our check loss and recovery experience and considering other factors that could affect that experience in the future. Such factors include the general economy, the overall industry mix of our customer volumes, statistical analysis of check fraud trends within our customer volumes, and the quality of returned checks. Once these factors are considered, we establish a rate for check losses that is calculated by dividing the expected check losses by dollar volume processed and a rate for anticipated recoveries that is calculated by dividing the anticipated recoveries by the total amount of related check losses. These rates are then applied against the dollar volume processed and check losses, respectively, each month and charged to costs of revenues. The estimated check returns and recovery amounts are subject to risk that actual amounts returned and recovered may be different than our estimates.
     Historically, such estimation processes have proven to be materially accurate; however, our projections of probable check guarantee losses and anticipated recoveries are inherently uncertain, and as a result, we cannot predict with certainty the amount of such items. Changes in economic conditions, the risk characteristics and composition of our customers, and other factors could impact our actual and projected amounts. We recorded check guarantee losses, net of anticipated recoveries excluding service fees, of $98.1 million and $113.8 million, respectively, for the years ended December 31, 2008 and 2007. A ten percent difference in our estimated gross check guarantee losses and our estimated recoveries as of December 31, 2008 could impact 2008 net earnings by approximately $2.2 million after-tax.
     Computer Software
     Computer software includes the fair value of software acquired in business combinations, purchased software and capitalized software development costs. As of December 31, 2008 and 2007, computer software, net of accumulated amortization, was $617.0 million and $775.2 million, respectively. Purchased software is recorded at cost and amortized using the straight line method over its estimated useful life and software acquired in business combinations is recorded at its fair value and amortized using straight line and accelerated methods over their estimated useful lives, ranging from 3 to 10 years. In determining useful lives, management considers historical results and technological trends which may influence the estimate. Amortization expense for computer software was $149.9 million, $177.8 million and $130.2 million in 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. Included in discontinued operations in the Consolidated Statement of Earnings in those years was amortization expense on computer software of $14.8 million, $32.5 million, and $30.2 million for 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. We also assess the recorded value of computer software for impairment on a regular basis by comparing the carrying value to the estimated future cash flows to be generated by the underlying software asset. There are inherent uncertainties in determining the expected useful life or cash flows to be generated from computer software. While we have not historically experienced significant changes in these estimates we could be subject to such changes in the future.
     Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets
     We are required to allocate the purchase price of acquired businesses to the assets acquired and liabilities assumed in the transaction at their estimated fair values. The estimates used to determine the fair value of long-lived assets, such as intangible assets, are complex and require a significant amount of management judgment. We generally engage independent valuation specialists to assist us in making fair value determinations. We are also required to estimate the useful lives of intangible assets to determine the amount of acquisition-related intangible asset amortization expense to record in future periods. We periodically review the estimated useful lives

20


Table of Contents

assigned to our definite-lived intangible assets to determine whether such estimated useful lives continue to be appropriate. Additionally we review our indefinite lived intangible assets to determine if there is any change in circumstances that may indicate the asset’s useful life is no longer indefinite.
     We review the carrying value of goodwill and indefinite-lived intangible assets for impairment annually and whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate the carrying value may not be recoverable in accordance with SFAS No. 142, Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets (“SFAS 142”). SFAS 142 requires us to perform a two-step impairment test on goodwill. First, we compare the fair value of each reporting unit to its carrying value. We determine the fair value of our reporting units based on the present value of estimated future cash flows. If the fair value of a reporting unit exceeds the carrying value of the unit’s net assets, goodwill is not impaired and further testing is not required. If the carrying value of the reporting unit’s net assets exceeds the fair value of the unit, then we perform the second step of the impairment test to determine the implied fair value of the reporting unit’s goodwill and any impairment charge. Additionally, we estimate the fair value of acquired intangible assets with indefinite lives and compare this amount to the underlying carrying value.
     Determining the fair value of a reporting unit or acquired intangible assets with indefinite lives involves judgment and the use of significant estimates and assumptions, which include assumptions regarding the revenue growth rates and operating margins used to calculate estimated future cash flows, risk-adjusted discount rates and future economic and market conditions and other assumptions. During the fourth quarter of 2008, immediately prior to our annual measurement date for impairment testing, our market capitalization declined to a point below our book value. Our annual impairment test indicated that no impairment has occurred, based on our assumptions of discounted future cash flows using our current best estimate of future performance. In December of 2008, upon the change in our reporting segments and in light of the fact that our market capitalization continued to remain below our book value, we performed new impairment tests on a segment basis and determined that no impairments existed.
     The Company has reconciled the aggregate estimated fair value of the reporting units to the market capitalization of the consolidated Company. We believe that the overall market conditions that existed at the measurement dates and continue to exist because of the financial crisis have led to a market capitalization well below the fair value of a controlling interest. Based on these factors, we concluded that the market capitalization does not represent the fair value of the Company.
     Our analysis of indefinite lived intangible assets did indicate an impairment of our check trademark. Accordingly we recorded a charge of $52.0 million to reduce the intangible asset’s carrying value to fair value (Note 11). Given the significance of our goodwill and intangible asset balances, an adverse change in fair value could result in an impairment charge, which could be material to our financial statements
     Accounting for Income Taxes
     As part of the process of preparing the Consolidated Financial Statements, we are required to determine income taxes in each of the jurisdictions in which we operate. This process involves estimating actual current tax expense together with assessing temporary differences resulting from differing recognition of items for income tax and accounting purposes. These differences result in deferred income tax assets and liabilities, which are included within the Consolidated Balance Sheets. We must then assess the likelihood that deferred income tax assets will be recovered from future taxable income and, to the extent we believe that recovery is not likely, establish a valuation allowance. To the extent we establish a valuation allowance or increase this allowance in a period, we must reflect this increase as an expense within income tax expense in the Statement of Earnings. Determination of the income tax expense requires estimates and can involve complex issues that may require an extended period to resolve. Further, changes in the geographic mix of revenues or in the estimated level of annual pre-tax income can cause the overall effective income tax rate to vary from period to period. We believe that our tax positions comply with applicable tax law and that we adequately provide for any known tax contingencies. We believe the estimates and assumptions used to support our evaluation of tax benefit realization are reasonable. However, final determination of prior-year tax liabilities, either by settlement with tax authorities or expiration of statutes of limitations, could be materially different than estimates reflected in assets and liabilities and historical income tax provisions. The outcome of these final determinations could have a material effect on our income tax provision, net income or cash flows in the period that determination is made.
Related Party Transactions
     We are a party to certain historical related party agreements with FNF, LPS and other related parties (see Note 5 to the Consolidated Financial Statements included in Item 8 of Part II of this Report).
Factors Affecting Comparability
     Our Consolidated Financial Statements included in this report that present our financial condition and operating results reflect the following significant transactions:

21


Table of Contents

    On July 2, 2008, we completed the LPS spin-off. The results of operations of the Lender Processing Services segment through the July 2, 2008 spin-off date are reflected as discontinued operations in the Consolidated Statements of Earnings, in accordance with SFAS 144, for all periods presented.
 
    On September 12, 2007, we acquired eFunds. eFunds provided risk management, EFT services, prepaid/gift card processing, and global outsourcing solutions to financial services companies in the U.S. and internationally. In connection with this acquisition, we borrowed an additional $1.6 billion under our bank credit facilities. The results of operations and financial position of eFunds are included in the Consolidated Financial Statements from and after the date of acquisition.
 
    On August 31, 2007, we completed the sale of one of our subsidiaries, Property Insight, to FNF, for $95.0 million in cash, realizing a pre-tax gain of $66.9 million ($42.1 million after-tax) which is reported as a discontinued operation in the consolidated statements of earnings in accordance with SFAS 144. Property Insight was a leading provider of title plant services to FNF, as well as to various national and regional title insurance underwriters. Property Insight primarily managed, maintained, and updated the title insurance plants that are owned by FNF.
 
    On April 25, 2007, the board of directors of Covansys entered into an agreement with Computer Sciences Corporation (“CSC”) under which CSC agreed to acquire Covansys for $34.00 per share in an all-cash transaction. The merger closed on July 3, 2007, and we exchanged our remaining 6.9 million shares of stock in Covansys for cash, and 4.0 million warrants for cash, per the terms of the merger agreement. We realized a pre-tax gain on sales of Covansys securities of $274.5 million in 2007.
 
    On February 1, 2006, we completed the Certegy Merger. The transaction resulted in a reverse acquisition with a total purchase price of approximately $2.2 billion. Certegy provided credit card, debit card, and other transaction processing and check risk management services to financial institutions and merchants in the U.S. and internationally through two segments, Card Services and Check Services.
     Although the legal entity that survived the Certegy Merger was Certegy (which has since been renamed Fidelity National Information Services, Inc.), for accounting purposes, our historical financial statements are those of FIS. Our Consolidated Financial Statements include the results of operations of Certegy from the date of the acquisition.
     As a result of the above transactions, the results of operations in the periods covered by the Consolidated Financial Statements may not be directly comparable.
Consolidated Results of Operations
(in millions, except per share amounts)
                         
    2008     2007     2006  
    (In millions, except per share amounts)  
Processing and services revenues
  $ 3,446.0     $ 2,921.0     $ 2,416.5  
Cost of revenues
    2,636.9       2,265.8       1,872.2  
 
                 
Gross profit
    809.1       655.2       544.3  
 
                 
Selling, general, and administrative expenses
    389.4       302.9       279.8  
Research and development costs
    84.8       70.4       70.9  
 
                 
Operating income
    334.9       281.9       193.6  
 
                 
Other income (expense):
                       
Interest income
    6.3       3.0       1.3  
Interest expense
    (163.5 )     (190.2 )     (190.9 )
Gain on sale of investment in Covansys
          274.5        
Other income (expense), net
    1.5       14.8       1.2  
 
                 
Total other income (expense)
    (155.7 )     102.1       (188.4 )
 
                 
Earnings before income taxes, equity in earnings of unconsolidated entities, minority interest, and discontinued operations
    179.2       384.0       5.2  
Provision for income taxes
    57.6       136.2       (2.9 )
 
                 
Earnings before equity in earnings of unconsolidated entities, minority interest, and discontinued operations
    121.6       247.8       8.1  
Equity in (losses) earnings of unconsolidated entities
    (0.2 )     2.8       5.8  
Minority interest (expense) income
    (4.0 )     0.1       1.7  
 
                 
Net earnings from continuing operations
    117.4       250.7       15.6  
Earnings from discontinued operations, net of tax
    97.4       310.5       243.5  
 
                 
Net earnings
  $ 214.8     $ 561.2     $ 259.1  
 
                 

22


Table of Contents

                         
    2008     2007     2006  
    (In millions, except per share amounts)  
Net earnings per share — basic from continuing operations
  $ 0.61     $ 1.30     $ 0.08  
Net earnings per share — basic from discontinued operations
    0.51       1.61       1.31  
 
                 
Net earnings per share — basic
  $ 1.12     $ 2.91     $ 1.39  
 
                 
Weighted average shares outstanding — basic
    191.6       193.1       185.9  
 
                 
Net earnings per share — diluted from continuing operations
  $ 0.61     $ 1.28     $ 0.08  
Net earnings per share — diluted from discontinued operations
    0.50       1.58       1.29  
 
                 
Net earnings per share — diluted
  $ 1.11     $ 2.86     $ 1.37  
 
                 
Weighted average shares outstanding — diluted
    193.5       196.5       189.2  
 
                 
     Processing and Services Revenues
     Processing and services revenues totaled $3,446.0 million, $2,921.0 million and $2,416.5 million in 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. The increase in revenue during 2008 of $525.0 million, or 18.0% as compared to 2007 is primarily attributable to the impact of the eFunds acquisition, which contributed year over year incremental revenues of $396.3 million. Additionally our Brazilian card processing venture, the “Brazilian Venture” had a year over year increase in revenue of $87.7 million. The increase in revenue in 2007 of $504.5 million as compared to 2006 is primarily attributable to revenue increases from the eFunds and Certegy acquisitions along with organic growth. The eFunds acquisition contributed revenues of $166.6 million from its September 12, 2007 completion date through December 31, 2007 and the Certegy Merger contributed one additional month of revenue in the 2007 period, or approximately $96.4 million, as compared to the full year 2006. The Brazilian Venture contributed $49.2 million to revenue growth in 2007, with other growth in international revenues comprising most of the year over year organic growth.
     Cost of Revenues and Gross Profit
     Cost of revenues totaled $2,636.9 million, $2,265.8 million and $1,872.2 million in 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively, resulting in gross profit of $809.1 million, $655.2 million and $544.3 million in 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. Gross profit as a percentage of revenues (“gross margin”) was 23.5%, 22.4% and 22.5% in 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. The increase in cost of revenues of $371.1 million in the 2008 period as compared to the 2007 period is directly attributable to revenue growth across our three operating segments. The increase in gross margin of 1.1% for 2008 over 2007 was driven by the growth of higher product margin sales and gained efficiencies relating to the integration of eFunds. The increase in cost of revenues of $393.6 million in the 2007 period as compared to the 2006 period was attributable to growth in our three operating segments primarily driven by the eFunds acquisition. The gross margin decreased slightly due to the costs associated with the eFunds acquisition including restructuring and integration as well as increased amortization expense relating to purchased intangibles.
     Selling, General and Administrative Expenses
     Selling, general and administrative expenses totaled $389.4 million, $302.9 million and $279.8 million for 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. The increase of $86.5 million in 2008 as compared to 2007 primarily relates to the incremental costs from the eFunds acquisition, as well as increased stock compensation costs, additional restructuring and integration charges, and charges associated with the LPS spin-off. Stock-based compensation increased from $24.9 million in 2007 to $51.6 million in 2008. The $26.7 million increase in stock-based compensation is mainly attributable to charges of $14.1 million for the accelerated vesting of all stock awards held by eFunds employees assumed in the eFunds acquisition and $2.6 million relating to the acceleration, upon termination, of certain unvested executive stock awards. The remaining increase is attributable to $21.0 million of additional restructuring and integration charges and $9.3 million in charges associated with the spin-off of LPS as compared to $6.0 million and $0.5 million respectively in 2007. The increase of $23.1 million in 2007 as compared to 2006 primarily resulted from the inclusion of $15.2 million of expenses relating to eFunds since its acquisition date, as well as one additional month of Certegy expenses.
     Research and Development Costs
     Research and development costs totaled $84.8 million, $70.4 million and $70.9 million for 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. The increase in research and development costs for 2008 as compared to 2007 is primarily related to the eFunds acquisition.
     Operating Income
     Operating income totaled $334.9 million, $281.9 million and $193.6 million for 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. Operating income as a percentage of revenue (“operating margin”) was 9.7%, 9.7% and 8.0% for 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. The increase in operating margin for 2007 as compared to 2006 is primarily attributable to the increased revenues and achievement of expense synergies relating to the Certegy Merger.

23


Table of Contents

     Interest Expense
     Interest expense totaled $163.5 million, $190.2 million and $190.9 million for 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. The decrease of $26.7 million in interest expense in 2008 as compared to 2007 is the result of a reduction of $1.6 billion in debt associated with the LPS spin-off on July 2, 2008 and the inclusion of $27.2 million in write-offs of capitalized debt issuance costs relating to our prior credit facility during 2007, partially offset by the write-off of $12.4 million in capitalized debt issuance costs associated with the Term Loan B retired in conjunction with the LPS spin-off in 2008. Additionally, the impact of our interest rate swaps, which has effectively fixed $2.1 billion of our debt at a rate of approximately 4.7%, offset the favorable decrease in borrowing rates under our credit facility. The decrease in 2007 as compared to 2006 was primarily the result of lower interest rates during 2007 partially offset by the inclusion of $27.2 million in write-offs of capitalized debt issuance costs relating to our prior credit facility.
     Provision for Income Taxes
     Income tax expense (benefit) from continuing operations totaled $57.6 million, $136.2 million and ($2.9) million for 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. This resulted in an effective tax rate on continuing operations of 32.1%, 35.5% and (55.2%) for 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. The decrease in tax expense for the 2008 period as compared to the 2007 period is attributable to the 2007 period including the gain on sale of Covansys common stock and warrants, partially offset by increased operating income in the 2008 period. The decrease in the 2008 overall effective tax rate is primarily related to state tax benefits and benefits related to research and development credits. The increase in tax expense for the 2007 period as compared to a tax benefit in 2006 is attributable to the gain on sale of Covansys common stock and warrants and increased operating income in the 2007 period. The 2006 year included certain favorable permanent book/tax differences and proportionately higher foreign income taxed at overall lower rates.
     Net Earnings from Continuing Operations
     Net earnings from continuing operations totaled $117.4 million, $250.7 million and $15.6 million for 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively, or $0.61, $1.28 and $0.08 per diluted share, respectively. The decrease in net earnings in 2008 is primarily the result of 2007 including an after tax gain of $172.9 million, or $0.88 per diluted share, from the sale of Covansys common stock and warrants, partially offset by the inclusion of eFunds for the full year 2008 as compared to the period from its acquisition date September 12, 2007 through December 31, 2007.
Segment Results of Operations
Financial Solutions
(in millions)
                         
    2008     2007     2006  
Processing and services revenues
  $ 1,158.8     $ 1,007.6     $ 882.2  
 
                 
Operating income
  $ 355.1     $ 203.1     $ 181.4  
 
                 
     Revenues for the Financial Solutions segment totaled $1,158.8 million, $1,007.6 million and $882.2 million for 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. The overall segment increase of $151.2 million in 2008 as compared to 2007 resulted primarily from the impact of the eFunds acquisition that occurred on September 12, 2007 and organic growth within our existing business. Incremental revenue from the eFunds acquisition contributed a year over year increase of $143.3 million. The overall segment increase of $125.4 million for 2007 as compared to 2006 was primarily attributable to organic growth of 7.9% and incremental revenue from the eFunds acquisition of $56.1 million.
     Operating income for the Financial Solutions segment totaled $355.1 million, $203.1 million and $181.4 million for 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. Operating margin was approximately 31%, 20% and 21% for 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. The increase in 2008 as compared to 2007 primarily resulted from increased operating margins due to targeted cost reductions coupled with the relatively higher margin on the additional revenues from eFunds. The increase in 2007 as compared to 2006 was primarily due to the eFunds acquisition.
Payment Solutions
(in millions)
                         
    2008     2007     2006  
Processing and services revenues
  $ 1,530.2     $ 1,298.8     $ 1,120.5  
 
                 
Operating income
  $ 347.8     $ 291.8     $ 253.9  
 
                 

24


Table of Contents

     Revenues for the Payment Solutions segment totaled $1,530.2 million, $1,298.8 million and $1,120.5 million for 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. The overall segment increase of $231.4 million in 2008 as compared to 2007 resulted primarily from the impact of the eFunds acquisition, which contributed year over year incremental revenue of $210.5 million. The overall segment increase of $178.3 million in 2007 as compared to 2006 resulted principally from organic growth of 8.0% and year over year growth from the eFunds acquisition of $88.9 million.
     Operating income for the Payment Solutions segment totaled $347.8 million, $291.8 million and $253.9 million for 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. Operating margin was approximately 23% for all three years, thus the year over year increases results from the margin on the incremental revenues.
International
(in millions)
                         
    2008     2007     2006  
Processing and services revenues
  $ 759.5     $ 618.1     $ 430.3  
 
                 
Operating income
  $ 49.5     $ 44.7     $ 38.3  
 
                 
     Revenues for the International segment totaled $759.5 million, $618.1 million and $430.3 million for 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. The overall segment increase of $141.4 million in 2008 as compared to 2007 resulted principally from increased revenue in our Brazilian Venture and incremental revenues due to the eFunds acquisition, partially offset by unfavorable currency effects of $28.2 million. The Brazilian Venture had a year over year increase in revenues of $87.7 million and the eFunds acquisition contributed year over year incremental revenue of $41.5 million. The overall segment increase of $187.8 million in 2007 as compared to 2006 was the result of a $56.4 million increase in financial solutions revenue and a $131.4 million increase in payment solutions revenue. The majority of the $56.4 million increase in financial solutions revenue was due to organic growth, principally in Germany. Of the $131.4 million increase in payment solutions revenue, $58.3 million was due to growth in credit cards principally due to growth in the Brazilian Venture, $40.5 million was due to the addition of the BPO business in Brazil, $8.9 million was due to organic growth in other regions and $23.7 million was due to incremental revenue from the eFunds acquisition.
     Operating income for the International segment totaled $49.5 million, $44.7 million and $38.3 million for 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. Operating margin was 7%, 7% and 9% for 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. The increase in operating income in 2008, as compared to 2007, as well as 2007 as compared to 2006, primarily results from margins on the incremental revenues.
     Corporate and Other
     The Corporate and Other segment results consist of selling, general and administrative expenses and depreciation and intangible asset amortization not otherwise allocated to the reportable segments. Corporate and Other expenses were $417.5 million, $257.7 million and $280.0 million in 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. The overall Corporate and Other increase of $159.8 million for 2008 as compared to 2007 is attributable to the effect of incremental expenses related to the eFunds acquisition, additional stock compensation expense, incremental restructuring and integration charges and costs associated with the LPS spin-off. Stock-based compensation increased from $24.9 million in 2007 to $51.6 million in 2008. The $26.7 million increase in stock-based compensation is mainly attributable to charges of $14.1 million for the accelerated vesting of all stock awards held by eFunds employees assumed in the eFunds acquisition and $2.6 million relating to the acceleration, upon termination, of certain unvested executive stock awards. Intangible asset amortization increased $46.6 million as compared to 2007 primarily relating to the eFunds acquisition coupled with an impairment charge of $26.0 million related to a decline in the fair value of the retail check guarantee business. Corporate expenses also include $21.0 million of restructuring and integration charges and $9.3 million in costs associated with the LPS spin-off.
     The overall corporate and other decrease of $22.3 million for 2007 as compared to 2006 is primarily attributable to a decrease in administrative costs due to cost reduction targets related to the integration of Certegy.
Liquidity and Capital Resources
Cash Requirements
Our cash requirements include cost of revenues, selling, general and administrative expenses, income taxes, debt service payments, capital expenditures, systems development expenditures, stockholder dividends, and business acquisitions. Our principal sources of funds are cash generated by operations and borrowings.
     At December 31, 2008, we had cash on hand of $220.9 million and debt of approximately $2,514.5 million, including the current portion. Of the $220.9 million cash on hand, approximately $139.8 million is held by our operations in foreign jurisdictions. We

25


Table of Contents

expect that cash flows from operations over the next twelve months will be sufficient to fund our operating cash requirements and pay principal and interest on our outstanding debt absent any unusual circumstances such as acquisitions or adverse changes in the business environment.
     We currently pay a $0.05 dividend on a quarterly basis, and expect to continue to do so in the future. The declaration and payment of future dividends is at the discretion of the Board of Directors and depends on, among other things, our investment policy and opportunities, results of operations, financial condition, cash requirements, future prospects, and other factors that may be considered relevant by our Board of Directors, including legal and contractual restrictions. Additionally, the payment of cash dividends may be limited by covenants in certain debt agreements. A regular quarterly dividend of $0.05 per common share is payable March 30, 2009 to shareholders of record as of the close of business on March 16, 2009.
Cash Flows from Operations
     Cash flows from operations were $596.4 million, $463.5 million and $494.7 million in 2008, 2007 and 2006 respectively. Included in the 2007 period cash flow from operations were payments of $106.6 million of tax liability relating to the gain on Covansys and a $47.5 million reduction in taxes payable due to stock option exercises. Included in 2006 cash flow from operations was a $26.9 million reduction in taxes payable due to stock option exercises.
Capital Expenditures
     Our principal capital expenditures are for computer software (purchased and internally developed) and additions to property and equipment. In 2008, we spent approximately $255.4 million on capital expenditures, including approximately $25.0 million related to LPS prior to the spin-off. In 2009 we expect to spend approximately 5% to 7% of 2009 revenue on capital expenditures.
Financing
     On January 18, 2007, we entered into a credit agreement with JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as Administrative Agent, Swing Line Lender, and Letter of Credit Issuer, Bank of America, N.A., as Swing Line Lender, and other financial institutions party thereto (the “Credit Agreement”). The Credit Agreement replaced our prior term loans and revolver as well as a $100 million settlement facility. As a result of the new credit agreement, we repaid the old credit agreement and recorded a charge of $27.2 million to write-off unamortized capitalized debt issuance costs. The Credit Agreement, which became secured as of September 12, 2007, provides for a committed $2.1 billion five-year term facility denominated in U.S. Dollars (the “Term Loan A”) and a committed $900 million revolving credit facility (the “Revolving Loan”) with a sublimit of $250 million for letters of credit and a sublimit of $250 million for swing line loans, maturing on the fifth anniversary of the closing date, January 18, 2012 (the “Maturity Date”). The Revolving Loan is bifurcated into a $735 million multicurrency revolving credit loan (the “Multicurrency Tranche”) that can be denominated in any combination of U.S. Dollars, Euro, British Pounds Sterling and Australian Dollars, and any other foreign currency in which the relevant lenders agree to make advances and a $165 million U.S. Dollar revolving credit loan that can be denominated only in U.S. Dollars. The swingline loans and letters of credit are available as a sublimit under the Multicurrency Tranche. In addition, the Credit Agreement originally provided for an uncommitted incremental loan facility in the maximum principal amount of $600 million, which would be made available only upon receipt of further commitments from lenders under the Credit Agreement sufficient to fund the amount requested by us. On July 30, 2007, we, along with the requisite lenders, executed an amendment to the existing Credit Agreement to facilitate our acquisition of eFunds. The amendment permitted the issuance of up to $2.1 billion in additional loans, an increase from the foregoing $600 million. The amendment became effective September 12, 2007. On September 12, 2007, we entered into a joinder agreement to obtain a secured $1.6 billion tranche of term loans denominated in U.S. Dollars (the “Term Loan B”) under the Credit Agreement, utilizing $1.6 billion of the $2.1 billion uncommitted incremental loan amount. The Term Loan B proceeds were used to finance the eFunds Acquisition, and pay related fees and expenses. On July 2, 2008, we completed the spin-off of our former Lender Processing Services segment into a separate publicly traded company, Lender Processing Services, Inc., referred to as LPS. In conjunction with the LPS spin-off, we immediately retired the outstanding $1,585.0 million principal balance of the Term Loan B. Debt issuance costs of $9.1 million are capitalized as of December 31, 2008. The $12.4 million remaining balance of Term Loan B debt issuance costs were written-off during July 2008 in conjunction with the LPS spin-off and retirement of the Term Loan B.
     As of December 31, 2008, the Term Loan A balance was $1,995.0 million and a total of $499.4 million was outstanding under the Revolving Loan. The obligations under the Credit Agreement have been jointly and severally, unconditionally guaranteed by certain of our domestic subsidiaries. Additionally, we and certain subsidiary guarantors pledged certain equity interests in other entities (including certain of our direct and indirect subsidiaries) as collateral security for the obligations under the credit facility and the guarantee.

26


Table of Contents

     We may borrow, repay and re-borrow amounts under the Revolving Loan from time to time until the maturity of the Revolving Loan. We must make quarterly principal payments under the Term Loan A in scheduled installments of: (a) $13.1 million per quarter from June 30, 2007 through December 31, 2008; (b) $26.3 million per quarter from March 31, 2009 through December 31, 2009; and (c) $52.5 million per quarter from March 31, 2010 through September 30, 2011, with the remaining balance of approximately $1.5 billion payable on the Maturity Date.
     In addition to the scheduled principal payments, the Term Loan is (with certain exceptions) subject to mandatory prepayment upon issuances of debt, casualty and condemnation events, and sales of assets, as well as from a percentage of excess cash flow (as defined in the Credit Agreement) between zero and fifty percent commencing with the cash flow for the year ended December 31, 2008. No mandatory prepayments were owed for the year ended December 31, 2008. Voluntary prepayment of the Loan is generally permitted at any time without fee upon proper notice and subject to a minimum dollar requirement. Commitment reductions of the Revolving Loan are also permitted at any time without fee upon proper notice. The Revolving Loan has no scheduled principal payments, but it will be due and payable in full on the Maturity Date.
     The outstanding balance on the Loans bears interest at a floating rate, which is an applicable margin plus, at our option, either (a) the Eurocurrency (LIBOR) rate or (b) either (i) the federal funds rate or (ii) the prime rate. The applicable margin is subject to adjustment based on a leverage ratio (our total indebtedness to our consolidated total EBITDA in our consolidated subsidiaries, as further defined in the Credit Agreement). Alternatively, we have the ability to request the lenders to submit competitive bids for one or more advances under the Revolving Loan.
     The Credit Agreement contains affirmative, negative and financial covenants customary for financings of this type, including, among other things, limits on the creation of liens, limits on the incurrence of indebtedness, restrictions on investments and dispositions, a prohibition on the payment of dividends and other restricted payments if an event of default has occurred and is continuing or would result therefrom, a minimum interest coverage ratio and a maximum leverage ratio. Upon an event of default, the Administrative Agent can accelerate the maturity of the Loans. Events of default include conditions customary for such an agreement, including failure to pay principal and interest in a timely manner and breach of certain covenants. These events of default include a cross-default provision that permits the lenders to declare the Credit Agreement in default if (i) we fail to make any payment after the applicable grace period under any indebtedness with a principal amount in excess of $150 million or (ii) we fail to perform any other term under any such indebtedness, as a result of which the holders thereof may cause it to become due and payable prior to its maturity. We were in compliance with all covenants related to the Credit Agreement at December 31, 2008.
     As of December 31, 2008, we have entered into interest rate swap transactions converting a portion of the interest rate exposure on our Term and Revolving Loans from variable to fixed (see Item 7A).
Contractual Obligations
     FIS’ long-term contractual obligations generally include its long-term debt and operating lease payments on certain of its property and equipment. The following table summarizes FIS’ significant contractual obligations and commitments as of December 31, 2008 (in millions):
                                                         
    2009   2010   2011   2012   2013   Thereafter   Total
Long-term debt
  $ 105.5     $ 210.0     $ 157.5     $ 2,041.5     $     $     $ 2,514.5  
Interest
    133.4       100.0       87.6       4.1                   325.1  
Operating leases
    62.9       47.4       31.4       18.6       13.2       27.1       200.6  
Data processing and maintenance and purchase commitments
    138.4       93.6       68.2       54.0       52.0       177.8       584.0  
                             
Total
  $ 440.2     $ 451.0     $ 344.7     $ 2,118.2     $ 65.2     $ 204.9     $ 3,624.2  
                             
     FIS believes that its existing cash balances, cash flows from operations and borrowing programs will provide adequate sources of liquidity and capital resources to meet FIS’ expected short-term liquidity needs and its long-term needs for the operations of its business, expected capital spending for the next 12 months and the foreseeable future and the satisfaction of these obligations and commitments.
Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements
     FIS does not have any material off-balance sheet arrangements other than operating leases.
Recent Accounting Pronouncements

27


Table of Contents

     In June 2008, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (FASB) issued FASB Staff Position (FSP) Emerging Issues Task Force 03-6-1, Determining Whether Instruments Granted in Share-Based Payment Transactions Are Participating Securities, which will become effective for periods beginning on or after December 15, 2008, and will be applied retrospectively. Under the FSP, unvested share-based payment awards that contain non-forfeitable rights to dividends or dividend equivalents are participating securities and, therefore, are included in computing earnings per share (EPS) pursuant to the two-class method. The two-class method determines earnings per share for each class of common stock and participating securities according to dividends or dividend equivalents and their respective participation rights in undistributed earnings. Adoption of FSP Emerging Issues Task Force 03-6-1 will not have a material impact on the Company’s financial position or results of its operations.
     In May 2008, the FASB issued SFAS No. 162, The Hierarchy of Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (“SFAS 162”). SFAS 162 identifies the sources of accounting principles and the framework for selecting the principles to be used in the preparation of financial statements of nongovernmental entities that are presented in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles in the United States. The FASB has concluded that the generally accepted accounting principles hierarchy should reside in the accounting literature established by the FASB and issued SFAS 162 to achieve that result. SFAS 162 was effective on November 15, 2008. The adoption of SFAS 162 did not have a material effect on the Company’s financial condition or results of its operations.
     In March 2008, the FASB issued SFAS No. 161, Disclosures about Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities-an amendment of FASB Statement No. 133. (“SFAS 161”). SFAS 161 expands the current disclosure requirements of SFAS No. 133, Accounting for Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities, (“SFAS 133”) such that entities must now provide enhanced disclosures on a quarterly basis regarding how and why the entity uses derivatives, how derivatives and related hedged items are accounted for under SFAS 133, and how derivatives and related hedged items affect the entity’s financial position, performance and cash flow. Pursuant to the transition provisions of the Statement, the Company will adopt SFAS 161 in fiscal year 2009 and will present the required disclosures in the prescribed format on a prospective basis. SFAS 161 will not impact the consolidated financial results as it is disclosure-only in nature.
     In December 2007, the FASB issued SFAS No. 160, Noncontrolling Interests in Consolidated Financial Statements — an amendment of ARB No. 51 (“SFAS 160”), requiring noncontrolling interests (sometimes called minority interests) to be presented as a component of equity on the balance sheet. SFAS 160 also requires that the amount of net earnings attributable to the parent and to the noncontrolling interests be clearly identified and presented on the face of the Consolidated Statement of Earnings. This Statement eliminates the need to apply purchase accounting when a parent company acquires a noncontrolling ownership interest in a subsidiary and requires that, upon deconsolidation of a subsidiary, a parent company recognize a gain or loss in net earnings after which any retained noncontrolling interest will be reported at fair value. SFAS 160 requires expanded disclosures in the Consolidated Financial Statements that identify and distinguish between the interests of the parent’s owners and the interest of the noncontrolling owners of subsidiaries. SFAS 160 is effective for periods beginning on or after December 15, 2008 and will be applied prospectively except for the presentation and disclosure requirements, which will be applied retrospectively for all periods presented. Adoption of SFAS 160 will not have a material effect on the Company’s statements of operations. Upon adoption of SFAS 160 the non controlling or minority interest ($164.2 million at December 31, 2008) will be reclassified to a component of equity.
     In December 2007, the FASB issued SFAS No. 141 (revised 2007), Business Combinations (“SFAS 141(R)”), requiring an acquirer in a business combination to recognize the assets acquired, the liabilities assumed, and any noncontrolling interest in the acquiree at their fair values at the acquisition date, with limited exceptions. The costs of the acquisition and any related restructuring costs will be recognized separately. Assets and liabilities arising from contingencies in a business combination are to be recognized at their fair value at the acquisition date and adjusted prospectively as new information becomes available. When the fair value of assets acquired exceeds the fair value of consideration transferred plus any noncontrolling interest in the acquiree, the excess will be recognized as a gain. Under SFAS 141(R), all business combinations will be accounted for prospectively by applying the acquisition method, including combinations among mutual entities and combinations by contract alone. SFAS 141(R) is effective for periods beginning on or after December 15, 2008, and will apply to business combinations occurring after the effective date. The Company will adopt SFAS 141R and apply its provisions to business combinations subsequent to December 31, 2008.
     In September 2006, the FASB issued SFAS No. 157, Fair Value Measurements (“SFAS 157”). SFAS 157 defines fair value, establishes a framework for measuring fair value, and expands disclosures about fair value measurements by establishing a fair value hierarchy based on the quality of inputs used to measure fair value. SFAS 157 does not require any new fair value measurements, but applies under other accounting pronouncements that require or permit fair value measurements. SFAS 157 is effective for financial statements for fiscal years beginning after November 15, 2007. The Company adopted SFAS 157 as of January 1, 2008. Items in our Consolidated Financial Statements for which SFAS 157 is already effective are discussed in the Financing section of Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations.
     In February 2008, the FASB issued FASB Staff Position SFAS No. 157-2, Effective Date of FASB Statement No. 157, which delays the effective date of SFAS 157 with respect to nonfinancial assets and nonfinancial liabilities that are not remeasured at fair value on a recurring basis until fiscal years beginning after November 15, 2008. Accordingly, the Company has not yet applied the

28


Table of Contents

disclosure requirements of SFAS 157 to certain such nonfinancial assets for which fair value measurements are determined on a non-recurring basis only when there is an indication of potential impairment.
     The fair value hierarchy established by SFAS 157 includes three levels which are based on the priority of the inputs to the valuation technique. The fair value hierarchy gives the highest priority to quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities (Level 1) and the lowest priority to unobservable inputs (Level 3). If the inputs used to measure the financial instruments fall within different levels of the hierarchy, the categorization is based on the lowest level input that is significant to the fair value measurement of the instrument. In accordance with SFAS 157, our financial assets and liabilities that are recorded on the Consolidated Balance Sheets are categorized based on the inputs to the valuation techniques as follows:
Level 1. Financial assets and liabilities whose values are based on unadjusted quoted prices for identical assets or liabilities in an active market that we have the ability to access.
Level 2. Financial assets and liabilities whose values are based on quoted prices in markets that are not active or model inputs that are observable either directly or indirectly for substantially the full term of the asset or liability.
Level 3. Financial assets and liabilities whose values are based on model inputs that are unobservable.
Item 7A. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosure About Market Risks
Market Risk
     We are exposed to market risks primarily from changes in interest rates and foreign currency exchange rates. In managing exposure to these fluctuations, we may engage in various hedging transactions that have been authorized according to documented policies and procedures. On a limited basis, we use certain derivative financial instruments, including interest rate swaps, to manage these risks. We do not use derivatives for trading purposes, to generate income or to engage in speculative activity. Our capital costs are directly linked to financial and business risks. We seek to manage the potential negative effects from market volatility and market risk. It is our policy to manage our debt structure in order to manage capital costs, control financial risks and maintain financial flexibility over the long term.
Interest Rate Risk
     We have issued debt in floating rate instruments. Interest rate swaps are used for the purpose of controlling interest expense by managing the mix of fixed and floating rate debt. We do not seek to make a profit from changes in interest rates. We manage interest rate sensitivity by measuring potential increases in interest expense that would result from a probable change in interest rates. When the potential increase in interest expense exceeds an acceptable amount, we reduce risk through the purchase of derivatives.
     As of December 31, 2008, we are paying interest on the Revolving Loan at LIBOR plus 0.70% and at LIBOR plus 0.88% on our Term Loan A. A one percent increase in the LIBOR rate would increase our annual debt service on the Credit Agreement by $3.9 million (based on principal amounts outstanding at December 31, 2008, net of interest rate swaps). The credit rating assigned to FIS by Standard & Poor’s was BB+ at December 31, 2008.
     We have entered into the following interest rate swap transactions converting a portion of the interest rate exposure on our Term and Revolving Loans from variable to fixed (in millions):
                         
                Bank Pays   FIS pays  
Effective Date   Termination Date   Notional Amount     Variable Rate of(1)   Fixed Rate of(2)  
October 11, 2007
  October 11, 2009   $ 1,000.0     1 Month Libor     4.73 %
December 11, 2007
  December 11, 2009     250.0     1 Month Libor     3.80 %
April 11, 2007
  April 11, 2010     850.0     1 Month Libor     4.92 %
 
                     
 
      $ 2,100.0              
 
                     
 
(1)   1.64% in effect at December 31, 2008 under the agreements.
 
(2)   In addition to the fixed rates paid under the swaps, we pay an applicable margin to our bank lenders on the Term Loan A of 0.88% and the Revolving Loan of 0.70% (plus a facility fee of 0.18%) as of December 31, 2008.

29


Table of Contents

     We are subject to foreign exchange risk for foreign currency-denominated transactions, such as debt issued, recognized payables and receivables and forecasted transactions. Changes in foreign currency exchange rates also affect translations of revenues denominated in currencies other than U.S. Dollars. Our international operations generated approximately $760.0 million in revenues in 2008, of which approximately $614.0 million was denominated in currencies other than the U.S. Dollar. The major currencies that we are exposed to are the Brazilian Real, the Euro and the British Pound Sterling. A 5% move in average exchange rates for these currencies would have had the following effect on 2008 reported revenues:
         
    Impact on  
    Revenues in U.S.  
Currency   Dollars (millions)  
Real
  $ 13.0  
Euro
    10.0  
Pound Sterling
    4.0  
 
     
Total Impact
  $ 27.0  
 
     
     In the future, we may enter into agreements to hedge our risks against foreign currency movements, but historically we have not entered into any such agreements. However, any hedging strategies may not be successful, and any future un-hedged foreign exchange payments could be subject to market fluctuations.

30


Table of Contents

Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data
FIDELITY NATIONAL INFORMATION SERVICES, INC.
AND SUBSIDIARIES
INDEX TO FINANCIAL INFORMATION
         
    Page
    Number
    32  
    33  
    34  
    35  
    36  
    37  
    38  
    39  

31


Table of Contents

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
The Board of Directors and Stockholders
Fidelity National Information Services, Inc.:
     We have audited Fidelity National Information Services, Inc.’s and subsidiaries’ (the “Company”) internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2008, based on criteria established in Internal Control — Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO). The Company’s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying Management’s Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audit.
     We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, and testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk. Our audit also included performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.
     A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.
     Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.
     In our opinion, Fidelity National Information Services, Inc. and subsidiaries maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2008, based on criteria established in Internal Control — Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission.
     We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the consolidated balance sheets of Fidelity National Information Services, Inc. and subsidiaries as of December 31, 2008 and 2007, and the related consolidated statements of earnings, stockholders’ equity, cash flows, and comprehensive earnings for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2008, and our report dated February 27, 2009 expressed an unqualified opinion on those consolidated financial statements.
/s/ KPMG LLP
February 27, 2009
Jacksonville, Florida
Certified Public Accountants

32


Table of Contents

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
The Board of Directors and Stockholders
Fidelity National Information Services, Inc.:
     We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Fidelity National Information Services, Inc. and subsidiaries (the “Company”) as of December 31, 2008 and 2007, and the related consolidated statements of earnings, stockholders’ equity, cash flows and comprehensive earnings for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2008. These consolidated financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these consolidated financial statements based on our audits.
     We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.
     In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Fidelity National Information Services, Inc. and Subsidiaries as of December 31, 2008 and 2007, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2008, in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles.
     We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Accounting Oversight Board (United States), Fidelity National Information Services, Inc.’s and subsidiaries’ internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2008, based on criteria established in Internal Control — Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO), and our report dated February 27, 2009 expressed an unqualified opinion on the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting.
     As discussed in notes 1 and 4 to the consolidated financial statements, the Company completed a spin-off of its Lender Processing Services segment on July 2, 2008.
/s/ KPMG LLP
February 27, 2009
Jacksonville, Florida
Certified Public Accountants

33


Table of Contents

FIDELITY NATIONAL INFORMATION SERVICES, INC.
AND SUBSIDIARIES
Consolidated Balance Sheets
December 31, 2008 and 2007
                 
    2008     2007  
    (In millions, except per share  
    amounts)  
ASSETS
               
Current assets:
               
Cash and cash equivalents
  $ 220.9     $ 355.3  
Settlement deposits
    31.4       21.2  
Trade receivables, net
    538.1       825.9  
Settlement receivables
    52.1       116.9  
Other receivables
    121.1       206.7  
Receivable from related party
    10.1       14.9  
Prepaid expenses and other current assets
    115.1       168.5  
Deferred income taxes
    91.0       120.1  
 
           
Total current assets
    1,179.8       1,829.5  
 
           
Property and equipment, net
    272.6       392.5  
Goodwill
    4,194.0       5,326.8  
Intangible assets, net
    924.3       1,030.6  
Computer software, net
    617.0       775.2  
Deferred contract costs
    241.2       256.9  
Investment in unconsolidated entities
          30.5  
Long term note receivable from FNF
    5.5       6.1  
Other noncurrent assets
    79.6       146.5  
 
           
Total assets
  $ 7,514.0     $ 9,794.6  
 
           
 
               
LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY
               
Current liabilities:
               
Accounts payable and accrued liabilities
  $ 480.5     $ 606.2  
Settlement payables
    83.3       129.8  
Current portion of long-term debt
    105.5       272.0  
Deferred revenues
    182.9       246.2  
 
           
Total current liabilities
    852.2       1,254.2  
 
           
Deferred revenues
    86.7       111.9  
Deferred income taxes
    346.3       395.0  
Long-term debt, excluding current portion
    2,409.0       4,003.4  
Other long-term liabilities
    122.8       234.7  
 
           
Total liabilities
    3,817.0       5,999.2  
 
           
Minority interest
    164.2       14.2  
 
           
Stockholders’ equity:
               
Preferred stock $0.01 par value; 200 million shares authorized, none issued and outstanding at December 31, 2008 and 2007
           
Common stock $0.01 par value; 600 million shares authorized, 200.2 million and 199.0 million shares issued at December 31, 2008 and 2007, respectively
    2.0       2.0  
Additional paid in capital
    2,959.8       3,038.2  
Retained earnings
    1,076.1       899.5  
Accumulated other comprehensive earnings
    (102.3 )     53.4  
Treasury stock, $0.01 par value, 9.3 million and 4.3 million shares at December 31, 2008 and 2007, respectively
    (402.8 )     (211.9 )
 
           
Total stockholders’ equity
    3,532.8       3,781.2  
 
           
Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity
  $ 7,514.0     $ 9,794.6  
 
           
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

34


Table of Contents

FIDELITY NATIONAL INFORMATION SERVICES, INC.
AND SUBSIDIARIES
Consolidated Statements of Earnings
Years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006
                         
    2008     2007     2006  
    (In millions, except per share amounts)  
Processing and services revenues (note 5)
  $ 3,446.0     $ 2,921.0     $ 2,416.5  
Cost of revenues (note 5)
    2,636.9       2,265.8       1,872.2  
 
                 
Gross profit
    809.1       655.2       544.3  
 
                 
Selling, general, and administrative expenses (note 5)
    389.4       302.9       279.8  
Research and development costs
    84.8       70.4       70.9  
 
                 
Operating income
    334.9       281.9       193.6  
 
                 
Other income (expense):
                       
Interest income
    6.3       3.0       1.3  
Interest expense
    (163.5 )     (190.2 )     (190.9 )
Gain on sale of investment in Covansys
          274.5        
Other income, net
    1.5       14.8       1.2  
 
                 
Total other income (expense)
    (155.7 )     102.1       (188.4 )
 
                 
Earnings before income taxes, equity in earnings of unconsolidated entities, minority interest, and discontinued operations
    179.2       384.0       5.2  
Provision for income taxes
    57.6       136.2       (2.9 )
 
                 
Earnings before equity in earnings of unconsolidated entities, minority interest, and discontinued operations
    121.6       247.8       8.1  
Equity in earnings of unconsolidated entities
    (0.2 )     2.8       5.8  
Minority interest
    (4.0 )     0.1       1.7  
 
                 
Net earnings from continuing operations
    117.4       250.7       15.6  
Earnings from discontinued operations, net of tax
    97.4       310.5       243.5  
 
                 
Net earnings
  $ 214.8     $ 561.2     $ 259.1  
 
                 
Net earnings per share — basic from continuing operations
  $ 0.61     $ 1.30     $ 0.08  
Net earnings per share — basic from discontinued operations
    0.51       1.61       1.31  
 
                 
Net earnings per share — basic
  $ 1.12     $ 2.91     $ 1.39  
 
                 
Weighted average shares outstanding — basic
    191.6       193.1       185.9  
 
                 
Net earnings per share — diluted from continuing operations
  $ 0.61     $ 1.28     $ 0.08  
Net earnings per share — diluted from discontinued operations
    0.50       1.58       1.29  
 
                 
Net earnings per share — diluted
  $ 1.11     $ 2.86     $ 1.37  
 
                 
Weighted average shares outstanding — diluted
    193.5       196.5       189.2  
 
                 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

35


Table of Contents

FIDELITY NATIONAL INFORMATION SERVICES, INC.
AND SUBSIDIARIES
Consolidated Statements of Stockholders’ Equity
Years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006
                                                                 
                    Amount  
                                            Accumulated                
                                            Other                
    Number of Shares             Additional             Comprehensive             Total  
    Common     Treasury     Common     Paid In     Retained     Earnings     Treasury     Stockholders’  
    Shares     Shares     Stock     Capital     Earnings     (Loss)     Stock     Equity  
    (In millions)  
Balances, December 31, 2005
    127.9           $ 1.3     $ 545.7     $ 156.1     $ (8.5 )   $     $ 694.6  
Net Earnings
                            259.1                   259.1  
Pension liability adjustment
                                  11.6             11.6  
Certegy acquisition
    69.5       (6.0 )     0.7       2,173.1                         2,173.8  
Exercise of stock options
          3.6             70.4                         70.4  
Tax benefit associated with exercise of stock options
                      26.9                         26.9  
Stock-based compensation
                      50.1                         50.1  
Cash dividends declared ($0.20 per share)
                            (38.2 )                 (38.2 )
National NY contribution from FNF
                      10.7                         10.7  
FNF Capital merger
          0.3             2.3                         2.3  
Purchases of treasury stock
          (4.3 )                             (160.5 )     (160.5 )
Unrealized gain on investments and derivatives, net
                                  12.4             12.4  
Unrealized gain on foreign currency translation
                                  29.5             29.5  
 
                                               
Balances, December 31, 2006
    197.4       (6.4 )   $ 2.0     $ 2,879.2     $ 377.0     $ 45.0     $ (160.5 )   $ 3,142.7  
 
                                               
Net Earnings
                            561.2                   561.2  
Pension liability adjustment
                                  (2.2 )           (2.2 )
Effect of fair valuing stock options assumed in the eFunds acquisition
                      37.7                         37.7  
Espiel, Inc. acquisition
    0.1                   6.0                         6.0  
Exercise of stock options
    1.5       3.7             28.8                   28.9       57.7  
Tax benefit associated with exercise of stock options
                      47.5                         47.5  
Stock-based compensation
                      39.0                         39.0  
Cash dividends declared ($0.20 per share)
                            (38.7 )                 (38.7 )
Purchases of treasury stock
          (1.6 )                             (80.3 )     (80.3 )
Unrealized loss on investments and derivatives, net
                                  (35.3 )           (35.3 )
Unrealized gain on foreign currency translation
                                  45.9             45.9  
 
                                               
Balances, December 31, 2007
    199.0       (4.3 )   $ 2.0     $ 3,038.2     $ 899.5     $ 53.4     $ (211.9 )   $ 3,781.2  
 
                                               
Net Earnings
                            214.8                   214.8  
Pension liability adjustment
                                  (4.0 )           (4.0 )
LPS spin-off
                      (105.0 )                       (105.0 )
Issuance of restricted stock
    1.2                                            
Exercise of stock options
          1.1             (26.0 )                 45.2       19.2  
Stock-based compensation
                      60.7                         60.7  
Cash dividends declared ($0.20 per share)
                            (38.2 )                 (38.2 )
Purchases of treasury stock
          (6.1 )                             (236.1 )     (236.1 )
Unrealized loss on investments and derivatives, net
                                  (27.9 )           (27.9 )
Unrealized loss on foreign currency translation
                                  (123.8 )           (123.8 )
Other
                      (8.1 )                       (8.1 )
 
                                               
Balances, December 31, 2008
    200.2       (9.3 )   $ 2.0     $ 2,959.8     $ 1,076.1     $ (102.3 )   $ (402.8 )   $ 3,532.8  
 
                                               
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

36


Table of Contents

FIDELITY NATIONAL INFORMATION SERVICES, INC.
AND SUBSIDIARIES
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows
Years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006
                         
    2008     2007     2006  
            (In millions)          
Cash flows from operating activities:
                       
Net earnings
  $ 214.8     $ 561.2     $ 259.1  
Adjustment to reconcile net earnings to net cash provided by operating activities:
                       
Depreciation and amortization
    465.4       496.8       433.6  
Amortization of debt issue costs
    16.8       30.6       5.3  
Gain on sale of Covansys stock
          (274.5 )      
Gain on sale of Property Insight
          (66.9 )      
Loss (gain) on sale of other assets
    33.6       (4.8 )      
Gain on pension settlement
          (12.1 )      
Stock-based compensation
    60.7       39.0       50.1  
Deferred income taxes
    35.6       17.9       11.6  
Income tax benefit from exercise of stock options
          (47.5 )     (26.9 )
Equity in earnings of unconsolidated entities
    2.3       (0.9 )     (5.8 )
Minority interest
    2.8       2.2       0.2  
Changes in assets and liabilities, net of effects from acquisitions:
                       
Net (increase) decrease in trade receivables
    (31.0 )     (169.9 )     32.0  
Net increase in prepaid expenses and other assets
    (12.7 )     (70.1 )     (73.7 )
Net increase in deferred contract costs
    (62.1 )     (57.9 )     (88.9 )
Net increase (decrease) in deferred revenue
    9.6       (11.5 )     (13.5 )
Net (decrease) increase in accounts payable, accrued liabilities, and other liabilities
    (139.4 )     31.9       (88.4 )
 
                 
Net cash provided by operating activities
    596.4       463.5       494.7  
 
                 
Cash flows from investing activities:
                       
Additions to property and equipment
    (76.7 )     (113.8 )     (122.4 )
Additions to capitalized software
    (178.7 )     (229.5 )     (177.8 )
Proceeds from sale of Covansys stock
          430.2        
Investment in Brazilian card processing venture
    (25.7 )            
Proceeds from sale of company assets
    32.6       96.2        
Acquisitions, net of cash acquired
    (19.9 )     (1,729.0 )     111.0  
Other investing activities
    (4.7 )            
 
                 
Net cash used in investing activities
    (273.1 )     (1,545.9 )     (189.2 )
 
                 
Cash flows from financing activities:
                       
Borrowings
    5,160.0       4,300.3       245.1  
Debt service payments
    (5,337.3 )     (3,032.7 )     (368.6 )
Capitalized debt issuance costs
          (29.4 )     (5.1 )
Income tax benefits from exercise of stock options
          47.5       26.9  
Stock options exercised
    19.2       57.7       70.4  
Treasury stock purchases
    (236.1 )     (80.3 )     (160.5 )
Dividends paid
    (38.2 )     (38.7 )     (38.2 )
Cash transferred in LPS spin-off
    (20.8 )            
Minority interest contribution to Brazilian card processing venture
    14.8              
Net contribution by FNF
                1.4  
 
                 
Net cash (used in) provided by financing activities
    (438.4 )     1,224.4       (228.6 )
 
                 
Effect of foreign currency exchange rates on cash
    (19.3 )     1.5       1.7  
Net (decrease) increase in cash and cash equivalents
    (134.4 )     143.5       78.6  
Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of year
    355.3       211.8       133.2  
 
                 
Cash and cash equivalents, end of year
  $ 220.9     $ 355.3     $ 211.8  
 
                 
Noncash contributions by FNF
  $     $     $ 11.6  
 
                 
Cash paid for interest
  $ 197.5     $ 201.3     $ 185.9  
 
                 
Cash paid for taxes
  $ 57.4     $ 282.6     $ 80.0  
 
                 
Noncash distribution of net assets of LPS
  $ 84.2     $     $  
 
                 
Retirement of Term Loan B in connection with LPS spin-off
  $ 1,585.0     $     $  
 
                 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

37


Table of Contents

FIDELITY NATIONAL INFORMATION SERVICES, INC.
AND SUBSIDIARIES
Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Earnings
Years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006
                         
    2008     2007     2006  
    (In millions)  
Net earnings
  $ 214.8     $ 561.2     $ 259.1  
Other comprehensive (loss) earnings:
                       
Unrealized gain on Covansys warrants, net of tax
          7.6       12.5  
Unrealized loss on interest rate swaps and other investments, net of tax
    (27.9 )     (28.6 )     (0.1 )
Unrealized (loss) gain on foreign currency translation, net of tax
    (123.8 )     45.9       29.5  
Pension liability adjustment, net of tax
    (4.0 )     (2.2 )     7.3  
Reclassification adjustments for realized gains on Covansys warrants included in net earnings, net of tax
          (14.3 )      
 
                 
Other comprehensive (loss) earnings
    (155.7 )     8.4       49.2  
 
                 
Comprehensive earnings
  $ 59.1     $ 569.6     $ 308.3  
 
                 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

38


Table of Contents

FIDELITY NATIONAL INFORMATION SERVICES, INC.
AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
     Unless stated otherwise or the context otherwise requires all references to “FIS,” “we”, the “Company” or the “registrant” are to Fidelity National Information Services, Inc., a Georgia corporation formerly known as Certegy Inc., which was the surviving legal entity in the Certegy Merger; all references to “eFunds” are to eFunds Corporation, and its subsidiaries, as acquired by FIS (Note 6); all references to “Old FNF” are to Fidelity National Financial, Inc., which owned a majority of the Company’s shares through November 9, 2006; all references to “FNF” are to Fidelity National Financial, Inc. (formerly known as Fidelity National Title Group, Inc. (“FNT”)), formerly a subsidiary of Old FNF but now an independent company that remains a related entity from an accounting perspective; and all references to “LPS” are to Lender Processing Services, Inc., a former wholly owned subsidiary of FIS which was spun-off as a separate publicly traded company on July 2, 2008 (note 4).
(1) Basis of Presentation
     FIS is a leading provider of technology solutions, processing services, and information-based services to the financial services industry. On February 1, 2006, the Company completed a merger with Certegy (the “Certegy Merger”) (Note 6), which was accounted for as a reverse acquisition and purchase accounting was applied to the acquired assets and assumed liabilities of Certegy. In form, Certegy was the legal acquirer in the Certegy Merger and the continuing registrant for Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”) reporting purposes. However, due to the majority ownership in the combined entity held by FIS shareholders, FIS was designated the acquirer for accounting purposes and, effective on the Certegy Merger date, the historical financial statements of FIS became the historical financial statements of the continuing registrant for all periods prior to the Certegy Merger. The results of operations of Certegy are only included in these historical financial statements for periods subsequent to the Certegy Merger. Immediately after the Certegy Merger, the name of the SEC registrant was changed to Fidelity National Information Services, Inc.
     On July 2, 2008, we completed the LPS spin-off. For accounting purposes the results of LPS are presented as discontinued operations. Accordingly all prior periods have been revised to present the results of LPS up to July 1, 2008 as discontinued operations.
     Subsequent to the LPS spin-off, we continued to operate under the historical operating segment of Transaction Processing Services. During the 2008 fourth quarter we performed a review and restructuring of our organizational and management structure and redefined our reporting segments as presented in Note 20 to the Consolidated Financial Statements.
(2) Combination with Old FNF
     On June 25, 2006, the Company entered into an agreement and plan of merger (the “FNF Merger Agreement”) with Old FNF (amended September 18, 2006) (the “FNF Merger”). The FNF Merger was one step in a plan that eliminated Old FNF’s holding company structure and majority ownership of FIS. In connection with this plan, Old FNF also entered into a securities exchange and distribution agreement (the “SEDA”) with its subsidiary Fidelity National Title Group, Inc. (“FNT”). Under the SEDA, Old FNF agreed that, prior to the merger, Old FNF would transfer substantially all its assets and liabilities to FNT, in exchange for shares of FNT common stock. Old FNF then would spin-off all shares of FNT stock it held to the stockholders of Old FNF in a tax-free distribution. Pursuant to the FNF Merger Agreement, on November 9, 2006, Old FNF merged with and into FIS, with FIS continuing as the surviving corporation. In consideration for the FNF Merger, Old FNF stockholders received an aggregate of 96,521,877 shares of FIS stock for their Old FNF shares. In addition, in connection with the FNF Merger, FIS issued options to purchase FIS common stock and shares of FIS restricted stock in exchange for certain Old FNF options and restricted stock outstanding at the time of the FNF Merger. The FNF Merger followed the completion, on October 24, 2006, of FNT’s acquisition under the SEDA of substantially all of the assets and liabilities of Old FNF (other than Old FNF’s interests in FIS and in FNF Capital Leasing, Inc., a small subsidiary which merged into FIS in a separate transaction) in exchange for 45,265,956 shares of FNT’s Class A common stock, and Old FNF’s subsequent spin-off of its FNT shares (the “FNT Distribution”). Pursuant to the SEDA and after the completion of all of the transactions, FNT was renamed Fidelity National Financial, Inc. (“FNF”) and now trades under the symbol FNF. Old FNF Chairman and CEO William P. Foley, II, assumed a similar position in FNF and now serves as its Chairman and as Executive Chairman of FIS, and other key members of Old FNF senior management continued their involvement in both FNF and FIS in executive capacities.
     U.S. generally accepted accounting principles require that one of the two parties to the FNF Merger be designated as the acquirer for accounting purposes. However, Financial Accounting Standards Board Technical Bulletin 85-5, Issues Relating to Accounting for Business Combinations provides that if a transaction lacks substance, it is not a purchase event and should be accounted for based on existing carrying amounts. In the FNF Merger, the minority interest of FIS has not changed and the only assets and liabilities of the

39


Table of Contents

combined entity after the exchange are those of FIS prior to the exchange. Because a change in ownership of the minority interest did not take place, the FNF Merger has been accounted for based on the carrying amounts of FIS’ assets and liabilities.
(3) Summary of Significant Accounting Policies
     The following describes the significant accounting policies of the Company which have been followed in preparing the accompanying Consolidated Financial Statements.
(a) Principles of Consolidation and Basis of Presentation
     The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of FIS, its wholly-owned subsidiaries, and subsidiaries that are majority owned and/or over which it exercises substantive control. Investments in unconsolidated affiliates, in which FIS has 20 percent to 50 percent of ownership interest and has the ability to exercise significant influence, but not substantive control, over the affiliate’s operating and financial policies, are accounted for using the equity method of accounting.
     All significant intercompany profits, transactions and balances have been eliminated in consolidation. The financial information included herein does not necessarily reflect what the financial position and results of operations of the Company would have been had it operated as a stand-alone entity during the periods covered.
     All dollar amounts presented in these notes and in the accompanying Consolidated Financial Statements (except per share amounts) are in millions unless indicated otherwise.
(b) Cash and Cash Equivalents
     For purposes of reporting balance sheets and cash flows, highly liquid instruments purchased with original maturities of three months or less are considered cash equivalents. The carrying amounts reported in the consolidated balance sheets for these instruments approximate their fair value. At December 31, 2008, we had cash on hand of $220.9 million of which approximately $139.8 million is held by our operations in foreign jurisdictions.
(c) Fair Value of Financial Instruments
     The carrying amounts reported in the Consolidated Balance Sheets for receivables and accounts payable approximate their fair values because of their immediate or short-term maturities. The fair value of the Company’s long-term debt at December 31, 2008 is estimated to be approximately $502.0 million lower than the carrying value (based on values of trades of our debt made in close proximity to year-end) and was estimated to approximate carrying value at December 31, 2007. These estimates are subjective in nature and involve uncertainties and significant judgment in the interpretation of current market data. Therefore, the values presented are not necessarily indicative of amounts the Company could realize or settle currently. The Company holds, or has held, certain derivative instruments, specifically interest rate swaps and warrants relating to certain subsidiaries. As discussed in Note 15, interest rate swaps were valued using Level 2-type measurements.
(d) Derivative Financial Instruments
     The Company accounts for derivative financial instruments in accordance with Statement of Financial Accounting Standards (“SFAS”) No. 133, Accounting for Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities, (“SFAS 133”) as amended. During 2008, 2007 and 2006, the Company engaged in hedging activities relating to its variable rate debt through the use of interest rate swaps. The Company designates these interest rate swaps as cash flow hedges. The estimated fair values of the cash flow hedges are recorded as an asset or liability of the Company and are included in the accompanying Consolidated Balance Sheets in prepaid expenses and other current assets, other non-current assets, accounts payable and accrued liabilities or other long-term liabilities, as appropriate, and as a component of accumulated other comprehensive earnings, net of deferred taxes. A portion of the amount included in accumulated other comprehensive earnings is recorded in interest expense as a yield adjustment as interest payments are made on the Company’s Term and Revolving Loans (Note 15). The Company’s existing cash flow hedges are highly effective and there is no current impact on earnings due to hedge ineffectiveness. It is our policy to execute such instruments with credit-worthy banks at the time of execution and not to enter into derivative financial instruments for speculative purposes. As of December 31, 2008, we believe that our interest rate swap counterparties will be able to fulfill their obligations under our agreements.
(e) Trade Receivables
     A summary of trade receivables, net, at December 31, 2008 and 2007 is as follows (in millions):

40


Table of Contents

                 
    December 31,     December 31,  
    2008     2007  
Trade receivables — billed
  $ 422.7     $ 739.5  
Trade receivables — unbilled
    156.0       139.8  
 
           
Total trade receivables
    578.7       879.3  
Allowance for doubtful accounts
    (40.6 )     (53.4 )
 
           
Total trade receivables, net
  $ 538.1     $ 825.9  
 
           
          The Company analyzes trade accounts receivable by considering historical bad debts, customer creditworthiness, current economic trends, changes in customer payment terms and collection trends when evaluating the adequacy of the allowance for doubtful accounts. Any change in the assumptions used in analyzing a specific account receivable may result in an additional allowance for doubtful accounts being recognized in the period in which the change occurs.
     A summary of the roll forward of allowance for doubtful accounts, at December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006 is as follows (in millions):
         
Allowance for doubtful accounts as of December 31, 2005
  $ (18.0 )
Bad debt expense
    (20.6 )
Transfers and acquisitions
    (7.5 )
Write-offs
    14.6  
 
     
Allowance for doubtful accounts as of December 31, 2006
    (31.5 )
 
     
Bad debt expense
    (30.3 )
Transfers and acquisitions
    (16.0 )
Write-offs
    24.4  
 
     
Allowance for doubtful accounts as of December 31, 2007
    (53.4 )
 
     
Bad debt expense
    (34.0 )
Transfers related to LPS spin-off
    33.8  
Write-offs
    13.0  
 
     
Allowance for doubtful accounts as of December 31, 2008
  $ (40.6 )
 
     
     Settlement Deposits, Receivables, and Payables. The Company records settlement receivables and payables that result from timing differences in the Company’s settlement process with merchants, financial institutions, and credit card associations related to merchant and card transaction processing and third-party check collections. Cash held by FIS associated with this settlement process is classified as settlement deposits in the Consolidated Balance Sheets.
(f) Other receivables
     Other receivables represent amounts due from consumers related to deferred debit processing services offered in Australia and the U.K., and other amounts including income taxes receivable. A significant portion of the amounts due from consumers related to deferred debit processing services relate to Certegy Australia, Ltd., which was sold on October 13, 2008. The carrying value for these receivables was $81.7 million at December 31, 2008 and approximates their fair value.
(g) Goodwill
     Goodwill represents the excess of cost over the fair value of identifiable net assets acquired and liabilities assumed in business combinations. SFAS No. 142, Goodwill and Intangible Assets (“SFAS No. 142”) requires that intangible assets with estimable useful lives be amortized over their respective estimated useful lives to their estimated residual values and be reviewed for impairment in accordance with SFAS No. 144, Accounting for the Impairment or Disposal of Long-Lived Assets (“SFAS No. 144”). SFAS No. 142 and SFAS No. 144 also provide that goodwill and other intangible assets with indefinite useful lives should not be amortized, but shall be tested for impairment annually or more frequently if circumstances indicate potential impairment, through a comparison of fair value to their carrying amounts. The Company measures for impairment on an annual basis during the fourth quarter using a September 30th measurement date unless circumstances require a more frequent measurement. During the third quarter of 2008, our market capitalization declined to a point below our book value. However, our impairment test indicated that no impairment had occurred, based on our assumptions of discounted future cash flows using our current best estimate of future performance. In December of 2008, upon the change in our reporting segments and in light of the fact that our market capitalization continued to remain below our book value, we performed new impairment tests on a segment basis and determined that no impairments existed.
     The Company has reconciled the aggregate estimated fair value of the reporting units to the market capitalization of the consolidated Company. We believe that the overall market conditions that existed at the measurement dates and continue to exist because of the financial crisis have led to a market capitalization well below the fair value of a controlling interest.

41


Table of Contents

Based on these factors, we concluded that the market capitalization does not represent the fair value of the Company.
(h) Long-lived Assets
     SFAS No. 144 requires that long-lived assets and intangible assets with definite useful lives be reviewed for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of an asset may not be recoverable. Recoverability of assets to be held and used is measured by comparison of the carrying amount of an asset to estimated undiscounted future cash flows expected to be generated by the asset. If the carrying amount of an asset exceeds its estimated future cash flows, an impairment charge is recognized in the amount by which the carrying amount of the asset exceeds the fair value of the asset.
(i) Intangible Assets
     The Company has intangible assets which consist primarily of customer relationships that are recorded in connection with acquisitions at their fair value based on the results of valuation analysis. Customer relationships are amortized over their estimated useful lives using an accelerated method which takes into consideration expected customer attrition rates up to a ten-year period. Intangible assets with estimated useful lives (principally customer relationships and certain trademarks) are reviewed for impairment in accordance with SFAS No. 144 while certain trademarks determined to have indefinite lives are reviewed for impairment at least annually in accordance with SFAS No. 142.
(j) Computer Software
     Computer software includes the fair value of software acquired in business combinations, purchased software and capitalized software development costs. Purchased software is recorded at cost and amortized using the straight-line method over its estimated useful life and software acquired in business combinations is recorded at its fair value and amortized using straight-line or accelerated methods over its estimated useful life, ranging from five to ten years.
     Capitalized software development costs are accounted for in accordance with either SFAS No. 86, Accounting for the Costs of Computer Software to Be Sold, Leased, or Otherwise Marketed (“SFAS No. 86”), or with the American Institute of Certified Public Accountants (“AICPA”) Statement of Position (“SOP”) No. 98-1, Accounting for the Costs of Computer Software Developed or Obtained for Internal Use (“SOP 98-1”). After the technological feasibility of the software has been established (for SFAS No. 86 software), or at the beginning of application development (for SOP No. 98-1 software), software development costs, which include salaries and related payroll costs and costs of independent contractors incurred during development, are capitalized. Research and development costs incurred prior to the establishment of technological feasibility (for SFAS No. 86 software), or prior to application development (for SOP No. 98-1 software), are expensed as incurred. Software development costs are amortized on a product by product basis commencing on the date of general release of the products (for SFAS No. 86 software) and the date placed in service for purchased software (for SOP No. 98-1 software). Software development costs (for SFAS No. 86 software) are amortized using the greater of (1) the straight-line method over its estimated useful life, which ranges from three to ten years or (2) the ratio of current revenues to total anticipated revenue over its useful life.
(k) Deferred Contract Costs
     Cost of software sales and outsourced data processing and application management arrangements, including costs incurred for bid and proposal activities, are generally expensed as incurred. However, certain costs incurred upon initiation of a contract are deferred and expensed over the contract life. These costs represent incremental external costs or certain specific internal costs that are directly related to the contract acquisition or transition activities and are primarily associated with installation of systems/processes and data conversion.
     In the event indications exist that a deferred contract cost balance related to a particular contract may be impaired, undiscounted estimated cash flows of the contract are projected over its remaining term and compared to the unamortized deferred contract cost balance. If the projected cash flows are not adequate to recover the unamortized cost balance, the balance would be adjusted to equal the contract’s net realizable value, including any termination fees provided for under the contract, in the period such a determination is made.
(l) Property and Equipment
     Property and equipment is recorded at cost, less accumulated depreciation and amortization. Depreciation and amortization are computed primarily using the straight-line method based on the estimated useful lives of the related assets: thirty years for buildings and three to seven years for furniture, fixtures and computer equipment. Leasehold improvements are amortized using the straight-line method over the lesser of the initial term of the applicable lease or the estimated useful lives of such assets.

42


Table of Contents

(m) Income Taxes
     The Company recognizes deferred income tax assets and liabilities for temporary differences between the financial reporting basis and the tax basis of the Company’s assets and liabilities and expected benefits of utilizing net operating loss and credit carryforwards. Deferred income tax assets and liabilities are measured using enacted tax rates expected to apply to taxable income in the years in which those temporary differences are expected to be recovered or settled. The impact on deferred income taxes of changes in tax rates and laws, if any, is reflected in the Consolidated Financial Statements in the period enacted.
(n) Revenue Recognition
     The Company generates revenues from the delivery of bank processing and credit and debit card processing services, professional services, software licensing and software related services and products. The Company recognizes revenues in accordance with accounting standards for software and service companies including American Institute of Certified Public Accountants (AICPA) Statement of Position (SOP) 97-2, Software Revenue Recognition (SOP 97-2), as amended by SOP 98-9, Modification of SOP 97-2, Software Revenue Recognition, With Respect to Certain Transactions, (“SOP 98-9”) the consensus reached in Emerging Issues Task Force (EITF) Issue No. 00-3, Application of AICPA Statement of Position 97-2 to Arrangements that Include the Right to Use Software Stored on Another Entity’s Hardware, the consensus reached in EITF Issue No. 00-21, Revenue Arrangements with Multiple Deliverables, SEC Staff Accounting Bulletin No. 104, Revenue Recognition, and SOP 81-1, Accounting for Performance of Construction-Type and Certain Production-Type Contracts, and related interpretations, including AICPA Technical Practice Aids. The Company recognizes revenue when: (i) evidence of an arrangement exists; (ii) delivery has occurred; (iii) the fees are fixed or determinable; and (iv) collection is considered probable.
     The following describes the Company’s primary types of revenues and its revenue recognition policies as they pertain to the types of transactions the Company enters into with its customers. The Company enters into arrangements with customers to provide services, software and software related services such as post-contract customer support and implementation and training either individually or as part of an integrated offering of multiple services. These services occasionally include offerings from more than one segment to the same customer. The revenues for services provided under these multiple element arrangements are recognized in accordance with the applicable revenue recognition accounting principles as further described below.
Bank Processing and Credit and Debit Card Processing Services
     Bank processing and credit and debit card processing services include data processing and application management. In some cases, these services are offered in combination with one another and in other cases the Company offers them individually. Revenues from processing services are typically volume-based depending on factors such as the number of accounts processed, transactions processed and computer resources utilized. Revenues from these arrangements are recognized as services are performed in accordance with SEC Staff Accounting Bulletin No. 104 (“SAB 104”), Revenue Recognition and related interpretations.
     In the event that the Company’s arrangements with its customers include more than one service, the Company determines whether the individual revenue elements can be recognized separately in accordance with EITF 00-21. EITF 00-21 addresses the determination of whether an arrangement involving more than one deliverable contains more than one unit of accounting and how the arrangement consideration should be measured and allocated to the separate units of accounting. In accordance with EITF 00-21, an element of an arrangement containing more than one deliverable is considered a separate unit of accounting if all the following criteria are met: the item has value to a customer on a standalone basis; there is objective and reliable evidence of fair value of the item; and, if the arrangement includes a general right of return relative to the delivered item, delivery or performance of the item is considered probable and substantially in the Company’s control.
     A relatively small percentage of credit card processing revenue is generated from the merchant institution processing business, where the relationship is with the financial institution that contracts directly with the merchant. In this business, the Company is responsible for collecting and settling interchange fees with the credit card associations. The Company follows the guidance provided

43


Table of Contents

in EITF 99-19, Reporting Revenue Gross as a Principal versus Net as an Agent, (“EITF 99-19”) which states that whether a company should recognize revenue based on the gross amount billed to a customer or the net amount retained is a matter of judgment that depends on the relevant facts and circumstances and that certain factors or indicators should be considered in the evaluation. The Company has evaluated the indicators and records the interchange fees revenue on a gross basis and the related costs are included in cost of revenue as the Company is considered the primary obligor and bears credit risk associated with the transactions.
Professional Service Revenues
     Revenues and costs related to implementation, conversion and programming services associated with the Company’s data processing and application management agreements during the implementation phase are deferred and subsequently recognized using the straight-line method over the term of the related services agreement. The Company evaluates these deferred contract costs for impairment in the event any indications of impairment exist.
     Revenues and costs related to consulting service agreements, which include implementation, conversion and programming services, are recognized as the services are provided in accordance with SAB 104.
License and Software Related Revenues
          The Company recognizes software license and post-contract customer support fees as well as associated development, implementation, training, conversion and programming fees in accordance with SOP No. 97-2 and SOP No. 98-9. Initial license fees are recognized when a contract exists, the fee is fixed or determinable, software delivery has occurred and collection of the receivable is deemed probable, provided that vendor-specific objective evidence (“VSOE”) has been established for each element or for any undelivered elements. The Company determines the fair value of each element or the undelivered elements in multi-element software arrangements based on VSOE. VSOE for each element is based on the price charged when the same element is sold separately, or in the case of post-contract customer support, when a stated renewal rate is provided to the customer. If evidence of fair value of all undelivered elements exists but evidence does not exist for one or more delivered elements, then revenue is recognized using the residual method. Under the residual method, the fair value of the undelivered elements is deferred and the remaining portion of the arrangement fee is recognized as revenue. If evidence of fair value does not exist for one or more undelivered elements of a contract, then all revenue is deferred until all elements are delivered or fair value is determined for all remaining undelivered elements. Revenue from post-contract customer support is recognized ratably over the term of the agreement. The Company records deferred revenue for all billings invoiced prior to revenue recognition.
     With respect to a small percentage of revenues, the Company uses contract accounting, as required by SOP No. 97-2, when the arrangement with the customer includes significant customization, modification, or production of software. For elements accounted for under contract accounting, revenue is recognized in accordance with SOP 81-1, Accounting for Performance of Construction Type and Certain Production-Type Contracts, using the percentage-of-completion method since reasonably dependable estimates of revenues and contract hours applicable to various elements of a contract can be made. Revenues in excess of billings on these agreements are recorded as unbilled receivables and are included in trade receivables. Billings in excess of revenue recognized on these agreements are recorded as deferred revenue until revenue recognition criteria are met. Changes in estimates for revenues, costs and profits are recognized in the period in which they are determinable. When the Company’s estimates indicate that the entire contract will be performed at a loss, a provision for the entire loss is recorded in that accounting period.
     In arrangements where the licensed software includes hosting the software for the customer, a software element is only considered present if the customer has the contractual right to take possession of the software at any time during the hosting period without significant penalty and it is feasible for the customer to either operate the software on their own hardware or contract with another vendor to host the software. If the arrangement meets these criteria, as well as the other criteria for recognition of the license revenues described above, a software element is present and license revenues are recognized when the software is delivered and hosting revenues are recognized as the service is provided. If a separate software element described above is not present, the related revenues are combined and recognized ratably over the hosting or maintenance period, whichever is longer.
     Hardware revenue is recognized as a delivered element in accordance with SOP No. 97-2 and SOP No. 98-9 as discussed above. The Company does not stock in inventory the hardware products sold, but arranges for delivery of hardware from third-party suppliers. For these transactions, the Company follows the guidance provided in EITF No. 99-19. The Company has evaluated the indicators and records the revenue related to hardware transactions on a gross basis and the related costs are included in cost of revenue as the Company is considered the primary obligor by the customer, bears risk of loss, and has latitude in establishing prices on the equipment.

44


Table of Contents

(o) Cost of revenue and selling, general and administrative expenses
     Cost of revenue includes payroll, employee benefits, occupancy costs and other costs associated with personnel employed in customer service roles, including program design and development and professional services. Cost of revenue also includes data processing costs, amortization of software, customer relationship intangible assets and depreciation on operating assets.
     Selling, general and administrative expenses include payroll, employee benefits, occupancy and other costs associated with personnel employed in sales, marketing, human resources and finance roles. Selling, general and administrative expenses also includes depreciation on non-operating corporate assets, advertising costs and other marketing-related programs.
(p) Stock-Based Compensation Plans
     The Company accounts for stock-based compensation plans using the fair value method. Using the fair value method of accounting, compensation cost is measured based on the fair value of the award at the grant date and recognized over the service period.
(q) Foreign Currency Translation
     The functional currency for the foreign operations of the Company is either the U.S. Dollar or the local currency. For foreign operations where the local currency is the functional currency, the translation of foreign currencies into U.S. Dollars is performed for balance sheet accounts using exchange rates in effect at the balance sheet date and for revenue and expense accounts using a weighted average exchange rate during the period. The gains and losses resulting from the translation are included in accumulated other comprehensive earnings (loss) in the Consolidated Statements of Stockholders’ Equity and are excluded from net earnings. Realized gains or losses resulting from other foreign currency transactions are included in other income.
(r) Management Estimates
     The preparation of these Consolidated Financial Statements in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the Consolidated Financial Statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting periods. Actual results could differ from those estimates.
(s) Check Guarantee Reserves
     In the Company’s check guarantee business, if a guaranteed check presented to a merchant customer is dishonored by the check writer’s bank, the Company reimburses the merchant customer for the check’s face value and pursues collection of the amount from the delinquent check writer. Loss reserves and anticipated recoveries are primarily determined by performing a historical analysis of the Company’s check loss and recovery experience and considering other factors that could affect that experience in the future. Such factors include the general economy, the overall industry mix of customer volumes, statistical analysis of check fraud trends within customer volumes, and the quality of returned checks. Once these factors are considered, the Company establishes a rate for check losses that is calculated by dividing the expected check losses by dollar volume processed and a rate for anticipated recoveries that is calculated by dividing the anticipated recoveries by the total amount of related check losses. These rates are then applied against the dollar volume processed and check losses, respectively, each month and charged to cost of revenue. The estimated check returns and recovery amounts are subject to risk that actual amounts returned and recovered may be different than the Company’s estimates. The Company had accrued claims payable balances of $21.0 million and $27.4 million at December 31, 2008 and 2007, respectively, related to these estimations. The Company had accrued claims recoverable of $24.0 million and $37.5 million at December 31, 2008 and 2007, respectively, related to these estimations. In addition, the Company recorded check guarantee losses, net of anticipated recoveries excluding service fees, of $98.1 million, $113.8 million and $102.9 million for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. The amount paid to merchant customers, net of amounts recovered from check writers excluding service fees, was $87.4 million, $112.0 million and $107.9 million for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively.
(t) Net Earnings per Share
     The basic weighted average shares and common stock equivalents determined using the treasury stock method for the year ended December 31, 2006 include the shares and options that were previously outstanding at Certegy only from February 1, 2006 through December 31, 2006. If these shares and options had been outstanding for the entire twelve months of 2006, basic weighted average shares outstanding would have been approximately 191.3 million, common stock equivalents would have been 3.3 million and weighted average shares on a diluted basis would have been 194.6 million.
     Net earnings and earnings per share for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006 are as follows (in millions, except

45


Table of Contents

per share data):
                         
    Year Ended December 31,  
    2008     2007     2006  
Net earnings from continuing operations
  $ 117.4     $ 250.7     $ 15.6  
Net earnings from discontinued operations (including gain on sale of discontinued operations, net of tax)
    97.4       310.5       243.5  
 
                 
Net earnings
  $ 214.8     $ 561.2     $ 259.1  
 
                 
Weighted average shares outstanding — basic
    191.6       193.1       185.9  
Plus: Common stock equivalent shares assumed from conversion of options
    1.9       3.4       3.3  
 
                 
Weighted average shares outstanding — diluted
    193.5       196.5       189.2  
 
                 
Basic net earnings from continuing operations per share
  $ 0.61     $ 1.30     $ 0.08  
Basic net earnings from discontinued operations per share
    0.51       1.61       1.31  
 
                 
Basic net earnings per share
  $ 1.12     $ 2.91     $ 1.39  
 
                 
Diluted net earnings from continuing operations per share
  $ 0.61     $ 1.28     $ 0.08  
Diluted net earnings from discontinued operations per share
    0.50       1.58       1.29  
 
                 
Diluted net earnings per share
  $ 1.11     $ 2.86     $ 1.37  
 
                 
     Options to purchase approximately 12.3 million, 3.4 million and 1.7 million shares of our common stock for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively, were not included in the computation of diluted earnings per share because they were antidilutive.
(u) Recent Accounting Pronouncements
     In June 2008, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (FASB) issued FASB Staff Position (FSP) Emerging Issues Task Force 03-6-1, Determining Whether Instruments Granted in Share-Based Payment Transactions Are Participating Securities, which will become effective for periods beginning on or after December 15, 2008, and will be applied retrospectively. Under the FSP, unvested share-based payment awards that contain non-forfeitable rights to dividends or dividend equivalents are participating securities and, therefore, are included in computing earnings per share (EPS) pursuant to the two-class method. The two-class method determines earnings per share for each class of common stock and participating securities according to dividends or dividend equivalents and their respective participation rights in undistributed earnings. Adoption of FSP Emerging Issues Task Force 03-6-1 will not have a material impact on the Company’s financial position or results of its operations.
     In May 2008, the FASB issued SFAS No. 162, The Hierarchy of Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (“SFAS 162”). SFAS 162 identifies the sources of accounting principles and the framework for selecting the principles to be used in the preparation of financial statements of nongovernmental entities that are presented in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles in the United States. The FASB has concluded that the generally accepted accounting principles hierarchy should reside in the accounting literature established by the FASB and issued SFAS 162 to achieve that result. SFAS 162 was effective on November 15, 2008. The adoption of SFAS 162 did not have a material effect on the Company’s financial condition or results of its operations.
     In March 2008, the FASB issued SFAS No. 161, Disclosures about Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities-an amendment of FASB Statement No. 133. (“SFAS 161”). SFAS 161 expands the current disclosure requirements of SFAS No. 133, “Accounting for Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities,” (“SFAS 133”) such that entities must now provide enhanced disclosures on a quarterly basis regarding how and why the entity uses derivatives; how derivatives and related hedged items are accounted for under SFAS 133, and how derivatives and related hedged items affect the entity’s financial position, performance and cash flow. Pursuant to the transition provisions of the Statement, the Company will adopt SFAS 161 in fiscal year 2009 and will present the required disclosures in the prescribed format on a prospective basis. SFAS 161 will not impact the consolidated financial results as it is disclosure-only in nature.
     In December 2007, the FASB issued SFAS No. 160, Noncontrolling Interests in Consolidated Financial Statements — an amendment of ARB No. 51 (“SFAS 160”), requiring noncontrolling interests (sometimes called minority interests) to be presented as a component of equity on the balance sheet. SFAS 160 also requires that the amount of net earnings attributable to the parent and to the noncontrolling interests be clearly identified and presented on the face of the Consolidated Statement of Earnings. This Statement eliminates the need to apply purchase accounting when a parent company acquires a noncontrolling ownership interest in a subsidiary and requires that, upon deconsolidation of a subsidiary, a parent company recognize a gain or loss in net earnings after which any retained noncontrolling interest will be reported at fair value. SFAS 160 requires expanded disclosures in the Consolidated Financial Statements that identify and distinguish between the interests of the parent’s owners and the interest of the noncontrolling owners of subsidiaries. SFAS 160 is effective for periods beginning on or after December 15, 2008 and will be applied prospectively except for the presentation and disclosure requirements, which will be applied retrospectively for all periods presented. Adoption of SFAS 160

46


Table of Contents

will not have a material effect on the Company’s statements of operations. Upon adoption of SFAS 160, the noncontrolling or minority interest, $164.2 million at December 31, 2008, will be reclassified to a component of equity.
     In December 2007, the FASB issued SFAS No. 141 (revised 2007), Business Combinations (“SFAS 141(R)”), requiring an acquirer in a business combination to recognize the assets acquired, the liabilities assumed, and any noncontrolling interest in the acquiree at their fair values at the acquisition date, with limited exceptions. The costs of the acquisition and any related restructuring costs will be recognized separately. Assets and liabilities arising from contingencies in a business combination are to be recognized at their fair value at the acquisition date and adjusted prospectively as new information becomes available. When the fair value of assets acquired exceeds the fair value of consideration transferred plus any noncontrolling interest in the acquiree, the excess will be recognized as a gain. Under SFAS 141(R), all business combinations will be accounted for prospectively by applying the acquisition method, including combinations among mutual entities and combinations by contract alone. SFAS 141(R) is effective for periods beginning on or after December 15, 2008, and will apply to business combinations occurring after the effective date. The Company will adopt SFAS 141R and apply its provisions to business combinations subsequent to December 31, 2008.
     In September 2006, the FASB issued SFAS No. 157, Fair Value Measurements (“SFAS 157”). SFAS 157 defines fair value, establishes a framework for measuring fair value, and expands disclosures about fair value measurements by establishing a fair value hierarchy based on the quality of inputs used to measure fair value. SFAS 157 does not require any new fair value measurements, but applies under other accounting pronouncements that require or permit fair value measurements. SFAS 157 is effective for financial statements for fiscal years beginning after November 15, 2007. The Company adopted SFAS 157 as of January 1, 2008.
     In February 2008, the FASB issued FASB Staff Position SFAS No. 157-2, “Effective Date of FASB Statement No. 157,” which delays the effective date of SFAS 157 with respect to nonfinancial assets and nonfinancial liabilities that are not remeasured at fair value on a recurring basis until fiscal years beginning after November 15, 2008. Accordingly, the Company has not yet applied the disclosure requirements of SFAS 157 to certain such nonfinancial assets for which fair value measurements are determined on a non-recurring basis.
     The fair value hierarchy established by SFAS 157 includes three levels which are based on the priority of the inputs to the valuation technique. The fair value hierarchy gives the highest priority to quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities (Level 1) and the lowest priority to unobservable inputs (Level 3). If the inputs used to measure the financial instruments fall within different levels of the hierarchy, the categorization is based on the lowest level input that is significant to the fair value measurement of the instrument. In accordance with SFAS 157, our financial assets and liabilities that are recorded on the Consolidated Balance Sheets are categorized based on the inputs to the valuation techniques as follows:
Level 1. Financial assets and liabilities whose values are based on unadjusted quoted prices for identical assets or liabilities in an active market that we have the ability to access.
Level 2. Financial assets and liabilities whose values are based on quoted prices in markets that are not active or model inputs that are observable either directly or indirectly for substantially the full term of the asset or liability.
Level 3. Financial assets and liabilities whose values are based on model inputs that are unobservable.
(v) Certain Reclassifications
     Certain reclassifications have been made in the 2007 and 2006 Consolidated Financial Statements to conform to the classifications used in 2008.
(4) Discontinued Operations
     During 2008 and 2007, we discontinued certain operations which are reported as discontinued operations in the Consolidated Statements of Earnings for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, in accordance with SFAS 144. Interest is allocated to discontinued operations based on debt to be retired and debt specifically identified as related to the respective discontinued operation.
     LPS
     On July 2, 2008 (the “spin-off date”), all of the shares of the common stock, par value $0.0001 per share, of LPS, previously a wholly-owned subsidiary of FIS, were distributed to FIS shareholders through a stock dividend (the “spin-off”). FIS and LPS are distinct and unique businesses that serve different customers, operate in different markets, and attract different investors. The spin-off allows us to provide more flexibility and dedicated management focus with respect to our product development, capital investment and strategic initiatives. At the time of the distribution, LPS consisted of substantially all the assets, liabilities, businesses and

47


Table of Contents

employees related to FIS’ Lender Processing Services segment as of the spin-off date. In the spin-off, FIS contributed all of its interest in such assets, liabilities, businesses and employees to LPS in exchange for shares of LPS common stock and $1,585.0 million aggregate principal amount of LPS debt obligations, which we used to retire our $1,585.0 Term Loan B. Upon the distribution, FIS shareholders received one-half share of LPS common stock for every share of FIS common stock held as of the close of business on June 24, 2008. FIS’ shareholders collectively received 100% of the LPS common stock, which became a stand-alone public company trading under the symbol “LPS” on the New York Stock Exchange. The results of operations of the former Lender Processing Services segment of FIS are reflected as discontinued operations in the Consolidated Statements of Earnings for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, in accordance with SFAS 144.
     LPS had revenues of $913.1 million, $1,686.6 million and $1,492.3 million for the period from January 1, 2008 through July 2, 2008, and for the years ended December 31, 2007 and 2006, respectively. LPS had earnings before taxes of $188.4 million, $412.3 million and $356.7 million for the period from January 1, 2008 through July 2, 2008 and for the years ended December 31, 2007 and 2006, respectively.
     The following table summarizes the major categories of LPS assets and liabilities disposed of in the July 2, 2008 spin-off:
         
Assets:
       
Total current assets
  $ 379.3  
Goodwill, net
    1,084.6  
Other intangible assets, net
    103.3  
Other non-current assets
    356.8  
 
       
Liabilities:
       
Other current liabilities
  $ 190.7  
Long-term debt
    1,585.2  
Other long-term liabilities
    52.9  
Minority interest
    10.8  
     Certegy Australia, Ltd.
     On October 13, 2008, we sold Certegy Australia, Ltd. (“Certegy Australia”) for $21.1 million in cash and other consideration, because its operations did not align with our strategic plans. Certegy Australia had revenues of $27.6 million, $29.1 million and $21.0 million during the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. Certegy Australia had (loss) earnings before taxes of ($17.6) million (including $26.0 million of trademark impairment charge as discussed below), $15.7 million and $9.1 million during the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. During the year ended December 31, 2008, in accordance with SFAS 142, as defined in Note 3(g) we recorded a pre-tax impairment charge of $52.0 million to reduce the carrying value of a trademark related to the Company’s retail check business to its estimated fair value. We estimated the fair value of the check trademark by utilizing a relief from royalty methodology. Under this method, we estimate the amount of cash flows that, without owning the trademark, we would have had to pay to license the trademark. These estimated cash flows were then discounted to determine the fair value. Additionally, the trademark, previously accounted for as an indefinite lived intangible asset, was determined to no longer be indefinite and has an estimated useful life of 15 years and is being amortized straight line over its remaining life. Approximately $26.0 million of this charge is included in cost of revenues in our Consolidated Statement of Earnings in the Corporate and Other segment and $26.0 million (approximately $17.7 million net of tax) is included in discontinued operations in our Consolidated Statements of Earnings, as a portion of the charge relates to the Company’s Australian retail check business disposed of in fiscal year 2008 and accounted for as a discontinued operation pursuant to SFAS 144.
     Certegy Gaming Services
     On April 1, 2008, we sold Certegy Gaming Services, Inc. (“Certegy Game”) for $25.0 million, realizing a pretax loss of $4.1 million, because its operations did not align with our strategic plans. Certegy Game had revenues of $27.2 million, $96.4 million and $82.4 million during the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. Certegy Game had (losses) earnings before taxes of $0.3 million (excluding the pretax loss realized on sale), ($1.1) million and $0.7 million during the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively.
     FIS Credit Services
     On February 29, 2008, we sold FIS Credit Services, Inc. (“Credit”) for $6.0 million, realizing a pre-tax gain of $1.4 million, because its operations did not align with our strategic plans. Credit had revenues of $1.4 million, $12.4 million and $17.5 million

48


Table of Contents

during the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. Credit had losses before taxes of ($0.2) million (excluding the realized gain), $2.1 million and $0.6 million during the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively.
     Homebuilders Financial Network
     During the year ended December 31, 2008, we discontinued and dissolved Homebuilders Financial Network, LLC and its related entities (“HFN”) due to the loss of a major customer. HFN had revenues of $1.4 million, $12.5 million and $12.5 million during the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. HFN had earnings (losses) before taxes of ($4.7) million, $3.5 million and $3.5 million during the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively.
     Property Insight
     On August 31, 2007, we sold Property Insight, LLC (“Property Insight”) to FNF for $95.0 million in cash realizing a pre-tax gain of $66.9 million ($42.1 million after-tax), because its operations did not align with our strategic plans. Property Insight had revenues of $52.6 million and $90.4 million during the years ended December 31, 2007 and 2006, respectively. Property Insight had earnings before taxes of $13.7 million (excluding the realized gain) and $29.1 million during the years ended December 31, 2007 and 2006, respectively.
(5) Related Party Transactions
     We are party to certain related party agreements with FNF, LPS and other related parties.
     A detail of related party items included in revenues is as follows (in millions):
                         
    2008     2007     2006  
ABN AMRO card and item processing revenue
  $ 96.4     $ 56.9     $ 24.2  
Banco Bradesco card and item processing revenue
    93.7       53.1       19.1  
Sedgwick data processing services revenue
    39.3       37.8       17.3  
FNF data processing services revenue
    28.0       22.3       29.9  
Other services revenue
    7.3       6.7       6.9  
 
                 
Total revenues
  $ 264.7     $ 176.8     $ 97.4  
 
                 
ABN AMRO Real and Banco Bradesco S.A.
     In March 2006 we entered into an agreement with Banco Bradesco S.A. (“Bradesco”) and ABN AMRO Real (“ABN”) (collectively, “banks”) to form a venture to provide comprehensive, fully outsourced card processing services to Brazilian card issuers. In exchange for a 51% controlling interest in the venture, we contributed our existing Brazilian card processing business contracts and Brazilian card processing infrastructure and committed to make enhancements to our card processing system to meet the processing needs of the banks and their affiliates. The banks executed long-term, exclusive contracts to process their card portfolios with the venture in exchange for an aggregate 49% interest in the venture (Note 7). Additionally, we provide payment solutions services to Bradesco and ABN AMRO outside of the Brazilian card processing venture.
Sedgwick
     We also provide data processing services to Sedgwick CMS, Inc. (“Sedgwick”), a company in which FNF holds an approximate 32% equity interest.
FNF and LPS
     We have historically conducted business with FNF and its subsidiaries. A number of these business activities were based upon agreements between FNF and entities which were a part of our Lender Processing Services segment, which is now being presented as a discontinued operation in our consolidated statements of earnings for all periods presented. In connection with the July 2, 2008 LPS spin-off, a number of these agreements were amended, assigned or renegotiated by FIS, FNF and LPS. A summary of the revenue producing agreements to which we are a party that were in effect as of December 31, 2008 is as follows:
    Data processing services. This agreement governs IT support services provided to FNF, consisting primarily of infrastructure support and data center management. Subject to certain early termination provisions (including the payment of minimum monthly service and termination fees), this agreement had an initial term of five years

49


Table of Contents

      from February 2006 with an option to renew for one or two additional years. In connection with the spin-off, this agreement was amended to cover these services through June 30, 2013.
    Other services revenue. These revenues relate to transitional services provided to LPS.
  A detail of related party items included in operating expenses (net of expense reimbursements) is as follows (in millions):
                         
    2008     2007     2006  
Equipment and real estate leasing
  $ 20.5     $ 6.8     $  
Administrative corporate support and other services
    8.3       7.7       5.8  
 
                 
Total expenses
  $ 28.8     $ 14.5     $ 5.8  
 
                 
We entered into service agreements with FNF and LPS to provide certain services to us and them. A summary of these agreements in effect as of December 31, 2008 is as follows:
    Equipment and real estate leasing agreements. We have entered into certain property management and real estate lease agreements with LPS and FNF relating to our Jacksonville corporate headquarters. We also incurred expenses for amounts paid by us to FNF under leases of certain personal property and technology equipment.
 
    Administrative corporate support services to and from FNF and LPS. Historically, FNF has provided to us, and to a lesser extent we have provided to FNF, certain administrative corporate support services relating to general management, statutory accounting, claims administration, and other administrative support services. The pricing for these services, both to and from FNF, is at cost. The term of the corporate services agreements was two years, subject to early termination if the services are no longer required by the party receiving the services or upon mutual agreement of the parties and subject to extension in certain circumstances. In connection with the LPS spin-off, we amended the corporate services agreement to reduce the administrative corporate support services provided by FNF. We also terminated the corporate services that we provide to FNF since such services are no longer required by FNF. In addition, prior to the spin-off, we provided general management, accounting, treasury, payroll, human resources, internal audit, and other corporate administrative support services to LPS. In connection with the spin-off, we entered into corporate services agreements with LPS under which we will provide to LPS, and we receive from LPS, certain transitional corporate support services. The pricing for all of these services, both from FNF, and from and to LPS, is at cost. The term of each of the corporate services agreements is two years, subject to early termination if the services are no longer required by the party receiving the services or upon mutual agreement of the parties and subject to extension in certain circumstances.
     We believe the amounts earned from or charged by us under each of the foregoing service arrangements are fair and reasonable. We believe our service arrangements are priced within the range of prices we offer to third parties. However, the amounts we earned or that were charged under these arrangements were not negotiated at arm’s-length, and may not represent the terms that we might have obtained from an unrelated third party.
     Discontinued Operations — Related Party Activity
     On August 31, 2007, we completed the sale of Property Insight to FNF. The net earnings from Property Insight, including related party revenues and expenses, are classified as earnings from discontinued operations for the period from January 1, 2007 through August 31, 2007 and the year ended December 31, 2006.
     Through July 2, 2008, LPS provided a number of services to FNF that are now presented as discontinued operations. These services included title agency services, software development services, real estate related services and other cost sharing services. These activities are included within net earnings from discontinued operations.
     FNF Capital
     On October 26, 2006, we completed a merger with FNF Capital, Inc. (“FNF Capital”), a leasing subsidiary of Old FNF. Through the merger, we assumed a note payable to Old FNF of $13.9 million and we recorded interest expense related to this note of $0.6 million and $0.2 million through September 30, 2007 and for the year ended December 31, 2006, respectively. On September 30, 2007, we sold certain leasing assets of FNF Capital back to FNF for $15.0 million and FNF assumed the aforementioned note payable and other liabilities. We also recorded a $7.3 million note receivable from FNF relating to the transaction, which matures in September 2012, with interest payable at a rate of LIBOR plus 0.45% (4.50% as of December 31, 2008). We recorded interest income related to this note of $0.1 million for the period from October 1, 2007 through December 31, 2007 and $0.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2008.

50


Table of Contents

(6) Acquisitions
     The results of operations and financial position of the entities acquired during the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007, and 2006 are included in the Consolidated Financial Statements from and after the date of acquisition. There were no significant acquisitions in 2008.
     2007 Significant Acquisition
eFunds Corporation
     On September 12, 2007, we completed the acquisition of eFunds (the “eFunds Acquisition”). This acquisition expanded our presence in risk management services, EFT services, prepaid/gift card processing, and global outsourcing solutions to financial services companies in the U.S. and internationally. Pursuant to the Agreement and Plan of Merger (the “eFunds Merger Agreement”) dated as of June 26, 2007, eFunds became a wholly-owned subsidiary of FIS. The issued and outstanding shares of eFunds common stock, par value $0.01 per share, were converted into the right to receive $36.50 per share in cash from us.
     The total purchase price was as follows (in millions):
         
Cash paid for eFunds’ common stock
  $ 1,744.9  
Value of eFunds’ stock awards
    37.6  
Transaction costs
    8.3  
 
     
 
  $ 1,790.8  
 
     
     The purchase price has been allocated to eFunds’ tangible and identifiable intangible assets acquired and liabilities assumed based on their fair values as of September 12, 2007. Goodwill has been recorded based on the amount that the purchase price exceeds the fair value of the net assets acquired. The purchase price allocation is as follows (in millions):
         
Cash
  $ 99.3  
Trade and other receivables
    129.1  
Land, buildings, and equipment
    77.9  
Other assets
    17.1  
Computer software
    59.6  
Intangible assets
    175.2  
Goodwill
    1,540.6  
Liabilities assumed
    (308.0 )
 
     
Total purchase price
  $ 1,790.8  
 
     
     The allocation of the purchase price to intangible assets, including computer software and customer relationships, is based on valuations performed to determine the values of such assets as of the merger date.
     The following table summarizes the liabilities assumed in the eFunds Acquisition (in millions):
         
Notes payable and capital lease obligations
  $ 103.2  
Deferred income taxes
    4.9  
Estimated severance payments
    41.6  
Estimated employee relocation and facility closure costs
    22.0  
Other merger related costs
    20.2  
Other operating liabilities
    116.1  
 
     
 
  $ 308.0  
 
     
     We have completed our evaluation of the various employment agreements, lease agreements, vendor arrangements, and customer contracts of eFunds. This evaluation has resulted in the recognition of certain liabilities associated with exiting activities of the acquired company.
          In connection with the eFunds Acquisition, we also adopted eFunds’ stock option plans and registered approximately 2.2 million options and 0.2 million restricted stock units in replacement of similar outstanding awards held by eFunds employees. The amounts attributable to vested options are included as an adjustment to the purchase price, and the amounts attributable to unvested

51


Table of Contents

options and restricted stock units will be expensed over the remaining vesting period based on a valuation as of the date of closing. On March 31, 2008, as approved by the Compensation Committee of the Company’s Board of Directors, we accelerated the vesting of all stock awards held by eFunds employees. As a result we recorded $14.1 million in additional stock compensation expense for the year ended December 31, 2008.
Pro Forma Results
     Selected unaudited pro forma results of operations for years ended December 31, 2007, assuming the eFunds Acquisition had occurred as of January 1, 2007, and using actual general and administrative expenses prior to the acquisition are presented for comparative purposes below (in millions, except per share amounts):
         
    2007
Total revenues
  $ 3,306.7  
Net earnings from continuing operations
  $ 140.5  
Pro forma earnings per share — basic from continuing operations
  $ 0.73  
Pro forma earnings per share — diluted from continuing operations
  $ 0.71  
     December 31, 2007 pro forma results include a pre-tax gain of $274.5 million on the sale of the investment in Covansys, and eFunds merger related costs of approximately $91.4 million, on a pre-tax basis.
2006 Significant Acquisition
Certegy
     On September 14, 2005, the Company entered into a definitive merger agreement with Certegy under which the Company and Certegy combined operations to form a single publicly traded company called Fidelity National Information Services, Inc. (NYSE:FIS). Certegy was a payment processing company headquartered in St. Petersburg, Florida. On January 26, 2006, Certegy’s shareholders approved the Certegy Merger, which was subsequently consummated on February 1, 2006. The Company acquired Certegy to expand its share of the payment processing services industry and create synergies with many of its other product lines.
     Under the terms of the Certegy Merger agreement, the Company was merged into a wholly owned subsidiary of Certegy in a tax-free merger, and all of the Company’s outstanding stock was converted into Certegy common stock.
     Generally accepted accounting principles in the U.S. require that one of the two companies in the transaction be designated as the acquirer for accounting purposes. FIS has been designated as the accounting acquirer because immediately after the Certegy Merger its shareholders held more than 50% of the common stock of the combined company. As a result, the Certegy Merger has been accounted for as a reverse acquisition under the purchase method of accounting. Under this accounting treatment, the Company is considered the acquiring entity and Certegy is considered the acquired entity for financial reporting purposes. The financial statements of the combined company after the Certegy Merger reflect the Company’s financial results on a historical basis and include the results of operations of Certegy from February 1, 2006.
     The purchase price was based on the number of outstanding shares of common stock of Certegy on February 1, 2006, the date of consummation of the Certegy Merger, valued at $33.38 per share (which was the average of the trading price of Certegy common stock two days before and two days after the announcement of the Certegy Merger on September 15, 2005 of $37.13, less the $3.75 per share special dividend declared to former Certegy shareholders just prior to closing). The purchase price also included the estimated fair value of Certegy’s stock options and restricted stock units outstanding at the transaction date.
     The total purchase price was as follows (in millions):
         
Value of Certegy’s common stock
  $ 2,121.0  
Value of Certegy’s stock options
    54.2  
Transaction costs
    5.9  
 
     
 
  $ 2,181.1  
 
     
     The purchase price has been allocated to Certegy’s tangible and identifiable intangible assets acquired and liabilities assumed based on their fair values as of February 1, 2006. Goodwill has been recorded based on the amount that the purchase price exceeds the fair value of the net assets acquired. The purchase price allocation is as follows (in millions):
         
Cash
  $ 376.3  
Trade and other receivables
    241.2  
Land, buildings, and equipment
    72.4  

52


Table of Contents

         
Other assets
    136.9  
Computer software
    131.6  
Intangible assets
    653.5  
Goodwill
    1,939.8  
Liabilities assumed
    (1,370.6 )
 
     
Total purchase price
  $ 2,181.1  
 
     
     The allocation of the purchase price to intangible assets, including computer software and customer relationships, is based on valuations performed as of the merger date.
     The following table summarizes the liabilities assumed in the Certegy Merger (in millions):
         
Notes payable and capital lease obligations
  $ 222.8  
Deferred income taxes
    210.5  
Dividends payable
    236.6  
Dividend bridge loan
    239.0  
Liabilities associated with pension, SERP, and postretirement benefit plans
    31.1  
Estimated severance payments to certain Certegy employees
    10.0  
Estimated employee relocation and facility closure costs
    11.6  
Other merger related
    28.5  
Other operating liabilities
    380.5  
 
     
 
  $ 1,370.6  
 
     
Other acquisitions:
     The following transactions with acquisition prices between $10 million and $100 million were completed by the Company during the period from January 1, 2006 through December 31, 2008. Purchase prices reflected in the table are net of cash acquired:
                 
Name of Company Acquired   Date Acquired     Purchase Price  
FastFunds Financial Corporation
  February 1, 2006   $14.0 million
Proservvi Empreendimentos e Servicos Ltda
  July 17, 2006   $16.2 million
Watterson Prime, LLC
  November 2, 2006   $10.4 million
Second Foundation, Inc.
  February 15, 2007   $18.9 million
Espiel, Inc. and Financial Systems Integrators, Inc.
  June 8, 2007   $43.3 million
McDash Analytics
  May 15, 2008   $19.1 million
(7) Brazilian Venture
     In March, 2006 we entered into an agreement with Banco Bradesco S.A. (“Bradesco”) and ABN AMRO Real (“ABN”) (collectively, “banks”) to form a venture to provide comprehensive, fully outsourced card processing services to Brazilian card issuers. In exchange for a 51% controlling interest in the venture, we contributed our existing Brazilian card processing business contracts and Brazilian card processing infrastructure and committed to make enhancements to our card processing system to meet the processing needs of the banks and their affiliates. The banks executed long-term, exclusive contracts to process their card portfolios with the venture in exchange for an aggregate 49% interest in the venture. The conversion of the banks’ existing card portfolios would follow completion of the system enhancements required for each respective bank. The venture agreement had certain provisions allowing it to be dissolved if conversions were unsuccessful. This dissolution right terminated at the ABN conversion date, which occurred in the second quarter 2008. Due to the lapse of these rights, we recorded a minority interest liability representing the 49% interest in the venture owned by the banks, and an offsetting customer contract intangible asset. The amount assigned to the customer intangible assets was $224.2 million and is based on the 49% of the estimated enterprise value of the venture plus additional consideration of $84.4 million based on exchange rates as of December 31, 2008. Of the additional consideration, $25.7 million was paid to the banks during the fourth quarter and the remaining amount will be paid after the final bank conversions which are expected to be completed in 2009. The customer intangible asset will be accounted for in accordance with EITF 01-9, Accounting for Consideration given by a Vendor to a Customer (including a Reseller of the Vendors products), (“EITF 01-9”) and will be amortized over the contractual relationship as a reduction of revenues based on projected card volumes over the term of the contract.
     Through December 31, 2008, we contributed approximately $93.8 million of development costs to the venture based on exchange rates as of December 31, 2008. Development costs in excess of Real 79.0 million ($33.8 million) are to be contractually shared by the parties: 75% by us and 25% by the banks. During the fourth quarter, the banks contributed $14.7 million representing their 25% share.
(8) Investment in Covansys Corporation

53


Table of Contents

In July of 2007 Covansys, an equity method investee of ours, was purchased by an unrelated entity. We received cash proceeds of approximately $430.2 million and recognized a pretax gain of approximately $274.5 million related to the sale of our investment in Covansys. Additionally, we held Covansys warrants in 2007 and 2006 that were accounted for under SFAS 115, Accounting for Certain Investments in Debt and Equity Securities, (“SFAS 115”) as available for sale securities prior to their exercise. Net of tax, amounts recognized in other comprehensive earnings in 2007 and 2006 related to the Covansys warrants were $7.6 million and $12.5 million, respectively. As of December 31, 2007, we had no remaining interest in Covansys.
(9) Property and Equipment
     Property and equipment as of December 31, 2008 and 2007 consists of the following (in millions):
                 
    December 31,     December 31,  
    2008     2007  
Land
  $ 23.9     $ 28.3  
Buildings
    87.1       154.9  
Leasehold improvements
    59.0       59.3  
Computer equipment
    266.7       330.5  
Furniture, fixtures, and other equipment
    80.3       151.0  
 
           
 
    517.0       724.0  
Accumulated depreciation and amortization
    (244.4 )     (331.5 )
 
           
 
  $ 272.6     $ 392.5  
 
           
     Depreciation and amortization expense on property and equipment amounted to $88.4 million, $115.6 million and $97.7 million for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. Included in discontinued operations in the Consolidated Statements of Earnings was depreciation and amortization expense on property and equipment of $8.6 million, $24.6 million and $28.6 million for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively.
(10) Goodwill
     Changes in goodwill, net of purchase accounting adjustments, during the years ended December 31, 2008 and 2007 are summarized as follows (in millions):
                                         
    Financial     Payment             Discontinued        
    Solutions     Solutions     International     Operations     Total  
Balance, December 31, 2006
  $ 1,320.8     $ 1,054.8     $ 266.8     $ 1,095.1     $ 3,737.5  
Goodwill distributed through the sale of non-strategic businesses
                      (17.1 )     (17.1 )
Goodwill acquired during 2007
    785.9       627.6       158.8       34.1       1,606.4  
 
                             
Balance, December 31, 2007
  $ 2,106.7     $ 1,682.4     $ 425.6     $ 1,112.1     $ 5,326.8  
Goodwill distributed through the sale of non-strategic businesses
                      (27.5 )     (27.5 )
Goodwill distributed through spin-off of LPS segment
                      (1,084.6 )     (1,084.6 )
Purchase price and foreign currency adjustments
    (10.3 )     (8.3 )     (2.1 )           (20.7 )
 
                             
Balance, December 31, 2008
  $ 2,096.4     $ 1,674.1     $ 423.5     $     $ 4,194.0  
 
                             
(11) Intangible Assets
     Customer relationships intangible assets are generally obtained as part of acquired businesses and are amortized over their estimated useful lives, generally 5 to 10 years using accelerated methods. Trademarks determined to have indefinite lives are not amortized, in accordance with the provisions of SFAS 142.
     Intangible assets, as of December 31, 2008, consisted of the following (in millions):
                         
            Accumulated        
    Cost     Amortization     Net  
Customer relationships
  $ 1,233.6     $ 499.3     $ 734.3  
Trademarks
    190.0             190.0  
 
                 
 
  $ 1,423.6     $ 499.3     $ 924.3  
 
                 
     Intangible assets, as of December 31, 2007, consisted of the following (in millions):

54


Table of Contents

                         
            Accumulated        
    Cost     Amortization     Net  
Customer relationships
  $ 1,392.3     $ 610.5     $ 781.8  
Trademarks
    249.7       0.9       248.8  
 
                 
 
  $ 1,642.0     $ 611.4     $ 1,030.6  
 
                 
     Amortization expense for intangible assets with definite lives was $187.4 million, $168.7 million and $175.6 million for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006 respectively. Included in discontinued operations, in the Consolidated Statements of Earnings was depreciation and amortization expense on intangible assets of $19.0 million, $44.4 million and $53.9 million for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. During the year ended December 31, 2008, in accordance with SFAS 142, we recorded a pre-tax impairment charge of $52.0 million to reduce the carrying value of a trademark related to the Company’s retail check business to its estimated fair value, due to declining check volumes and the sale of our Australian check business. Approximately $26.0 million of this charge is included in cost of revenues in our Consolidated Statement of Earnings and was recorded in the Corporate and Other segment and $26.0 million (approximately $17.7 million net of tax) is included in discontinued operations in our Consolidated Statements of Earnings, as a portion of the charge relates to the Company’s Australian retail check business disposed of in fiscal year 2008 and accounted for as a discontinued operation pursuant to SFAS No. 144.
     Estimated amortization expense for the next five years is as follows (in millions):
         
2009
  $ 123.5  
2010
    110.7  
2011
    94.5  
2012
    80.8  
2013
    68.6  
(12) Computer Software
     Computer software as of December 31, 2008 and 2007 consisted of the following (in millions):
                 
    December 31,     December 31,  
    2008     2007  
Software from business acquisitions
  $ 368.6     $ 438.0  
Capitalized software development costs
    529.5       598.3  
Purchased software
    64.6       73.4  
 
           
Computer software
    962.7       1,109.7  
Accumulated amortization
    (345.7 )     (334.5 )
 
           
Computer software, net of accumulated amortization
  $ 617.0     $ 775.2  
 
           
     Amortization expense for computer software was $149.9 million, $177.8 million and $130.2 million for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. Included in discontinued operations in the Consolidated Statements of Earnings was amortization expense on computer software of $14.8 million, $32.5 million and $30.2 million for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. Included in amortization in 2007 was a $13.5 million write-off of the carrying value of impaired software in our Financial Solutions segment.
(13) Deferred Contract Costs
     A summary of deferred contract costs as of December 31, 2008 and 2007 was as follows (in millions):
                 
    December 31,     December 31,  
    2008     2007  
Installations and conversions in progress
  $ 91.9     $ 85.5  
Installations and conversions completed, net
    85.9       118.8  
Other, net
    63.4       52.6  
 
           
Total deferred contract costs
  $ 241.2     $ 256.9  
 
           
     Amortization of deferred contract costs was $39.8 million, $34.8 million and $30.1 million for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006 respectively. Included in discontinued operations in the Consolidated Statements of Earnings was amortization expense on deferred contract costs of $1.1 million, $2.0 million and $2.2 million for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively.

55


Table of Contents

(14) Accounts Payable and Accrued Liabilities
     Accounts payable and accrued liabilities as of December 31, 2008 and 2007 consisted of the following (in millions):
                 
    December 31,     December 31,  
    2008     2007  
Salaries and incentives
  $ 62.7     $ 61.8  
Accrued benefits and payroll taxes
    27.4       36.9  
Trade accounts payable
    61.6       119.5  
Reserve for claims and claims payable
    36.2       57.8  
Other accrued liabilities
    292.6       330.2  
 
           
Total accounts payable and accrued liabilities
  $ 480.5     $ 606.2  
 
           
(15) Long-Term Debt
     Long-term debt as of December 31, 2008 and 2007 consisted of the following (in millions):
                 
    December 31,     December 31,  
    2008     2007  
Term Loan A, secured, interest payable at LIBOR plus 0.88% (2.51% at December 31, 2008), quarterly principal amortization, maturing January 2012
  $ 1,995.0     $ 2,047.5  
Term Loan B, retired July 2, 2008
          1,596.0  
Revolving Loan, secured, interest payable at LIBOR plus 0.70% (Eurocurrency Borrowings), Fed-funds plus 0.70% (Swingline Borrowings) or Prime plus 0.00% (Base Rate Borrowings) plus 0.18% facility fee (1.19%, 0.84% or 3.25% respectively at December 31, 2008), maturing January 2012. Total of $400.6 million unused as of December 31, 2008
    499.4       308.0  
Secured notes, net of discount, interest payable semiannually at 4.75%, repaid September 2008
          198.2  
Unsecured eFunds notes, interest payable semiannually at 5.39%, repaid February 2008
          98.5  
Other promissory notes with various interest rates and maturities
    20.1       27.2  
 
           
 
    2,514.5       4,275.4  
Less current portion
    (105.5 )     (272.0 )
 
           
Long-term debt, excluding current portion
  $ 2,409.0     $ 4,003.4  
 
           
     On January 18, 2007, we entered into a credit agreement with JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as Administrative Agent, Swing Line Lender, and Letter of Credit Issuer, Bank of America, N.A., as Swing Line Lender, and other financial institutions party thereto (the “Credit Agreement”). The Credit Agreement replaced our prior term loans and revolver as well as a $100 million settlement facility. As a result of the new credit agreement, we repaid the old credit agreement and recorded a charge of $27.2 million to write-off unamortized capitalized debt issuance costs. The Credit Agreement, which became secured as of September 12, 2007, provides for a committed $2.1 billion five-year term facility denominated in U.S. Dollars (the “Term Loan A”) and a committed $900 million revolving credit facility (the “Revolving Loan”) with a sublimit of $250 million for letters of credit and a sublimit of $250 million for swing line loans, maturing on the fifth anniversary of the closing date, January 18, 2012 (the “Maturity Date”). The Revolving Loan is bifurcated into a $735 million multicurrency revolving credit loan (the “Multicurrency Tranche”) that can be denominated in any combination of U.S. Dollars, Euro, British Pounds Sterling and Australian Dollars, and any other foreign currency in which the relevant lenders agree to make advances and a $165 million U.S. Dollar revolving credit loan that can be denominated only in U.S. Dollars. The swingline loans and letters of credit are available as a sublimit under the Multicurrency Tranche. In addition, the Credit Agreement originally provided for an uncommitted incremental loan facility in the maximum principal amount of $600 million, which would be made available only upon receipt of further commitments from lenders under the Credit Agreement sufficient to fund the amount requested by us. On July 30, 2007, we, along with the requisite lenders, executed an amendment to the existing Credit Agreement to facilitate our acquisition of eFunds. The amendment permitted the issuance of up to $2.1 billion in additional loans, an increase from the foregoing $600 million. The amendment became effective September 12, 2007. On September 12, 2007, we entered into a joinder agreement to obtain a secured $1.6 billion tranche of term loans denominated in U.S. Dollars (the “Term Loan B”) under the Credit Agreement, utilizing $1.6 billion of the $2.1 billion uncommitted incremental loan amount. The Term Loan B proceeds were used to finance the eFunds Acquisition, and pay related fees and expenses. On July 2, 2008, we completed the spin-off of LPS as a separate publicly traded company. In conjunction with the LPS spin-off, we immediately retired the outstanding $1,585.0 million principal balance of the Term Loan B. Debt issuance costs of $9.1 million are capitalized as of December 31, 2008. The $12.4 million remaining balance of Term Loan B debt issuance costs were written-off during July 2008, in conjunction with the LPS spin-off and retirement of the Term Loan B.

56


Table of Contents

     As of December 31, 2008, the Term Loan A balance was $1,995.0 million and a total of $499.4 million was outstanding under the Revolving Loan. The obligations under the Credit Agreement have been jointly and severally, unconditionally guaranteed by certain of our domestic subsidiaries. Additionally, we and certain subsidiary guarantors pledged certain equity interests in other entities (including certain of our direct and indirect subsidiaries) as collateral security for the obligations under the credit facility and the guarantee.
     We may borrow, repay and re-borrow amounts under the Revolving Loan from time to time until the maturity of the Revolving Loan. We must make quarterly principal payments under the Term Loan A in scheduled installments of: (a) $26.3 million per quarter from March 31, 2009 through December 31, 2009; and (b) $52.5 million per quarter from March 31, 2010 through September 30, 2011, with the remaining balance of approximately $1.5 billion payable on the Maturity Date.
     In addition to the scheduled principal payments, the Term Loan is (with certain exceptions) subject to mandatory prepayment upon issuances of debt, casualty and condemnation events, and sales of assets, as well as from a percentage of excess cash flow (as defined in the Credit Agreement) between zero and fifty percent commencing with the cash flow for the year ended December 31, 2008. No mandatory prepayments were owed for the year ended December 31, 2008. Voluntary prepayment of the Loan is generally permitted at any time without fee upon proper notice and subject to a minimum dollar requirement. Commitment reductions of the Revolving Loan are also permitted at any time without fee upon proper notice. The Revolving Loan has no scheduled principal payments, but it will be due and payable in full on the Maturity Date.
     The outstanding balance on the Loans bears interest at a floating rate, which is an applicable margin plus, at our option, either (a) the Eurocurrency (LIBOR) rate or (b) either (i) the federal funds rate or (ii) the prime rate. The applicable margin is subject to adjustment based on a leverage ratio (our total indebtedness to our consolidated EBITDA, as further defined in the Credit Agreement). Alternatively, we have the ability to request the lenders to submit competitive bids for one or more advances under the Revolving Loan.
     The Credit Agreement contains affirmative, negative and financial covenants customary for financings of this type, including, among other things, limits on the creation of liens, limits on the incurrence of indebtedness, restrictions on investments and dispositions, a prohibition on the payment of dividends and other restricted payments if an event of default has occurred and is continuing or would result therefrom, a minimum interest coverage ratio and a maximum leverage ratio. Upon an event of default, the Administrative Agent can accelerate the maturity of the Loans. Events of default include conditions customary for such an agreement, including failure to pay principal and interest in a timely manner and breach of certain covenants. These events of default include a cross-default provision that permits the lenders to declare the Credit Agreement in default if (i) we fail to make any payment after the applicable grace period under any indebtedness with a principal amount in excess of $150 million or (ii) we fail to perform any other term under any such indebtedness, as a result of which the holders thereof may cause it to become due and payable prior to its maturity. We were in compliance with all covenants related to the Credit Agreement at December 31, 2008.
     Through the merger with Certegy Inc., we acquired an obligation to service $200.0 million (aggregate principal amount) of secured 4.75% fixed-rate notes, which were repaid and fully satisfied on September 15, 2008. The notes were recorded in purchase accounting at a discount of $5.7 million, which was amortized over the term of the notes.
     Through the eFunds acquisition on September 12, 2007, we assumed $100.0 million in long-term notes payable previously issued by eFunds (the “eFunds Notes”). On February 26, 2008, we redeemed the eFunds Notes for a total of $109.3 million, which included a make-whole premium of $9.3 million.
     As of December 31, 2008, we have entered into the following interest rate swap transactions converting a portion of the interest rate exposure on our Term and Revolving Loans from variable to fixed (in millions):
                     
                Bank Pays   FIS pays
Effective Date   Termination Date   Notional Amount     Variable Rate of(1)   Fixed Rate of(2)
October 11, 2007
  October 11, 2009   $ 1,000.0     1 Month Libor   4.73%
December 11, 2007
  December 11, 2009     250.0     1 Month Libor   3.80%
April 11, 2007
  April 11, 2010     850.0     1 Month Libor   4.92%
 
                 
 
      $ 2,100.0          
 
                 
 
(1)   1.64% in effect at December 31, 2008 under the agreements.
 
(2)   In addition to the fixed rates paid under the swaps, we pay an applicable margin to our bank lenders on the Term Loan A of 0.88% and the Revolving Loan of 0.70% (plus a facility fee of 0.18%) as of December 31, 2008.

57


Table of Contents

     We have designated these interest rate swaps as cash flow hedges in accordance with SFAS 133. The estimated fair value of these cash flow hedges results in liabilities of $84.2 million and $41.2 million as of December 31, 2008 and 2007, respectively. Of these liabilities, $75.0 million is included in accounts payable and accrued liabilities as of December 31, 2008 and $9.2 million and $41.2 million is included in other long-term liabilities as of December 31, 2008 and 2007, respectively in the Consolidated Balance Sheets and as a component of accumulated other comprehensive earnings, net of deferred taxes. A portion of the amount included in accumulated other comprehensive earnings is reclassified into interest expense as a yield adjustment as interest payments are made on the Term and Revolving Loans. In accordance with the provisions of SFAS 157, the inputs used to determine the estimated fair value of our interest rate swaps are Level 2-type measurements. In accordance with SFAS 157, we considered our own credit risk when determining the fair value of our interest rate swaps. During June 2008, we terminated the $750 million interest rate swap tied to the Term Loan B that was retired during July 2008, without any significant impact to our financial position or results of operations during the period as its fair value was approximately zero on the date of termination.
     Our existing cash flow hedges are highly effective and there is no current impact on earnings due to hedge ineffectiveness. It is our policy to execute such instruments with credit-worthy banks at the time of execution and not to enter into derivative financial instruments for speculative purposes. As of December 31, 2008, we believe that our interest rate swap counterparties will be able to fulfill their obligations under our agreements and we believe that we will have debt outstanding through the various expiration dates of the swaps such that the future hedge cash flows remain probable of occurring.
     Principal maturities of long-term debt at December 31, 2008 for the next five years and thereafter are as follows (in millions):
         
2009
  $ 105.5  
2010
    210.0  
2011
    157.5  
2012
    2,041.5  
 
     
Total
  $ 2,514.5  
 
     
(16) Income Taxes
     Income tax expense (benefit) attributable to continuing operations for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006 consists of the following (in millions):
                         
    2008     2007     2006  
Current provision (benefit):
                       
Federal
  $ 14.0     $ 114.2     $ (5.9 )
State
    3.6       17.5       3.0  
Foreign
    2.2       0.1       1.1  
 
                 
Total current provision
  $ 19.8     $ 131.8     $ (1.8 )
 
                 
Deferred provision (benefit):
                       
Federal
  $ 32.5     $ 4.4     $ (3.0 )
State
    2.6       (2.8 )     (1.1 )
Foreign
    2.7       2.8       3.0  
 
                 
Total deferred provision
    37.8       4.4       (1.1 )
 
                 
Total provision for income taxes
  $ 57.6     $ 136.2     $ (2.9 )
 
                 
     The provision for income taxes is based on pre-tax income from continuing operations, which is as follows (in millions):
                         
    2008     2007     2006  
United States
  $ 137.1     $ 364.2     $ (8.3 )
Foreign
    42.1       19.8       13.5  
 
                 
Total
  $ 179.2     $ 384.0     $ 5.2  
 
                 
     Total income tax expense for the years ended December 31 was allocated as follows (in millions):
                         
    2008     2007     2006  
Tax expense per statements of earnings
  $ 57.6     $ 136.2     $ (2.9 )
Tax expense on equity in earnings of unconsolidated subsidiaries
    0.1       1.5       3.3  
Tax expense attributable to discontinued operations
    66.1       164.4       142.1  
Unrealized gain (loss) on interest rate swaps
    (15.2 )     (16.8 )     (0.1 )

58


Table of Contents

                         
    2008     2007     2006  
Unrealized (loss) gain on foreign currency translation
    (12.1 )     9.7        
Other adjustment
    0.7       (4.9 )     3.7  
 
                 
Total income tax expense (benefit) allocated to other comprehensive income
    (26.6 )     (12.0 )     3.6  
 
                 
Tax benefit from exercise of stock options
    (1.2 )     (56.6 )     (31.2 )
 
                 
Total income tax expense
  $ 96.0     $ 233.5     $ 114.9  
 
                 
     A reconciliation of the federal statutory income tax rate to the Company’s effective income tax rate for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006 is as follows:
                         
    2008   2007   2006
Federal statutory income tax rate
    35.0 %     35.0 %     35.0 %
State income taxes
    5.2       4.3       3.7  
Federal benefit of state taxes
    (1.8 )     (1.5 )     (1.3 )
Foreign rate differential
    (3.4 )     (1.3 )     (44.0 )
Other
    (2.9 )     (1.0 )     (48.6 )
 
                       
Effective income tax rate
    32.1 %     35.5 %     (55.2 )%
 
                       
     The significant components of deferred income tax assets and liabilities at December 31, 2008 and 2007 consist of the following (in millions):
                 
    2008     2007  
Deferred income tax assets:
               
Net operating loss carryforwards
  $ 60.5     $ 64.6  
Deferred revenue
    60.0       82.5  
Employee benefit accruals
    36.2       47.2  
Interest rate swaps
    32.1       15.1  
Accruals and Reserves
    14.7       27.0  
Allowance for doubtful accounts
    14.1       17.3  
Foreign tax credit carryforwards
    13.5       12.4  
Foreign currency translation adjustment
    12.9        
Other
    3.7       12.3  
 
           
Total gross deferred income tax assets
    247.7       278.4  
Less valuation allowance
    (12.8 )     (12.8 )
 
           
Total deferred income tax assets
    234.9       265.6  
 
           
Deferred income tax liabilities:
               
Amortization of goodwill and intangible assets
    414.9       410.1  
Deferred contract costs
    71.6       90.6  
Depreciation
          26.1  
Investment
          4.1  
Other
    3.7       9.6  
 
           
Total deferred income tax liabilities
    490.2       540.5  
 
           
Net deferred income tax liability
  $ 255.3     $ 274.9  
 
           
     Deferred income taxes have been classified in the consolidated balance sheets as of December 31, 2008 and 2007 as follows (in millions):
                 
    2008     2007  
Current assets
  $ 91.0     $ 120.1  
Noncurrent liabilities
    346.3       395.0  
 
           
Net deferred income tax liability
  $ 255.3     $ 274.9  
 
           
     Management believes that based on its historical pattern of taxable income, projections of future income, tax planning strategies and other relevant evidence, the Company will produce sufficient income in the future to realize its deferred income tax assets. A valuation allowance is established for any portion of a deferred income tax asset if management believes it is more likely than not that the Company will not be able to realize the benefits or portion of a deferred income tax asset. Adjustments to the valuation allowance will be made if there is a change in management’s assessment of the amount of deferred income tax asset that is realizable.
     As of December 31, 2008 and 2007, the Company had income taxes (payable) receivable of ($1.1) million and $32.2 million, respectively.
     Pre-tax income as of December 31, 2006, was $5.2 million while the income tax benefit for the same period was ($2.9) million. The impact of the favorable rate adjustments including the foreign rate differential results in significant rate adjustments relative to the Company’s pre-tax income.

59


Table of Contents

     At December 31, 2008 and 2007, the Company has federal, state and foreign net operating loss carryforwards resulting in deferred tax assets of $60.5 million and $64.6 million, respectively. The federal net operating losses result in deferred tax assets at December 31, 2008 and 2007 of $2.1 million and $13.6 million, respectively, which expire between 2019 and 2024. The Company anticipates fully utilizing these net operating losses prior to expiration. The Company also has state net operating loss carryforwards resulting in a deferred tax asset of $5.3 million at December 31, 2008 and 2007. The Company has a full valuation allowance against this amount at December 31, 2008 and 2007. The Company has foreign net operating loss carryforwards resulting in deferred tax assets at December 31, 2008 and 2007 of $53.1 million and $45.6 million, respectively. The Company has valuation allowances against these net operating losses at December 31, 2008 and 2007 of $5.2 million and $5.2 million, respectively. During 2008, the Company recorded a deferred tax asset of $7.4 million related to foreign net operating loss carryforwards resulting from a prior acquisition. The offset was recorded as a reduction of goodwill. At December 31, 2008 and 2007, the Company had foreign tax credit carryovers of $13.5 million and $12.4 million, respectively, which expire between 2013 and 2025. As of December 31, 2008 and 2007, the Company has a valuation allowance against $2.3 million of foreign tax credits that the Company’s management believes it is more likely than not that it will not realize the benefit.
     As of January 1, 2005, the IRS selected the Company to participate in the Compliance Assurance Process (CAP) which is a real-time audit for 2005 and future years. The IRS has completed its review for years 2002-2006 which resulted in immaterial adjustments for tax year 2004. Currently management believes the ultimate resolution of the IRS examinations will not result in a material adverse effect to the Company’s financial position or results of operations. Substantially all material foreign income tax return matters have been concluded through 2001. Substantially all state income tax returns have been concluded through 2004.
     The Company provides for United States income taxes on earnings of foreign subsidiaries unless they are considered permanently reinvested outside the United States. At December 31, 2008, the cumulative earnings on which United States taxes have not been provided for were $201.1 million. If these earnings were repatriated to the United States, they would generate foreign tax credits that could reduce the federal tax liability associated with the foreign dividend.
     The following table reconciles the gross amounts of unrecognized gross tax benefits at the beginning and end of the period (in millions) as required by FASB Interpretation No. 48, Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes (“FIN 48”):
         
    Gross Amount  
Amounts of unrecognized tax benefits at January 1, 2008
  $ 23.7  
Amount of decreases due to lapse of the applicable statute of limitations
    (3.6 )
Amount of decreases due to change of position
    (2.5 )
Amount of decreases due to settlements
    (6.7 )
Increases as a result of tax positions taken in a prior period
    4.8  
 
     
Amount of unrecognized tax benefit at December 31, 2008
  $ 15.7  
 
     
     The total amount of interest expense recognized in the Consolidated Statements of Earnings for unpaid taxes is $2.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2008. The total amount of interest and penalties recognized in the consolidated balance sheet is $3.8 million at December 31, 2008. Interest and penalties are recorded as a component of income tax expense in the Consolidated Statements of Earnings.
     Due to the expiration of various statutes of limitation in the next twelve months, an estimated $2.1 million of gross unrecognized tax benefits may be recognized during that twelve month period.
(17) Commitments and Contingencies
Litigation
     In the ordinary course of business, the Company is involved in various pending and threatened litigation matters related to operations, some of which include claims for punitive or exemplary damages. The Company believes that no actions, other than the matters listed below, depart from customary litigation incidental to its business. As background to the disclosure below, please note the following:
    These matters raise difficult and complicated factual and legal issues and are subject to many uncertainties and complexities.
 
    The Company reviews these matters on an on-going basis and follows the provisions of Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 5, Accounting for Contingencies (“SFAS 5”), when making accrual and disclosure decisions. When assessing reasonably possible and probable outcomes, the Company bases decisions on the assessment of the ultimate outcome following all appeals.

60


Table of Contents

     Driver’s Privacy Protection Act
     A putative class action lawsuit styled Richard Fresco, et al. v. Automotive Directions, Inc. et al., was filed against eFunds and seven other non-related parties in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of Florida. The complaint alleged that eFunds purchased motor vehicle records that were used for marketing and other purposes that are not permitted under the Federal Driver’s Privacy Protection Act (“DPPA”). The plaintiffs sought statutory damages, plus costs, attorney’s fees and injunctive relief. eFunds and five of the other seven defendants settled the case with the plaintiffs. That settlement was approved by the court over the objection of a group of Texas drivers and motor vehicle record holders. The plaintiffs have since moved to amend the court’s order approving the settlement in order to seek a greater attorneys’ fee award and to recover supplemental costs. In the meantime, the objectors filed two class action complaints styled Sharon Taylor, et al. v. Biometric Access Company et al and Sharon Taylor, et al. v. Acxiom et al in the U.S. District Court for the Eastern District of Texas alleging similar violations of the DPPA. The Acxiom action was filed against the Company’s ChexSystems, Inc. subsidiary, while the Biometric suit was filed against the Company’s Certegy Check Services, Inc. subsidiary. The judge recused himself in the action against Certegy because he was a potential member of the class. The lawsuit was then assigned to a new judge and Certegy filed a motion to dismiss. The court granted Certegy’s motion to dismiss with prejudice in the third quarter of 2008. ChexSystems filed a motion to dismiss or stay its action based upon the earlier settlement and the Court granted the motion to stay pending resolution of the Florida case. The court dismissed the ChexSystems’ lawsuit with prejudice against the remaining defendants in the third quarter of 2008. The plaintiffs moved the court to amend the dismissal to exclude defendants that were parties to the Florida settlement. That motion was granted. The plaintiffs then appealed the dismissal. The plaintiffs’ appeals of the dismissals in both lawsuits are pending.
     Searcy, Gladys v. eFunds Corporation
     This is a nationwide putative class action that was originally filed against eFunds Corporation and its affiliate Deposit Payment Protection Services, Inc. during the first quarter of 2008. The complaint alleges willful violation of the Fair Credit Reporting Act (“FCRA”) in connection with the operation of the Shared Check Authorization Network (“SCAN”). Plaintiff’s principal allegation is that consumers did not receive appropriate disclosures pursuant to §1681g of the FCRA because the disclosures did not include: (i) all information in the consumer’s file at the time of the request; (ii) the source of the information in the consumer’s file; and/or (iii) the names of any persons who requested information related to the consumer’s check writing history during the prior year. The Company is vigorously defending the matter.
Indemnifications and Warranties
     The Company often indemnifies its customers against damages and costs resulting from claims of patent, copyright, or trademark infringement associated with use of its software through software licensing agreements. Historically, the Company has not made any payments under such indemnifications, but continues to monitor the conditions that are subject to the indemnifications to identify whether it is probable that a loss has occurred, and would recognize any such losses when they are estimable. In addition, the Company warrants to customers that its software operates substantially in accordance with the software specifications. Historically, no costs have been incurred related to software warranties and none are expected in the future, and as such no accruals for warranty costs have been made.
Leases
     The Company leases certain of its property under leases which expire at various dates. Several of these agreements include escalation clauses and provide for purchases and renewal options for periods ranging from one to five years.
     Future minimum operating lease payments for leases with remaining terms greater than one year for each of the years in the five years ending December 31, 2013, and thereafter in the aggregate, are as follows (in millions):
         
2009
  $ 62.9  
2010
    47.4  
2011
    31.4  
2012
    18.6  
2013
    13.2  
Thereafter
    27.1  
 
     
Total
  $ 200.6  
 
     
     In addition, the Company has operating lease commitments relating to office equipment and computer hardware with annual lease payments of approximately $21.6 million per year which renew on a short-term basis.

61


Table of Contents

     Rent expense incurred under all operating leases during the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006 was $117.0 million, $108.4 million and $81.5 million, respectively. Included in discontinued operations in the Consolidated Statements of Earnings was rent expense of $14.2 million, $23.5 million and $45.2 million for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively.
     Data Processing and Maintenance Services Agreements. The Company has agreements with various vendors, which expire between 2009 and 2017, for portions of its computer data processing operations and related functions. The Company’s estimated aggregate contractual obligation remaining under these agreements was approximately $584.0 million as of December 31, 2008. However, this amount could be more or less depending on various factors such as the inflation rate, foreign exchange rates, the introduction of significant new technologies, or changes in the Company’s data processing needs.
(18) Employee Benefit Plans
Stock Purchase Plan
     Prior to the Certegy Merger (Note 6), FIS employees participated in the Fidelity National Financial, Inc. Employee Stock Purchase Plan (ESPP). Subsequent to the Certegy Merger, the Company instituted its own plan with the same terms as the Fidelity National Financial, Inc. plan. Under the terms of both plans and subsequent amendments, eligible employees may voluntarily purchase, at current market prices, shares of FNF’s (prior to the Certegy Merger) or FIS’ (post Certegy Merger) common stock through payroll deductions. Pursuant to the ESPP, employees may contribute an amount between 3% and 15% of their base salary and certain commissions. Shares purchased are allocated to employees based upon their contributions. The Company contributes varying matching amounts as specified in the ESPP. The Company recorded an expense of $14.3 million, $15.2 million and $13.1 million, respectively, for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006 relating to the participation of FIS employees in the ESPP. Included in discontinued operations in the Consolidated Statements of Earnings was $2.9 million, $5.6 million and $4.6 million for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively.
401(k) Profit Sharing Plan
     The Company’s employees are covered by a qualified 401(k) plan. Prior to the Certegy Merger, this plan was sponsored by FNF. Eligible employees may contribute up to 40% of their pretax annual compensation, up to the amount allowed pursuant to the Internal Revenue Code. The Company generally matches 50% of each dollar of employee contribution up to 6% of the employee’s total eligible compensation. The Company recorded expense of $18.5 million, $20.3 million and $19.0 million, respectively, for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006 relating to the participation of FIS employees in the 401(k) plan. Included in discontinued operations in the Consolidated Statements of Earnings was expense of $3.8 million, $7.7 million and $6.8 million for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively.
Stock Option Plans
     In 2005, the Company adopted the FIS 2005 Stock Incentive Plan (the “Plan”). As of December 31, 2008 and 2007, there were 2.7 million and 2.6 million options outstanding under this plan, respectively, at a strike price of $8.71 per share (as adjusted for the 1.7952 conversion ratio for the LPS spin-off and the 0.6396 exchange ratio in the Certegy transaction), respectively. These stock options were granted at the fair value of the Company’s stock on the grant date based on the price for which the Company sold 32 million shares (a 25% interest) to the financial sponsors in the recapitalization transaction on March 9, 2005. The options granted thus far under this plan have a term of 10 years and vest quarterly over either a 4 or 5 year period (the “time-based options”) on a quarterly basis or based on specific performance criteria (the “performance-based options”). The performance-based options vested in 2006 after the performance criteria was met subsequent to the Certegy Merger.
     Through the Certegy Merger, the Company assumed the Certegy Inc. Stock Incentive Plan that provides for the issuance of qualified and non-qualified stock options to officers and other key employees at exercise prices not less than market on the date of grant. All options and awards outstanding prior to the Certegy Merger under the Certegy Plan were fully vested as of the Certegy Merger date. As part of the Certegy Merger, the Certegy shareholders approved amendments to the plan and approved an additional 6.0 million shares to be made available under the plan. The Company granted 0.1 million, 4.7 million and 4.7 million options under this plan in the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and for the period from February 1, 2006 through December 31, 2006, respectively. There were 14.7 million and 11.4 million options outstanding under this plan at December 31, 2008 and 2007, respectively.
     On November 9, 2006, as part of the closing of the FNF Merger, the Company assumed certain options and restricted stock grants that the Company’s employees and directors held in FNF under certain FNF stock option plans. The Company assumed 2.7 million options to replace approximately 4.9 million outstanding FNF options per the FNF Merger agreement. The Company also assumed 0.1 million shares of restricted stock.

62


Table of Contents

     Certain FIS employees were participants in FNF’s stock-based compensation plans prior to the FNF Merger, which provide for the granting of incentive and nonqualified stock options, restricted stock and other stock-based incentive awards for officers and key employees. Grants of incentive and nonqualified stock options under these plans have generally provided that options shall vest equally over three years and generally expire ten years after their original date of grant. All options granted under these plans have an exercise price equal to the market value of the underlying common stock on the date of grant. There were no FNF options granted to FIS employees under these plans in the years ended December 31, 2007 and 2006. The Company recorded expense relating to these options and restricted stock of $1.0 million, $6.4 million and $3.8 million in the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. All FNF options and restricted stock for which the Company now records expense were converted into FIS options and restricted stock in the FNF Merger noted above.
     On September 12, 2007, as part of the closing of the eFunds acquisition, the Company assumed certain vested and unvested options and restricted stock units that the employees of eFunds held as of the acquisition date in the eFunds stock option plans. The Company assumed 2.2 million options and 0.1 million restricted stock units.
     In 2008, the Company adopted the FIS 2008 Stock Incentive Plan. As of December 31, 2008 there were 4.8 million options outstanding under this plan and 19.2 million options available for grant under this plan.
     On July 2, 2008, we completed the LPS spin-off. All stock options and awards held by our employees that became LPS employees were cancelled as of that date and reissued as LPS stock options and awards which are being accounted for in LPS’ financial results on a go-forward basis. All stock options and awards held by employees that continued to be FIS employees were adjusted using a conversion factor to adjust both the number of awards and the strike price of the awards that ensured the fair value of the option and award was the same immediately before and after the spin-off transaction.
     The following schedule summarizes the stock option activity for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006 (in millions except for per share amounts):
                 
            Weighted  
            Average  
    Shares     Exercise Price  
Balance, December 31, 2005
    9.0     $ 15.63  
 
           
Assumed in Certegy Merger
    4.4       27.23  
Assumed in the FNF Merger
    2.7       25.72  
Granted
    4.7       39.75  
Exercised
    (3.5 )     20.05  
Cancelled
    (0.2 )     15.89  
 
           
Balance, December 31, 2006
    17.1     $ 26.02  
 
           
Assumed in eFunds acquisition
    2.2       28.47  
Granted
    4.7       42.55  
Exercised
    (6.5 )     18.18  
Cancelled
    (0.2 )     20.07  
 
           
Balance, December 31, 2007
    17.3     $ 33.22  
 
           
Granted January 1, 2008 through July 2, 2008
    0.2       40.24  
Exercised January 1, 2008 through July 2, 2008
    (0.5 )     21.85  
Cancelled January 1, 2008 through July 2, 2008
    (0.2 )     31.02  
Cancelled and assumed by LPS in spin-off transaction
    (4.6 )     33.89  
 
           
Balance, July 2, 2008 before equity restructuring adjustment
    12.2       33.58  
 
           
Granted in LPS spin-off transaction
    9.7       (a )
 
           
Balance, July 2, 2008 post-equity restructuring adjustment
    21.9       18.71  
 
           
Granted July 3, 2008 through December 31, 2008
    4.7       14.46  
Exercised July 3, 2008 through December 31, 2008
    (0.6 )     13.78  
Cancelled July 3, 2008 through December 31, 2008
    (0.2 )     19.56  
 
           
Balance, December 31, 2008
    25.8     $ 17.95  
 
           
 
(a)   As a result of the LPS spin-off, all FIS stock options and awards held by LPS’ employees were cancelled and reissued as LPS stock options and awards and are accounted for in LPS’ financial results going forward. All stock options and awards held by employees that continued as FIS employees were adjusted using a conversion factor of 1.7952 to adjust both the number of awards and the strike price of these awards to ensure that their fair value was the same immediately before and after the spin-off.
     The intrinsic value of options exercised during the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006 was $11.4 million, $179.3 million and $68.1 million, respectively.

63


Table of Contents

     The following table summarizes information related to stock options outstanding and exercisable as of December 31:
                                                                 
Outstanding Options     Exercisable Options  
            Weighted                             Weighted              
            Average     Weighted     Intrinsic             Average     Weighted     Intrinsic  
    Number     Remaining     Average     Value at     Number     Remaining     Average     Value at  
    of     Contractual     Exercise     December 31,     of     Contractual     Exercise     December 31,  
Range of Exercise Price   Options     Life     Price     2008     Options     Life     Price     2008  
    (In millions)                     (In millions)                             (In millions)  
$0.00   - $8.71
    2.7       6.05     $ 8.65     $ 20.9       2.5       6.04     $ 8.64     $ 19.3  
$8.72   - $16.00
    6.9       5.51       13.73       17.5       2.2       2.71       12.41       8.5  
$16.01 - $22.35
    7.7       4.41       19.02       (a )     6.5       4.46       18.54       (a )
$22.36 - $22.75
    1.2       4.86       22.42       (a )     0.8       4.86       22.42       (a )
$22.76 - $23.25
    1.8       4.86       23.03       (a )     1.2       4.86       23.03       (a )
$23.26 - $23.50
    0.1       6.12       23.46       (a )                       (a )
$23.51 - $23.75
    5.3       5.77       23.71       (a )     2.0       5.77       23.71       (a )
$23.76 - $25.00
    0.1       6.69       24.89       (a )           6.69       24.89       (a )
 
                                                         
$0.00   - $61.00
    25.8       5.22     $ 17.95     $ 38.4       15.2       4.69     $ 17.24     $ 27.8  
 
                                                       
 
(a)   No intrinsic value as of December 31, 2008 .
     The Company has provided for total stock compensation expense of $60.7 million, $ 39.0 million and $50.1 million for 2008, 2007, and 2006, respectively, which is included in selling, general, and administrative expense in the Consolidated Statements of Earnings, unless the expense is attributable to a discontinued operation. The amount of stock compensation expense related to discontinued operations is $9.1 million, $14.0 million and $24.1 million in 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively, and has been reclassified accordingly. The year ended December 31, 2008, included stock compensation expense of $14.1 million relating to the acceleration of option vesting for all options held by eFunds employees prior to the merger and $2.6 million relating to the acceleration upon termination of certain executive unvested stock awards. The year ended December 31, 2007 included stock compensation expense of $2.2 million relating to the acceleration of option vesting upon termination of certain employees during the year. The year ended 2006 included stock compensation expense of $24.5 million relating to the FIS performance based options granted on March 9, 2005 for which the performance and market based criteria for vesting were met during the period and a $6.1 million charge relating to the acceleration of option vesting per the FNF Merger agreement.
     The weighted average fair value of options granted during 2008, 2007 and 2006 were estimated to be $3.84, $12.60 and $15.52, respectively, using the Black-Scholes option pricing model with the assumptions below:
                         
    2008   2007   2006
Risk free interest rate
    2.8 %     3.5 %     4.9 %
Volatility
    26.0 %     25.0 %     30.0 %
Dividend yield
    1.0 %     0.5 %     0.5 %
Weighed average expected life (years)
    5.3       5.8       6.4  
     At December 31, 2008 and 2007, the total unrecognized compensation cost related to non-vested stock awards is $69.3 million and $123.4 million, respectively, which is expected to be recognized in pre-tax income over a weighted average period of 1.6 years and 1.8 years, respectively. The amount for 2007 includes awards cancelled in the LPS spin.
     On October 25, 2006, our Board of Directors approved a plan authorizing repurchases of up to $200 million worth of our common stock (the “Old Plan”). On April 17, 2008, our Board of Directors approved a plan authorizing repurchases of up to an additional $250.0 million worth of our common stock (the “New Plan”). Under the New Plan we repurchased 5.8 million shares of our stock for $226.2 million, at an average price of $38.97 for the year ended December 31, 2008. During the year ended December 31, 2008, we also repurchased an additional 0.2 million shares of our stock for $10.0 million at an average price of $40.56 under the Old Plan. During 2007 and 2006, the Company repurchased 1.6 million shares and 4.3 million shares, respectively, at an average price of $49.15 and $37.60, respectively under the Old Plan.
     On March 20, 2008, we granted 0.4 million shares of restricted stock at a price of $38.75 that vest quarterly over 2 years. On July 2, 2008, $0.2 million of these shares were cancelled and assumed by LPS. The remaining unvested restricted shares were converted by the conversion factor of 1.7952. On October 27, 2008, we granted 0.8 million shares of restricted stock at a price of $14.35 that vest annually over 3 years. As of December 31, 2008, we have approximately 1.0 million unvested restricted shares remaining.

64


Table of Contents

Defined Benefit Plans
Certegy Pension Plan
     In connection with the Certegy Merger, the Company announced that it was going to terminate and settle the Certegy U.S. Retirement Income Plan (“USRIP”). The estimated impact of this settlement was reflected in the purchase price allocation as an increase in the pension liability, less the fair value of the pension plan assets, based on estimates of the total cost to settle the liability through the purchase of annuity contracts or lump sum settlements to the beneficiaries. The final USRIP settlement occurred during the fourth quarter of 2007 and was paid to the participant electing to take a lump-sum payment of their accrued benefit or receiving an annuity contract for their remaining benefit. The aggregate settlement value was $73.5 million. In addition the Company amended the Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan (“SERP”) to effectively freeze the benefits entitled under the plan resulting in a curtailment and settlement of that plan at December 31, 2007. The liabilities of that plan were then paid out in February 2008.
Kordoba
     In connection with the Kordoba acquisition, the Company assumed Kordoba’s unfunded, defined benefit plan obligations. These obligations relate to retirement benefits to be paid to Kordoba’s employees upon retirement. Total benefit costs for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006 were $2.9 million, $3.2 million and $3.3 million, respectively. The accumulated benefit obligation at December 31, 2008 and 2007 was $27.7 million and $28.9 million, respectively, and the projected benefit obligation was $28.6 million and $30.1 million, respectively. The plan remains unfunded as of December 31, 2008.
The measurement date for the Plan was December 31, 2008. The assumptions used to determine benefit obligations at December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006 and the periodic pension costs for the periods in each of the years then ended were as follows:
                         
    2008   2007   2006
Discount rate
    5.75 %     5.25 %     4.50 %
Salary projection rate
    3.00 %     3.00 %     2.50 %
     Estimated future benefit payments for the next five years and for the years from 2014 to 2018 are as follows (in millions):
         
2009
  $ 1.0
2010
    1.0
2011
    1.0
2012
    1.5
2013
    1.7
2014–2018
  $ 8.6
(19) Concentration of Risk
     The Company generates a significant amount of revenue from large customers, however, no customers accounted for more than 10% of total revenue or total segment revenue in the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006.
     Financial instruments that potentially subject the Company to concentrations of credit risk consist primarily of cash equivalents and trade receivables.
     The Company places its cash equivalents with high credit quality financial institutions and, by policy, limits the amount of credit exposure with any one financial institution.
     Concentrations of credit risk with respect to trade receivables are limited because a large number of geographically diverse customers make up the Company’s customer base, thus spreading the trade receivables credit risk. The Company controls credit risk through monitoring procedures.
(20) Segment Information
     On July 2, 2008, we completed the LPS spin-off. The results of operations of the lender processing services segment are reflected as discontinued operations in the Consolidated Statements of Earnings, in accordance with SFAS 144, for all periods presented. Prior to the LPS spin-off (see note 4), the Company operated in two reportable segments, Transaction Processing Services (TPS) and Lender Processing Services (LPS).

65


Table of Contents

     Subsequent to the LPS spin-off, we completed the previously announced review and restructuring of our reporting and management structure, and are now reporting the results of our operations in four new reporting segments: 1) Financial Solutions, 2) Payment Solutions, 3) International and 4) Corporate and Other. All periods presented have been conformed to reflect the segment changes.
     Summarized financial information for the Company’s segments is shown in the following tables.
     As of and for the year ended December 31, 2008 (in millions):
                                         
    Financial     Payment             Corporate        
    Solutions     Solutions     International     and Other     Total  
Processing and services revenues
  $ 1,158.8     $ 1,530.2     $ 759.5     $ (2.5 )   $ 3,446.0  
Operating expenses
    803.7       1,182.4       710.0       415.0       3,111.1  
 
                             
Operating income
  $ 355.1     $ 347.8     $ 49.5     $ (417.5 )     334.9  
 
                               
Other income (expense) unallocated
                                    (155.7 )
 
                                     
Income from continuing operations
                                  $ 179.2  
 
                                     
 
                                       
Depreciation and amortization
  $ 116.9     $ 46.4     $ 55.2     $ 203.3     $ 421.8  
 
                             
Capital expenditures
  $ 90.5     $ 32.6     $ 95.7     $ 11.2     $ 230.0  
 
                             
Total assets
  $ 2,873.7     $ 2,195.1     $ 1,349.2     $ 1,096.0     $ 7,514.0  
 
                             
Goodwill
  $ 2,096.4     $ 1,674.1     $ 423.5     $     $ 4,194.0  
 
                             
     As of and for the year ended December 31, 2007 (in millions):
                                         
    Financial     Payment             Corporate        
    Solutions     Solutions     International     and Other     Total  
Processing and services revenues
  $ 1,007.6     $ 1,298.8     $ 618.1     $ (3.5 )   $ 2,921.0  
Operating expenses
    804.5       1,007.0       573.4       254.2       2,639.1  
 
                             
Operating income
  $ 203.1     $ 291.8     $ 44.7     $ (257.7 )     281.9  
 
                               
Other income (expense) unallocated
                                    102.1  
 
                                     
Income from continuing operations
                                  $ 384.0  
 
                                     
 
                                       
Depreciation and amortization
  $ 152.0     $ 41.6     $ 45.1     $ 154.6     $ 393.3  
 
                             
Total assets
  $ 2,992.8     $ 2,386.6     $ 1,090.3     $ 1,180.9     $ 7,650.6  
 
                             
Goodwill
  $ 2,106.7     $ 1,682.4     $ 425.6     $     $ 4,214.7  
 
                             
     As of and for year ended December 31, 2006 (in millions):
                                         
    Financial     Payment             Corporate        
    Solutions     Solutions     International     and Other     Total  
Processing and services revenues
  $ 882.2     $ 1,120.5     $ 430.3     $ (16.5 )   $ 2,416.5  
Operating expenses
    700.8       866.6       392.0       263.5       2,222.9  
 
                             
Operating income
  $ 181.4     $ 253.9     $ 38.3     $ (280.0 )     193.6  
 
                               
Other income (expense) unallocated
                                    (188.4 )
 
                                     
Income from continuing operations
                                  $ 5.2  
 
                                     
 
                                       
Depreciation and amortization
  $ 119.4     $ 37.8     $ 24.3     $ 137.0     $ 318.5  
 
                             
Total assets
  $ 2,080.6     $ 1,459.0     $ 777.7     $ 1,241.8     $ 5,559.1  
 
                             
Goodwill
  $ 1,320.8     $ 1,054.8     $ 266.8     $     $ 2,642.4  
 
                             
     Enterprise-wide sales to non-U.S. based customers were $768.8 million, $620.9 million and $429.2 million in the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. Brazil, Germany and the U.K. accounted for the majority of the sales to non-U.S. based customers.
     Capital expenditures for the years ended 2007 and 2006 are not provided. We did not track capital expenditures in the prior periods consistent with the current segment reporting. Therefore, it was impracticable to obtain this information for periods other than 2008.
     Total assets and goodwill at December 31, 2007 and 2006, excludes total assets of $2,144.0 million and $2,071.5 million and goodwill of $1,112.1 million and $1,095.1 million, respectively, related to discontinued operations.
Financial Solutions

66


Table of Contents

     The Financial Solutions segment focuses on serving the processing needs of financial institutions of all sizes, commercial lenders, finance companies and other businesses. The Company’s primary software applications function as the underlying infrastructure of a financial institution’s processing environment. These applications include core bank processing software, which banks use to maintain the primary records of their customer accounts. The Company also provides a number of complementary applications and services that interact directly with the core processing applications, including applications that facilitate interactions between the Company’s financial institution customers and their clients. The Company offers applications and services through a range of delivery and service models, including on-site outsourcing and remote processing arrangements, as well as on a licensed software basis for installation on customer-owned and operated systems.
Payment Solutions
     The Payment Solutions segment focuses on serving the payment processing and risk management needs of financial institutions, retailers and other businesses. This segment includes card issuer services, which enable banks, credit unions, and others to issue VISA and MasterCard credit and debit cards, private label cards, and other electronic payment cards for use by both consumer and business accounts. In addition, this segment provides risk management services to retailers and financial institutions. The Company offers applications and services through a range of delivery and service models, including on-site outsourcing and remote processing arrangements, as well as on a licensed software basis for installation on customer-owned and operated systems.
International
     The International segment offers both financial solutions and payment solutions to a wide array of international financial institutions. Also, this segment includes the Company’s consolidated Brazilian card processing venture (see note 7). Included in this segment are long-term assets, excluding Goodwill and Other Intangible assets, located outside of the United States totaling $398.0 million, $332.1 million and $296.5 million at December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. These assets are predominantly located in Germany, Brazil, U.K. and India.
Corporate and Other
     The Corporate and Other segment consists of the corporate overhead costs that are not allocated to any operating segments. These include costs related to human resources, finance, accounting, domestic sales and marketing and amortization of acquisition related intangibles and other costs that are not considered when management evaluates segment performance.

67


Table of Contents

Item 9. Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure.
     None.
Item 9A. Controls and Procedures.
     As of the end of the year covered by this report, the Company carried out an evaluation, under the supervision and with the participation of its principal executive officer and principal financial officer, of the effectiveness of the design and operation of its disclosure controls and procedures, as such term is defined in Rule 13a-15 (e) under the Exchange Act. Based on this evaluation, the Company’s principal executive officer and principal financial officer concluded that its disclosure controls and procedures are effective to provide reasonable assurance that its disclosure controls and procedures will timely alert them to material information required to be included in the Company’s periodic SEC reports.
     There were no changes in our internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the most recent fiscal quarter that have materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal control over financial reporting.
MANAGEMENT’S REPORT ON INTERNAL CONTROL OVER FINANCIAL REPORTING
     Management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting, as such term is defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f). Under the supervision and with the participation of our management, including our principal executive officer and principal financial officer, we conducted an evaluation of the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting. Management has adopted the framework in Internal Control — Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO). Based on our evaluation under this framework, our management concluded that our internal control over financial reporting was effective as of December 31, 2008. KPMG LLP, an independent registered public accounting firm has issued an attestation report on our internal control over financial reporting as set forth in Item 8.
Item 9B. Other Information.
     On October 29, 2009, we granted non-qualified stock options and restricted stock pursuant to the Fidelity National Information Services, Inc. 2008 Omnibus Incentive Plan to the following executive officers: William P. Foley — 587,500 non-qualified stock options and 146,875 shares of restricted stock; Lee A. Kennedy — 763,750 non-qualified stock options and 190,938 shares of restricted stock; George P. Scanlon — 270,250 non-qualified stock options and 67,563 shares of restricted stock; Brent B. Bickett — 141,000 non-qualified stock options and 35,250 shares of restricted stock;. In each case, the stock options were awarded with an exercise price equal to the fair market value of a share on the date of grant, vest proportionately each year over three years and have a seven year term. In each case, the restricted stock vests proportionately each year over three years.
PART III
Items 10-14.
     Within 120 days after the close of its fiscal year, the Company intends to file with the Securities and Exchange Commission a definitive proxy statement pursuant to Regulation 14A of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 as amended, which will include the matters required by these items.
PART IV
Item 15. Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules
  (1)   Financial Statement Schedules:
 
      All schedules have been omitted because they are not applicable or the required information is included in the Consolidated Financial Statements or Notes to the statements.
 
  (2)   Exhibits:
 
      The following is a complete list of exhibits included as part of this report, including those incorporated by reference. A list of those documents filed with this report is set forth on the Exhibit Index appearing elsewhere in this report and is incorporated by reference.

68


Table of Contents

     
Exhibit    
No.   Description
2.1
  Agreement and Plan of Merger, dated as of September 14, 2005, among Certegy Inc., C Co. Merger Sub, LLC and Fidelity National Information Services, Inc. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.1 to Current Report on Form 8-K filed on September 16, 2005).
 
   
2.2
  Agreement and Plan of Merger, dated as of June 25, 2006 and amended and restated as of September 18, 2006, between Fidelity National Information Services, Inc. and Fidelity National Financial, Inc. (incorporated by reference to Annex A to Amendment No. 1 to Registration Statement on Form S-4 filed on September 18, 2006).
 
   
3.1
  Amended and Restated Articles of Incorporation of Fidelity National Information Services, Inc. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to Current Report on Form 8-K filed on February 6, 2006).
 
   
3.2
  Amended and Restated Bylaws of Fidelity National Information Services, Inc. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.2 to Current Report on Form 8-K filed on February 6, 2006).
 
   
4.1
  Registration Rights Agreement, dated as of February 1, 2006, among Fidelity National Information Services, Inc. and the security holders named therein (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 to Current Report on Form 8-K filed on February 6, 2006).
 
   
4.2
  Form of certificate representing Fidelity National Information Services, Inc. Common Stock (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.3 to Registration Statement on Form S-3 filed on February 6, 2006).
 
   
10.1
  Assignment and Assumption of Lease and Other Operative Documents, dated as of June 25, 2001, among Equifax Inc., Certegy Inc., Prefco VI Limited Partnership, Atlantic Financial Group, Ltd. and SunTrust Bank (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on August 14, 2001).
 
   
10.1(a)
  Omnibus Amendment to Master Agreement, Lease, Loan Agreement and Definitions Appendix A, dated as of September 17, 2004, entered into among Certegy Inc., Prefco VI Limited Partnership and SunTrust Bank (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3(a) to Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on November 9, 2004).
 
   
10.2
  Tax Sharing and Indemnification Agreement, dated as of June 30, 2001, between Equifax Inc. and Certegy Inc. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 to Current Report on Form 8-K filed on July 20, 2001).
 
   
10.3
  Certegy Inc. Executive Life and Supplemental Retirement Benefit Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.13 to Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on March 25, 2002). (1)
 
   
10.4
  Grantor Trust Agreement, dated as of July 8, 2001, between Certegy Inc. and Wachovia Bank, N.A. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.15 to Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on March 25, 2002).
 
   
10.4(a)
  Grantor Trust Agreement, dated as of July 8, 2001 and amended and restated as of December 5, 2003, between Certegy Inc. and Wachovia Bank, N.A. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.15(a) to Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on February 17, 2004).
 
   
10.5
  Intellectual Property Agreement, dated as of June 30, 2001, between Equifax Inc. and Certegy Inc. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.5 to Current Report on Form 8-K filed on July 20, 2001).
 
   
10.6
  Agreement Regarding Leases, dated as of June 30, 2001, between Equifax Inc. and Certegy Payment Services, Inc. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.6 to Current Report on Form 8-K filed on July 20, 2001).
 
   
10.7
  Certegy Inc. Non-Employee Director Stock Option Plan, effective as of June 15, 2001 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.24 to Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on March 25, 2002). (1)
 
   
10.8
  Certegy Inc. Deferred Compensation Plan, effective as of June 15, 2001 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.25 to Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on March 25, 2002). (1)
 
   
10.9
  Certegy 2002 Bonus Deferral Program Terms and Conditions (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.29 to Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on March 25, 2002). (1)
 
   
10.10
  Certegy Inc. Officers’ Group Personal Excess Liability Insurance Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.30 to Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on March 25, 2002). (1)
 
   
10.11
  2003 Renewal Service Agreement, dated as of June 1, 2003, between ICBA Bancard, Inc. and Certegy Card Services, Inc. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.36 to Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on February 17, 2004).
 
   
10.12
  2004 Restated CSCU Card Processing Service Agreement, dated as of January 1, 2004, between Card Services for Credit Unions, Inc. and Certegy Card Services, Inc. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.37 to Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on February 17, 2004).
 
   
10.13
  Certegy Inc. Special Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan, effective as of November 7, 2003 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.38 to Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on February 17, 2004). (1)

69


Table of Contents

     
Exhibit    
No.   Description
10.14
  Certegy Inc. Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan, effective as of November 5, 2003 (the “SERP”) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.39 to Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on February 17, 2004). (1)
 
   
10.15
  Amendment to the SERP, dated as of December 31, 2007 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to Current Report on Form 8-K filed on January 2, 2008). (1)
 
   
10.16
  Lee A. Kennedy’s Payment Election Form under the SERP, dated as of December 31, 2007 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to Current Report on Form 8-K filed on January 2, 2008). (1)
 
   
10.17
  Certegy Inc. Executive Life and Supplemental Retirement Benefit Plan Split Dollar Life Insurance Agreement, effective as of November 7, 2003 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.40 to Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on February 17, 2004). (1)
 
   
10.18
  Master Agreement for Operations Support Services, dated as of June 29, 2001, between Certegy Inc. and International Business Machines Corporation (the “Master Agreement”) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.42 to Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on February 17, 2004). (Document omits information pursuant to a Request for Confidential Treatment granted under Rule 24b-2 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.)
 
   
10.19
  Transaction Document #03-01 under the Master Agreement, effective as of March 5, 2003, between Certegy Inc. and International Business Machines Corporation (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.43 to Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on February 17, 2004). (Document omits information pursuant to a Request for Confidential Treatment granted under Rule 24b-2 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.)
 
   
10.20
  Certegy Inc. Stock Incentive Plan Restricted Stock Unit Award Agreement, dated as of June 18, 2004 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.44 to Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on August 6, 2004). (1)
 
   
10.21
  Form of Certegy Inc. Restricted Stock Units Deferral Election Agreement for 2004 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.45 to Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on August 6, 2004). (1)
 
   
10.22
  Form of Certegy Inc. Annual Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.46 to Current Report on Form 8-K filed on February 10, 2005). (1)
 
   
10.23
  Form of Certegy Inc. Non-Qualified Stock Option Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.47 to Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on March 11, 2005). (1)
 
   
10.24
  Form of Certegy Inc. Stock Incentive Plan Restricted Stock Unit Award Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.48 to Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on March 11, 2005). (1)
 
   
10.25
  Form of Certegy Inc. Stock Incentive Plan Restricted Stock Award Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.49 to Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on March 11, 2005). (1)
 
   
10.26
  Form of Notice of Restricted Stock Grant and Restricted Stock Award Agreement under Fidelity National Information Services, Inc. (f/k/a Certegy Inc.) Stock Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 to Current Report on Form 8-K filed on March 25, 2008). (1)
 
   
10.27
  Credit Agreement, dated as of January 18, 2007, among Fidelity National Information Services, Inc., certain of its subsidiaries, JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., Bank of America, N.A., and other financial institutions party thereto (the “Credit Agreement”) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to Current Report on Form 8-K filed on January 19, 2007).
 
   
10.28
  Amendment No. 1 to the Credit Agreement, dated as of July 30, 2007 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to Current Report on Form 8-K filed on September 18, 2007).
 
   
10.29
  Joinder Agreement, dated as of September 12, 2007, by and among Fidelity National Information Services, Inc., Bank of America, N.A., JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. and Wachovia Bank N.A. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to Current Report on Form 8-K filed on September 18, 2007).
 
   
10.30
  Fidelity National Information Services, Inc. 2005 Stock Incentive Plan, effective as of March 9, 2005 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.84 to Annual Report on Form 10-K of Fidelity National Financial, Inc. filed on March 16, 2005). (1)
 
   
10.31
  Form of Non-Qualified Stock Option Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.10 to Current Report on Form 8-K filed on February 6, 2006). (1)
 
   
10.32
  Form of Non-Qualified Stock Option Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.11 to Current Report on Form 8-K filed on February 6, 2006). (1)
 
   
10.33
  Amended and Restated Certegy Inc. Stock Incentive Plan, effective as of June 15, 2001 and amended and restated as of October 23, 2006 (incorporated by reference to Annex B to Amendment No. 1 to Registration Statement on Form S-4 filed on September 19, 2006). (1)

70


Table of Contents

     
Exhibit    
No.   Description
10.34
  Form of Amendment to Change in Control Letter Agreements (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.36 to Current Report on Form 8-K filed on February 6, 2006). (1)
 
   
10.35
  Granite Financial, Inc. Omnibus Stock Plan of 1996, amended and restated as of April 24, 1997 and June 14, 1997 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3.1 to Amendment No. 4 to Registration Statement on Form SB-2 of Granite Financial, Inc. filed on July 23, 1997). (1)
 
   
10.36
  Fidelity National Financial, Inc. Amended and Restated 1998 Stock Incentive Plan, amended and restated as of July 24, 2001 and as of November 12, 2004 and effective as of December 16, 2004 (incorporated by reference to Annex C to Definitive Proxy Statement on Schedule 14A of Fidelity National Financial, Inc. filed on November 15, 2004).
 
   
10.37
  Fidelity National Financial, Inc. Amended and Restated 2001 Stock Incentive Plan, amended and restated as of July 24, 2001 and as of November 12, 2004 and effective as of December 16, 2004 (incorporated by reference to Annex B to Definitive Proxy Statement on Schedule 14A of Fidelity National Financial, Inc. filed on November 15, 2004).
 
   
10.38
  Fidelity National Information Solutions, Inc. 2001 Stock Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to Registration Statement on Form S-8 of Fidelity National Information Solutions, Inc. filed on December 14, 2001). (1)
 
   
10.39
  Vista Information Solutions, Inc. 1999 Stock Option Plan, effective as of January 27, 1999 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.42 to Annual Report on Form 10-KSB of Fidelity National Information Solutions, Inc. filed on April 14, 2000). (1)
 
   
10.40
  Micro General Corporation 1999 Stock Incentive Plan, effective as of November 17, 1999 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to Registration Statement on Form S-8 of Micro General Corporation filed on February 1, 2000). (1)
 
   
10.41
  Micro General Corporation 1998 Stock Incentive Plan, effective as of June 3, 1998 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to Registration Statement on Form S-8 of Micro General Corporation filed on September 25, 1998). (1)
 
   
10.42
  Vista Environmental Information, Inc. 1993 Stock Option Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 to Registration Statement on Form S-8 of Fidelity National Information Solutions, Inc. filed on August 21, 1996). (1)
 
   
10.43
  DataMap, Inc. 1995 Stock Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.2 to Registration Statement on Form S-8 of Fidelity National Information Solutions, Inc. filed on August 21, 1996). (1)
 
   
10.44
  Form of Stock Option Agreement and Notice of Stock Option Grant under Fidelity National Information Services, Inc. 2005 Stock Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 to Current Report on Form 8-K of Fidelity National Financial, Inc. filed on March 21, 2005). (1)
 
   
10.45
  Sanchez Computer Associates, Inc. Amended and Restated 1995 Equity Compensation Plan, effective as of October 9, 1995 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 to Registration Statement on Form S-8 of Fidelity National Financial, Inc. filed on April 15, 2004). (1)
 
   
10.46
  InterCept Group, Inc. Amended and Restated 1996 Stock Option Plan, InterCept, Inc. 2002 Stock Option Plan and InterCept, Inc. G. Lynn Boggs 2002 Stock Option Plan, all amended and restated as of November 8, 2004 (incorporated by reference to Exhibits 99.2, 99.3 and 99.4, respectively, to Registration Statement on Form S-8 of Fidelity National Financial, Inc. filed on November 23, 2004). (1)
 
   
10.47
  Fidelity National Financial Inc. 2004 Omnibus Incentive Plan, effective as of December 16, 2004 (incorporated by reference to Annex A to Definitive Proxy Statement on Schedule 14A of Fidelity National Financial, Inc. filed on November 15, 2004). (1)
 
   
10.48
  Notice of Stock Option Grant under Fidelity National Financial, Inc. 2004 Omnibus Incentive Plan, effective as of August 19, 2005 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 to Current Report on Form 8-K of Fidelity National Financial, Inc. filed on August 25, 2005).
 
   
10.49
  Fidelity National Information Services, Inc. 2008 Omnibus Incentive Plan, effective as of May 29, 2008 (incorporated by reference to Annex A to Definitive Proxy Statement on Schedule 14A filed on April 15, 2008). (1)
 
   
10.50
  Form of Notice of Restricted Stock Grant and Restricted Stock Award Agreement under Fidelity National Information Services, Inc. 2008 Omnibus Incentive Plan (1)
 
   
10.51
  Form of Notice of Stock Option Grant and Stock Option Agreement under Fidelity National Information Services, Inc. 2008 Omnibus Incentive Plan (1)

71


Table of Contents

     
Exhibit    
No.   Description
10.52
  Employment Agreement, effective as of May 1, 2008, between Fidelity National Information Services, Inc. and Lee A. Kennedy (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on May 8, 2008). (1)
 
   
10.53
  Fidelity National Information Services, Inc. Employee Stock Purchase Plan, effective as of March 16, 2006 (incorporated by reference to Annex C to Amendment No. 1 to Registration Statement on Form S-4 filed on September 19, 2006). (1)
 
   
10.54
  Fidelity National Information Services, Inc. Annual Incentive Plan, effective as of October 23, 2006 (incorporated by reference to Annex D to Amendment No. 1 to Registration Statement on Form S-4 filed on September 19, 2006).
 
   
10.55
  Tax Disaffiliation Agreement, dated as of October 23, 2006, by and among Fidelity National Financial, Inc., Fidelity National Title Group, Inc. and Fidelity National Information Services, Inc. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 to Current Report on Form 8-K filed on October 27, 2006).
 
   
10.56
  Cross-Indemnity Agreement, dated as of October 23, 2006, by and between Fidelity National Information Services, Inc. and Fidelity National Title Group, Inc. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.2 to Current Report on Form 8-K filed on October 27, 2006).
 
   
10.57
  Employment Agreement, effective as of May 1, 2008, between Fidelity National Information Services, Inc. and Francis R. Sanchez. (1)
 
   
10.58
  Employment Agreement, effective as of July 2, 2008, between Fidelity National Information Services, Inc. and William P. Foley, II. (1)
 
   
10.59
  Employment Agreement, effective as of July 2, 2008, between Fidelity National Information Services, Inc. and Brent B. Bickett. (1)
 
   
10.60
  Employment Agreement, effective as of November 16, 2007, between Fidelity National Information Services, Inc. and Gary A. Norcross (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.58 to Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on February 29, 2008). (1)
 
   
10.61
  Employment Agreement, effective as of May 1, 2008, between Fidelity National Information Services, Inc. and George P. Scanlon (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.4 to Current Report on Form 8-K filed on July 9, 2008). (1)
 
   
10.62
  Employment Agreement, effective as of June 30, 2008, between Fidelity National Information Services, Inc. and James W. Woodall (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.5 to Current Report on Form 8-K filed on July 9, 2008). (1)
 
   
10.63
  Form of Fidelity National Information Services, Inc. (f/k/a Certegy Inc.) Non-Qualified Stock Option Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.56 to Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on March 1, 2007). (1)
 
   
21.1
  Subsidiaries of the Registrant.
 
   
23.1
  Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm (KPMG LLP).
 
   
31.1
  Certification of Lee A. Kennedy, Chief Executive Officer of Fidelity National Information Services, Inc., pursuant to rule 13a-14(a) or 15d-14(a) of the Exchange Act, as adopted pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
 
   
31.2
  Certification of George P. Scanlon, Chief Financial Officer of Fidelity National Information Services, Inc., pursuant to rule 13a-14(a) or 15d-14(a) of the Exchange Act, as adopted pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
 
   
32.1
  Certification of Lee A. Kennedy, Chief Executive Officer of Fidelity National Information Services, Inc., pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
 
   
32.2
  Certification of George P. Scanlon, Chief Financial Officer of Fidelity National Information Services, Inc., pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
 
(1)   Management Contract or Compensatory Plan.

72


Table of Contents

SIGNATURES
     Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.
         
Date: February 27, 2009  Fidelity National Information Services, Inc.
 
 
  By:   /s/ Lee A. Kennedy    
    Lee A. Kennedy   
    President and Chief Executive Officer   
 
     Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated.
         
     
Date: February 27, 2009  By:   /s/ William P. Foley, II    
    William P. Foley, II   
    Chairman of the Board   
 
     
Date: February 27, 2009  By:   /s/ Lee A. Kennedy    
    Lee A. Kennedy   
    President and Chief Executive Officer;
Director (Principal Executive Officer) 
 
 
     
Date: February 27, 2009  By:   /s/ george p. scanlon    
    George P. Scanlon   
    Executive Vice President and Chief
Financial Officer (Principal Financial
Officer and Principal Accounting Officer) 
 
 
     
Date: February 27, 2009  By:   /s/ Thomas M. Hagerty    
    Thomas M. Hagerty,   
    Director   
 
     
Date: February 27, 2009  By:   /s/ Keith W. Hughes    
    Keith W. Hughes,   
    Director   
 
     
Date: February 27, 2009  By:   /s/ David K. Hunt    
    David K. Hunt,   
    Director   
 
     
Date: February 27, 2009  By:   /s/ Robert M. Clements    
    Robert M. Clements,   
    Director   
 
     
Date: February 27, 2009  By:   /s/ Richard N. Massey    
    Richard N. Massey,   
    Director   

73


Table of Contents

         
FIDELITY NATIONAL INFORMATION SERVICES, INC.
FORM 10-K
INDEX TO EXHIBITS
     The following documents are being filed with this Report:
     
Exhibit    
No.   Description
10.50
  Form of Notice of Restricted Stock Grant and Restricted Stock Award Agreement under Fidelity National Information Services, Inc. 2008 Omnibus Incentive Plan (1)
 
   
10.51
  Form of Notice of Stock Option Grant and Stock Option Agreement under Fidelity National Information Services, Inc. 2008 Omnibus Incentive Plan (1)
 
   
10.57
  Employment Agreement, effective as of May 1, 2008, between Fidelity National Information Services, Inc. and Francis R. Sanchez. (1)
 
   
10.58
  Employment Agreement, effective as of July 2, 2008, between Fidelity National Information Services, Inc. and William P. Foley, II. (1)
 
   
10.59
  Employment Agreement, effective as of July 2, 2008, between Fidelity National Information Services, Inc. and Brent B. Bickett. (1)
 
   
21.1
  Subsidiaries of the Registrant.
 
   
23.1
  Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm (KPMG LLP).
 
   
31.1
  Certification of Lee A. Kennedy, Chief Executive Officer of Fidelity National Information Services, Inc., pursuant to rule 13a-14(a) or 15d-14(a) of the Exchange Act, as adopted pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
 
   
31.2
  Certification of George P. Scanlon, Chief Financial Officer of Fidelity National Information Services, Inc., pursuant to rule 13a-14(a) or 15d-14(a) of the Exchange Act, as adopted pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
 
   
32.1
  Certification of Lee A. Kennedy, Chief Executive Officer of Fidelity National Information Services, Inc., pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
 
   
32.2
  Certification of George P. Scanlon, Chief Financial Officer of Fidelity National Information Services, Inc., pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
 
(1)   Management Contract or Compensatory Plan.

74

EX-10.50
Exhibit 10.50
Fidelity National Information Services, Inc.
2008 Omnibus Incentive Plan
Notice of Stock Option Grant
     You (the “Optionee”) have been granted the following option (the “Option”) to purchase Common Stock of Fidelity National Information Services, Inc. (the “Company”), par value $0.01 per share (“Share”), pursuant to the Fidelity National Information Services, Inc. 2008 Omnibus Incentive Plan (the “Plan”):
     
Name of Optionee:
   
 
Total Number of Shares Subject to Option:
   
 
Type of Option:
  Nonqualified
 
Exercise Price Per Share:
  $
 
Effective Date of Grant:
   
 
Vesting Schedule:
  Subject to the terms of the Plan and the Stock Option Agreement attached hereto, the right to exercise this Option shall vest with respect to one-third of the total number of Shares subject to this Option on each anniversary of the Effective Date of Grant, until fully vested.
 
Expiration Date:
  7th Anniversary of Effective Date of Grant
 
 
  The Option is subject to earlier expiration, as provided in Section 3(b) of the attached Stock Option Agreement.
By your signature and the signature of the Company’s representative below, you and the Company agree and acknowledge that this Option is granted under and governed by the terms and conditions of the Plan and the attached Stock Option Agreement, which are incorporated herein by reference, and that you have been provided with a copy of the Plan and Stock Option Agreement.
         
Optionee:   Fidelity National Information
      Services, Inc.
 
    By:  
(Name) 
    Name:  
Date:
    Title:  
Address: 
       
       

 


 

Fidelity National Information Services, Inc.
2008 Omnibus Incentive Plan
Stock Option Agreement
   SECTION 1. GRANT OF OPTION.
     (a) Option. On the terms and conditions set forth in the Notice of Stock Option Grant and this Stock Option Agreement (the “Agreement”), the Company grants to the Optionee on the Effective Date of Grant the option (the “Option”) to purchase at the Exercise Price the number of Shares set forth in the Notice of Stock Option Grant.
     (b) Plan and Defined Terms. The Option is granted pursuant to the Plan. All terms, provisions, and conditions applicable to the Option set forth in the Plan and not set forth herein are hereby incorporated by reference herein. To the extent any provision hereof is inconsistent with a provision of the Plan, the provisions of the Plan will govern. All capitalized terms that are used in the Notice of Stock Option Grant or this Agreement and not otherwise defined therein or herein shall have the meanings ascribed to them in the Plan.
   SECTION 2. RIGHT TO EXERCISE.
     The Option hereby granted shall be exercised by written notice to the Committee, specifying the number of Shares the Optionee desires to purchase together with provision for payment of the Exercise Price. Subject to such limitations as the Committee may impose (including prohibition of one more of the following payment methods), payment of the Exercise Price may be made by (a) check payable to the order of the Company, for an amount in United States dollars equal to the aggregate Exercise Price of such Shares, (b) by tendering to the Company Shares having an aggregate Fair Market Value equal to such Exercise Price, (c) by broker-assisted exercise, or (d) by a combination of such methods. The Company may require the Optionee to furnish or execute such other documents as the Company shall reasonably deem necessary (i) to evidence such exercise and (ii) to comply with or satisfy the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, the Exchange Act, applicable state or non-U.S. securities laws or any other law.
   SECTION 3. TERM AND EXPIRATION.
     (a) Basic Term. Subject to earlier termination pursuant to the terms here, the Option shall expire on the expiration date set forth in the Notice of Stock Option Grant.
     (b) Termination of Employment or Service. If the Optionee’s employment or service as a Director or Consultant, as the case may be, is terminated, the Option shall expire on the earliest of the following occasions:
     (i) The expiration date set forth in the Notice of Stock Option Grant;

-1-


 

     (ii) The date three months following the termination of the Optionee’s employment or service for any reason other than Cause, death, or Disability;
     (iii) The date one year following the termination of the Optionee’s employment or service due to death or Disability; or
     (iv) The date of termination of the Optionee’s employment or service for Cause.
The Optionee may exercise all or part of this Option at any time before its expiration under the preceding sentence, but, subject to the following sentence, only to the extent that the Option had become vested before the Optionee’s employment or service terminated. When the Optionee’s employment or service terminates, this Option shall expire immediately with respect to the number of Shares for which the Option is not yet vested. If the Optionee dies after termination of employment or service, but before the expiration of the Option, all or part of this Option may be exercised (prior to expiration) by the personal representative of the Optionee or by any person who has acquired this Option directly from the Optionee by will, bequest or inheritance, but only to the extent that the Option was vested and exercisable upon termination of the Optionee’s employment or service.
     (c) Definition of “Cause.” The term “Cause” shall have the meaning ascribed to such term in the Optionee’s employment agreement with the Company or any Subsidiary. If the Optionee’s employment agreement does not define the term “Cause,” or if the Optionee has not entered into an employment agreement with the Company or any Subsidiary, the term “Cause” shall mean (i) the willful engaging by the Optionee in misconduct that is demonstrably injurious to the Company or any Parent or Subsidiary (monetarily or otherwise), (ii) the Optionee’s conviction of, or pleading guilty or nolo contendere to, a felony involving moral turpitude, or (iii) the Optionee’s violation of any confidentiality, non-solicitation, or non-competition covenant to which the Optionee is subject.
     (d) Definition of “Disability.” The term “Disability” shall have the meaning ascribed to such term in the Optionee’s employment agreement with the Company or any Subsidiary. If the Optionee’s employment agreement does not define the term “Disability,” or if the Optionee has not entered into an employment agreement with the Company or any Subsidiary, the term “Disability” shall mean the Optionee’s entitlement to long-term disability benefits pursuant to the long-term disability plan maintained by the Company or in which the Company’s employees participate.
   SECTION 4. TRANSFERABILITY OF OPTION.
     The Option shall not be transferable by the Optionee other than by will or the laws of descent and distribution, and the Option shall be exercisable during the Optionee’s lifetime only by the Optionee or on his or her behalf by the Optionee’s guardian or legal representative.
   SECTION 5. MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS.
     (a) Acknowledgements. The Optionee hereby acknowledges that he or she has read and understands the terms of the Plan and this Agreement, and agrees to be bound by their respective terms and conditions. The Optionee acknowledges that there may be tax consequences upon the

-2-


 

exercise or transfer of the Option and that the Optionee should consult an independent tax advisor prior to any exercise of the Option.
     (b) Tax Withholding. Pursuant to Article 20 of the Plan, the Committee shall have the power and the right to deduct or withhold, or require the Optionee to remit to the Company, an amount sufficient to satisfy any federal, state and local taxes (including the Optionee’s FICA obligations) required by law to be withheld with respect to this Option. The Committee may condition the delivery of Shares upon the Optionee’s satisfaction of such withholding obligations. The Optionee may elect to satisfy all or part of such withholding requirement by tendering previously-owned Shares or by having the Company withhold Shares having a Fair Market Value equal to the minimum statutory withholding (based on minimum statutory withholding rates for federal, state and local tax purposes, as applicable, including payroll taxes) that could be imposed on the transaction, and, to the extent the Committee so permits, amounts in excess of the minimum statutory withholding to the extent it would not result in additional accounting expense. Such election shall be irrevocable, made in writing, signed by the Optionee, and shall be subject to any restrictions or limitations that the Committee, in its sole discretion, deems appropriate.
     (c) Notice Concerning Disqualifying Dispositions. If the Option is an Incentive Stock Option, the Optionee shall notify the Committee of any disposition of Shares issued pursuant to the exercise of the Option if the disposition constitutes a “disqualifying disposition” within the meaning of Sections 421 and 422 of the Code (or any successor provision of the Code then in effect relating to disqualifying dispositions). Such notice shall be provided by the Optionee to the Committee in writing within 10 days of any such disqualifying disposition.
     (d) Rights as a Stockholder. Neither the Optionee nor the Optionee’s transferee or representative shall have any rights as a stockholder with respect to any Shares subject to this Option until the Option has been exercised and Share certificates have been issued to the Optionee, transferee or representative, as the case may be.
     (e) Ratification of Actions. By accepting this Agreement, the Optionee and each person claiming under or through the Optionee shall be conclusively deemed to have indicated the Optionee’s acceptance and ratification of, and consent to, any action taken under the Plan or this Agreement and Notice of Stock Option Grant by the Company, the Board, or the Committee.
     (f) Notice. Any notice required by the terms of this Agreement shall be given in writing and shall be deemed effective upon personal delivery or upon deposit with the United States Postal Service, by registered or certified mail, with postage and fees prepaid. Notice shall be addressed to the Company at its principal executive office and to the Optionee at the address that he or she most recently provided in writing to the Company.
     (g) Choice of Law. This Agreement and the Notice of Stock Option Grant shall be governed by, and construed in accordance with, the laws of Florida, without regard to any conflicts of law or choice of law rule or principle that might otherwise cause the Plan, this Agreement or the Notice of Stock Option Grant to be governed by or construed in accordance with the substantive law of another jurisdiction.

-3-


 

     (h) Arbitration. Subject to, and in accordance with the provisions of Article 3 of the Plan, any dispute or claim arising out of or relating to the Plan, this Agreement or the Notice of Stock Option Grant shall be settled by binding arbitration before a single arbitrator in Jacksonville, Florida and in accordance with the Commercial Arbitration Rules of the American Arbitration Association. The arbitrator shall decide any issues submitted in accordance with the provisions and commercial purposes of the Plan, this Agreement and the Notice of Stock Option Grant, provided that all substantive questions of law shall be determined in accordance with the state and Federal laws applicable in Florida, without regard to internal principles relating to conflict of laws.
     (i) Modification or Amendment. This Agreement may only be modified or amended by written agreement executed by the parties hereto; provided, however, that the adjustments permitted pursuant to Article 4.3 of the Plan may be made without such written agreement.
     (j) Severability. In the event any provision of this Agreement shall be held illegal or invalid for any reason, the illegality or invalidity shall not affect the remaining provisions of this Agreement, and this Agreement shall be construed and enforced as if such illegal or invalid provision had not been included.
     (k) References to Plan. All references to the Plan shall be deemed references to the Plan as may be amended from time to time.
     (l) Section 409A Compliance. To the extent applicable, it is intended that the Plan and this Agreement comply with the requirements of Code Section 409A and any related regulations or other guidance promulgated with respect to such Section by the U.S. Department of the Treasury or the Internal Revenue Service and the Plan and the Award Agreement shall be interpreted accordingly.

-4-

EX-10.51
Exhibit 10.51
Fidelity National Information services, Inc.
2008 Omnibus Incentive Plan
Notice of Restricted Stock Grant
     You (the “Grantee”) have been granted the following award of restricted Common Stock (the “Restricted Stock”) of Fidelity National Information Services, Inc. (the “Company”), par value $0.01 per share (the “Shares”), pursuant to the Fidelity National Information Services, Inc. 2008 Omnibus Incentive Plan (the “Plan”):
     
Name of Grantee:
   
 
Number of Shares of Restricted Stock Granted:
   
 
Effective Date of Grant:
   
 
Vesting and Period of Restriction:
  Subject to the terms of the Plan and the Restricted Stock Award Agreement attached hereto, the Period of Restriction shall lapse, and the shares of Restricted Stock granted hereunder shall vest and become free of the forfeiture and transfer restrictions contained in the Restricted Stock Award Agreement, with respect to one-third of the total number of Shares of Restricted Stock granted hereunder on each anniversary of the Effective Date of Grant, until fully vested.
By your signature and the signature of the Company’s representative below, you and the Company agree and acknowledge that this grant of Restricted Stock is granted under and governed by the terms and conditions of the Plan and the attached Restricted Stock Award Agreement, which are incorporated herein by reference, and that you have been provided with a copy of the Plan and Restricted Stock Agreement.
         
Grantee:   Fidelity National Information
      Services, Inc.
 
    By:  
(Name) 
    Name:  
Date:
    Title:  
Address: 
       
       

 


 

Fidelity National Information Services, Inc.
2008 Omnibus Incentive Plan
Restricted Stock Award Agreement
SECTION 1. GRANT OF RESTRICTED STOCK
     (a) Restricted Stock. On the terms and conditions set forth in the Notice of Restricted Stock Grant and this Restricted Stock Award Agreement (the “Agreement”), the Company grants to the Grantee on the Effective Date of Grant the Shares of Restricted Stock (the “Restricted Stock”) set forth in the Notice of Restricted Stock Grant.
     (b) Plan and Defined Terms. The Restricted Stock is granted pursuant to the Plan. All terms, provisions, and conditions applicable to the Restricted Stock set forth in the Plan and not set forth herein are hereby incorporated by reference herein. To the extent any provision hereof is inconsistent with a provision of the Plan, the provisions of the Plan will govern. All capitalized terms that are used in the Notice of Restricted Stock Grant or this Agreement and not otherwise defined therein or herein shall have the meanings ascribed to them in the Plan.
SECTION 2. FORFEITURE AND TRANSFER RESTRICTIONS
     (a) Forfeiture Restrictions. If the Grantee’s employment or service as a Director or Consultant, as the case may be, is terminated for any reason other than (i) death, (ii) Disability (as defined below) or (iii) termination by the Company and its Subsidiaries without Cause (as defined below), the Grantee shall, for no consideration, forfeit to the Company the Shares of Restricted Stock to the extent such Shares are subject to a Period of Restriction at the time of such termination. If the Grantee’s employment or service as a Director or Consultant, as the case may be, terminates due to the Grantee’s death or Disability, or is terminated by the Company and its Subsidiaries without Cause, while Shares of Restricted Stock are subject to a Period of Restriction, the Period of Restriction with respect to such Shares shall lapse, and the Shares shall vest and become free of the forfeiture and transfer restrictions described in this Section 2, on the date of the Grantee’s termination of employment or service.
           (i) The term “Cause” shall have the meaning ascribed to such term in the Grantee’s employment agreement with the Company or any Subsidiary. If the Grantee’s employment agreement does not define the term “Cause,” or if the Grantee has not entered into an employment agreement with the Company or any Subsidiary, the term “Cause” shall mean (A) the willful engaging by the Grantee in misconduct that is demonstrably injurious to the Company or any Parent or Subsidiary (monetarily or otherwise), as determined by the Company in its sole discretion, (B) the Grantee’s conviction of, or pleading guilty or nolo contendere to, a felony involving moral turpitude, or (C) the Grantee’s violation of any confidentiality, non-solicitation, or non-competition covenant to which the Grantee is subject.
           (ii) The term “Disability” shall have the meaning ascribed to such term in the Grantee’s employment agreement with the Company or any Subsidiary. If the Grantee’s employment agreement does not define the term “Disability,” or if the Grantee has not entered

-2-


 

into an employment agreement with the Company or any Subsidiary, the term “Disability” shall mean the Grantee’s entitlement to long-term disability benefits pursuant to the long-term disability plan maintained by the Company or in which the Company’s employees participate.
     (b) Transfer Restrictions. During the Period of Restriction, the Restricted Stock may not be sold, assigned, pledged, exchanged, hypothecated or otherwise transferred, encumbered or disposed of to the extent such Shares are subject to a Period of Restriction.
     (c) Lapse of Restrictions. The Period of Restriction shall lapse as to the Restricted Stock in accordance with the Notice of Restricted Stock Grant. Subject to the terms of the Plan and Section 4(a) hereof, upon lapse of the Period of Restriction, the Grantee shall own the Shares that are subject to this Agreement free of all restrictions otherwise imposed by this Agreement.
SECTION 3. STOCK CERTIFICATES
     As soon as practicable following the grant of Restricted Stock, the Shares of Restricted Stock shall be registered in the Grantee’s name in certificate or book-entry form. If a certificate is issued, it shall bear an appropriate legend referring to the restrictions and it shall be held by the Company, or its agent, on behalf of the Grantee until the Period of Restriction has lapsed. If the Shares are registered in book-entry form, the restrictions shall be placed on the book-entry registration. The Grantee may be required to execute and return to the Company a blank stock power for each Restricted Stock certificate (or instruction letter, with respect to Shares registered in book-entry form), which will permit transfer to the Company, without further action, of all or any portion of the Restricted Stock that is forfeited in accordance with this Agreement.
     Except for the transfer restrictions, and subject to such other restrictions, if any, as determined by the Committee, the Participant shall have all other rights of a holder of Shares, including the right to receive dividends paid (whether in cash or property) with respect to the Restricted Stock and the right to vote (or to execute proxies for voting) such Shares. Unless otherwise determined by the Committee, if all or part of a dividend in respect of the Restricted Stock is paid in Shares or any other security issued by the Company, such Shares or other securities shall be held by the Company subject to the same restrictions as the Restricted Stock in respect of which the dividend was paid.
SECTION 4. MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS
     (a) Tax Withholding. Pursuant to Article 20 of the Plan, the Committee shall have the power and right to deduct or withhold, or require the Grantee to remit to the Company, an amount sufficient to satisfy any federal, state and local taxes (including the Grantee’s FICA obligations) required by law to be withheld with respect to this Award. The Committee may condition the delivery of Shares upon the Grantee’s satisfaction of such withholding obligations. The Grantee may elect to satisfy all or part of such withholding requirement by tendering previously-owned Shares or by having the Company withhold Shares having a Fair Market Value equal to the minimum statutory withholding (based on minimum statutory withholding rates for federal, state and local tax purposes, as applicable, including payroll taxes) that could be imposed on the transaction, and, to the extent the Committee so permits, amounts in excess of the minimum statutory withholding to the extent it would not result in additional accounting

-3-


 

expense. Such election shall be irrevocable, made in writing, signed by the Grantee, and shall be subject to any restrictions or limitations that the Committee, in its sole discretion, deems appropriate.
     (b) Ratification of Actions. By accepting this Agreement, the Grantee and each person claiming under or through the Grantee shall be conclusively deemed to have indicated the Grantee’s acceptance and ratification of, and consent to, any action taken under the Plan or this Agreement and Notice of Restricted Stock Grant by the Company, the Board or the Committee.
     (c) Notice. Any notice required by the terms of this Agreement shall be given in writing and shall be deemed effective upon personal delivery or upon deposit with the United States Postal Service, by registered or certified mail, with postage and fees prepaid. Notice shall be addressed to the Company at its principal executive office and to the Grantee at the address that he or she most recently provided in writing to the Company.
     (d) Choice of Law. This Agreement and the Notice of Restricted Stock Grant shall be governed by, and construed in accordance with, the laws of Florida, without regard to any conflicts of law or choice of law rule or principle that might otherwise cause the Plan, this Agreement or the Notice of Restricted Stock Grant to be governed by or construed in accordance with the substantive law of another jurisdiction.
     (e) Arbitration. Subject to, and in accordance with the provisions of Article 3 of the Plan, any dispute or claim arising out of or relating to the Plan, this Agreement or the Notice of Restricted Stock Grant shall be settled by binding arbitration before a single arbitrator in Jacksonville, Florida and in accordance with the Commercial Arbitration Rules of the American Arbitration Association. The arbitrator shall decide any issues submitted in accordance with the provisions and commercial purposes of the Plan, this Agreement and the Notice of Restricted Stock Grant, provided that all substantive questions of law shall be determined in accordance with the state and Federal laws applicable in Florida, without regard to internal principles relating to conflict of laws.
     (f) Modification or Amendment. This Agreement may only be modified or amended by written agreement executed by the parties hereto; provided, however, that the adjustments permitted pursuant to Section 4.3 of the Plan may be made without such written agreement.
     (g) Severability. In the event any provision of this Agreement shall be held illegal or invalid for any reason, the illegality or invalidity shall not affect the remaining provisions of this Agreement, and this Agreement shall be construed and enforced as if such illegal or invalid provision had not been included.
     (h) References to Plan. All references to the Plan shall be deemed references to the Plan as may be amended from time to time.
     (i) Section 409A Compliance. To the extent applicable, it is intended that the Plan and this Agreement comply with the requirements of Code Section 409A and any related regulations or other guidance promulgated with respect to such Section by the U.S. Department of the Treasury or the Internal Revenue Service and the Plan and the Award Agreement shall be interpreted accordingly.

-4-

EX-10.57
Exhibit 10.57
EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT
          THIS EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT (the “Agreement”) is effective as of May 1, 2008 (the “Effective Date”), by and between FIDELITY NATIONAL INFORMATION SERVICES, INC., a Georgia corporation (the “Company”), and FRANK R. SANCHEZ (the “Employee”). In consideration of the mutual covenants and agreements set forth herein, the parties agree as follows:
     1. Purpose and Release. The purpose of this Agreement is to terminate all prior agreements between Company, and any of its affiliates, and Employee relating to the subject matter of this Agreement (including an Employment Agreement dated March 1, 2005 and a Non-Competition Agreement dated January 27, 2004 with Fidelity Information Services, Inc.), to recognize Employee’s significant contributions to the overall financial performance and success of Company, to protect Company’s business interests through the addition of restrictive covenants, and to provide a single, integrated document which shall provide the basis for Employee’s continued employment by Company. In consideration of the execution of this Agreement and the termination of all such prior agreements, the parties each release all rights and claims that they have, had or may have arising under such prior agreements.
     2. Employment and Duties. Subject to the terms and conditions of this Agreement, Company employs Employee to serve as President, Strategic Solutions. Employee accepts such employment and agrees to undertake and discharge the duties, functions and responsibilities commensurate with the aforesaid position and such other duties and responsibilities as may be prescribed from time to time by the Chief Executive Officer (the “CEO”) or the Board of Directors of the Company (the “Board”). Except as expressly provided in Subsection 13(c), Employee shall devote substantially all of his business time, attention and effort to the performance of his duties hereunder and shall not engage in any business, profession or occupation, for compensation or otherwise without the express written consent of the CEO or Board, other than personal, personal investment, charitable, or civic activities or other matters that do not conflict with Employee’s duties.
     3. Term. This Agreement shall commence on the Effective Date and, unless terminated as set forth in Section 8, continue through April 15, 2011. This Agreement shall be extended automatically for successive one (1) year periods (the initial period and any extensions being collectively referred to as the “Employment Term”). Either party may terminate this Agreement as of the end of the then-current period by giving written notice at least thirty (30) days prior to the end of that period. Notwithstanding any termination of this Agreement or Employee’s employment, Sections 8 through 10 shall remain in effect until all obligations and benefits that accrued prior to termination are satisfied.
     4. Salary. During the Employment Term, Company shall pay Employee an annual base salary, before deducting all applicable withholdings, of no less than $590,000.00 per year, payable at the time and in the manner dictated by Company’s standard payroll policies. Such minimum annual base salary may be periodically reviewed and increased (but not decreased without Employee’s express written consent) at the discretion of the CEO, Board or Compensation Committee of the Board (the “Committee”) to reflect, among other matters, cost of living increases and performance results (such annual base salary, including any increases pursuant to this Section 4, the “Annual Base Salary”).

 


 

     5. Other Compensation and Fringe Benefits. In addition to any executive bonus, pension, deferred compensation and long-term incentive plans which Company or an affiliate of Company may from time to time make available to Employee, Employee shall be entitled to the following during the Employment Term:
  (a)   the standard Company benefits enjoyed by Company’s other top executives as a group;
 
  (b)   medical and other insurance coverage (for Employee and any covered dependents) provided by Company to its other top executives as a group;
 
  (c)   supplemental disability insurance sufficient to provide two-thirds of Employee’s pre-disability Annual Base Salary;
 
  (d)   an annual incentive bonus opportunity under Company’s annual incentive plan (“Annual Bonus Plan”) for each calendar year included in the Employment Term, with such opportunity to be earned based upon attainment of performance objectives established by the CEO, Board or Committee (“Annual Bonus”). Employee’s target Annual Bonus under the Annual Bonus Plan shall be no less than 150% of Employee’s Annual Base Salary, with a maximum of up to 300% of Employee’s Annual Base Salary (collectively, the target and maximum are referred to as the “Annual Bonus Opportunity”). Employee’s Annual Bonus Opportunity may be periodically reviewed and increased (but not decreased without Employee’s express written consent) at the discretion of the Committee, Board or CEO. The Annual Bonus shall be paid no later than the March 15th first following the calendar year to which the Annual Bonus relates. Unless provided otherwise herein or the Board determines otherwise, no Annual Bonus shall be paid to Employee unless Employee is employed by Company, or an affiliate thereof, on the Annual Bonus payment date; and
 
  (e)   participation in Company’s equity incentive plans.
     6. Vacation. For and during each calendar year within the Employment Term, Employee shall be entitled to reasonable paid vacation periods consistent with Employee’s position and in accordance with Company’s standard policies, or as the CEO, Board or Committee may approve. In addition, Employee shall be entitled to such holidays consistent with Company’s standard policies or as the CEO, Board or Committee may approve.
     7. Expense Reimbursement. In addition to the compensation and benefits provided herein, Company shall, upon receipt of appropriate documentation, reimburse Employee each month for his reasonable travel, lodging, entertainment, promotion and other ordinary and necessary business expenses to the extent such reimbursement is permitted under Company’s expense reimbursement policy.
     8. Termination of Employment. Company or Employee may terminate Employee’s employment at any time and for any reason in accordance with Subsection 8(a) below. The Employment Term shall be deemed to have ended on the last day of Employee’s employment. The Employment Term shall terminate automatically upon Employee’s death.

2


 

  (a)   Notice of Termination. Any purported termination of Employee’s employment (other than by reason of death) shall be communicated by written Notice of Termination (as defined herein) from one party to the other in accordance with the notice provisions contained in Section 25. For purposes of this Agreement, a “Notice of Termination” shall mean a notice that indicates the Date of Termination (as that term is defined in Subsection 8(b)) and, with respect to a termination due to Cause (as that term is defined in Subsection 8(d)), Disability (as that term is defined in Subsection 8(e)) or Good Reason (as that term is defined in Subsection 8(f)), sets forth in reasonable detail the facts and circumstances that are alleged to provide a basis for such termination. A Notice of Termination from Company shall specify whether the termination is with or without Cause or due to Employee’s Disability. A Notice of Termination from Employee shall specify whether the termination is with or without Good Reason or due to Disability.
 
  (b)   Date of Termination. For purposes of this Agreement, “Date of Termination” shall mean the date specified in the Notice of Termination (but in no event shall such date be earlier than the thirtieth (30th) day following the date the Notice of Termination is given) or the date of Employee’s death.
 
  (c)   No Waiver. The failure to set forth any fact or circumstance in a Notice of Termination, which fact or circumstance was not known to the party giving the Notice of Termination when the notice was given, shall not constitute a waiver of the right to assert such fact or circumstance in an attempt to enforce any right under or provision of this Agreement.
 
  (d)   Cause. For purposes of this Agreement, a termination for “Cause” means a termination by Company based upon Employee’s: (i) persistent failure to perform duties consistent with a commercially reasonable standard of care (other than due to a physical or mental impairment or due to an action or inaction directed by Company that would otherwise constitute Good Reason); (ii) willful neglect of duties (other than due to a physical or mental impairment or due to an action or inaction directed by Company that would otherwise constitute Good Reason); (iii) conviction of, or pleading nolo contendere to, criminal or other illegal activities involving dishonesty; (iv) material breach of this Agreement; or (v) failure to materially cooperate with or impeding an investigation authorized by the Board.
 
  (e)   Disability. For purposes of this Agreement, a termination based upon “Disability” means a termination by Company based upon Employee’s entitlement to long-term disability benefits under Company’s long-term disability plan or policy, as the case may be, as in effect on the Date of Termination.
 
  (f)   Good Reason. For purposes of this Agreement, a termination for “Good Reason” means a termination by Employee during the Employment Term based upon the occurrence (without Employee’s express written consent) of any of the following:

3


 

  (i)   a material diminution in Employee’s position or title, or the assignment of duties to Employee that are materially inconsistent with Employee’s position or title;
 
  (ii)   a material diminution in Employee’s Annual Base Salary or Annual Bonus Opportunity;
 
  (iii)   within six (6) months immediately preceding or within two (2) years immediately following a Change in Control: (A) a material adverse change in Employee’s status, authority or responsibility (e.g., The Company has determined that a change in the department or functional group over which Employee has managerial authority would constitute such a material adverse change); (B) a change in the person to whom Employee reports that results in a material adverse change to the Employee’s service relationship or the conditions under which Employee performs his duties; (C) a material adverse change in the position to whom Employee reports or a material diminution in the authority, duties or responsibilities of that position; (D) a material diminution in the budget over which Employee has managing authority; or (E) a material change in the geographic location of Employee’s principal place of employment, which is currently Jacksonville, Florida (e.g., The Company has determined that a relocation of more than thirty-five (35) miles would constitute such a material change); or
 
  (iv)   a material breach by Company of any of its obligations under this Agreement.
Notwithstanding the foregoing, Employee being placed on a paid leave for up to sixty (60) days pending a determination of whether there is a basis to terminate Employee for Cause shall not constitute Good Reason. Employee’s continued employment shall not constitute consent to, or a waiver of rights with respect to, any act or failure to act constituting Good Reason hereunder; provided, however, that no such event described above shall constitute Good Reason unless: (1) Employee gives Notice of Termination to Company specifying the condition or event relied upon for such termination either: (x) within ninety (90) days of the initial existence of such event; or (y) in the case of an event predating a Change in Control, within ninety (90) days of the Change in Control; and (2) Company fails to cure the condition or event constituting Good Reason within thirty (30) days following receipt of Employee’s Notice of Termination.
     9. Obligations of Company Upon Termination.
  (a)   Termination by Company for a Reason Other than Cause, Death or Disability and Termination by Employee for Good Reason. If Employee’s employment is terminated by: (1) Company for any reason other than Cause, Death or Disability; or (2) Employee for Good Reason:
   (i)   Company shall pay Employee the following (collectively, the “Accrued Obligations”): (A) within five (5) business days after the Date of Termination, any earned but unpaid Annual Base Salary; (B) within a

4


 

      reasonable time following submission of all applicable documentation, any expense reimbursement payments owed to Employee for expenses incurred prior to the Date of Termination; and (C) no later than March 15th of the year in which the Date of Termination occurs, any earned but unpaid Annual Bonus payments relating to the prior calendar year;
 
  (ii)   Company shall pay Employee no later than March 15th of the calendar year following the year in which the Date of Termination occurs, a prorated Annual Bonus based upon the actual Annual Bonus that would have been earned by Employee for the year in which the Date of Termination occurs (based upon the target Annual Bonus opportunity in the year in which the Date of Termination occurred, or the prior year if no target Annual Bonus opportunity has yet been determined, and the actual satisfaction of the applicable performance measures, but ignoring any requirement under the Annual Bonus plan that Employee must be employed on the payment date) multiplied by the percentage of the calendar year completed before the Date of Termination;
 
  (iii)   Company shall pay Employee, within thirty (30) business days after the Date of Termination, a lump-sum payment equal to 300% of the sum of: (A) Employee’s Annual Base Salary in effect immediately prior to the Date of Termination (disregarding any reduction in Annual Base Salary to which Employee did not expressly consent in writing); and (B) the highest Annual Bonus paid to Employee by Company within the three (3) years preceding his termination of employment or, if higher, the target Annual Bonus opportunity in the year in which the Date of Termination occurs;
 
  (iv)   All stock option, restricted stock and other equity-based incentive awards granted by Company that were outstanding but not vested as of the Date of Termination shall become immediately vested and/or payable, as the case may be; unless the equity incentive awards are based upon satisfaction of performance criteria; in which case, they will only vest pursuant to their express terms; and
 
  (v)   As long as Employee pays the full monthly premiums for COBRA coverage, Company shall provide Employee and, as applicable, Employee’s eligible dependents with continued medical and dental coverage, on the same basis as provided to Company’s active executives and their dependents until the earlier of: (i) three (3) years after the Date of Termination; or (ii) the date Employee is first eligible for medical and dental coverage (without pre-existing condition limitations) with a subsequent employer. In addition, within thirty (30) business days after the Date of Termination, Company shall pay Employee a lump sum cash payment equal to thirty-six monthly medical and dental COBRA premiums based on the level of coverage in effect for the Employee (e.g., employee only or family coverage) on the Date of Termination.

5


 

  (b)   Termination by Company for Cause and by Employee without Good Reason. If Employee’s employment is terminated by Company for Cause or by Employee without Good Reason, Company’s only obligation under this Agreement shall be payment of any Accrued Obligations.
  (c)   Termination due to Death or Disability. If Employee’s employment is terminated due to death or Disability, Company shall pay Employee (or to Employee’s estate or personal representative in the case of death), within thirty (30) business days after the Date of Termination: (i) any Accrued Obligations; plus (ii) a prorated Annual Bonus based upon the target Annual Bonus opportunity in the year in which the Date of Termination occurred (or the prior year if no target Annual Bonus opportunity has yet been determined) multiplied by the percentage of the calendar year completed before the Date of Termination; plus (iii) the unpaid portion of the Annual Base Salary for the remainder of the Employment Term.
  (d)   Definition of Change in Control. For purposes of this Agreement, the term “Change in Control” shall mean that the conditions set forth in any one of the following subsections shall have been satisfied:
  (i)   the acquisition, directly or indirectly, by any “person” (within the meaning of Section 3(a)(9) of the Securities and Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “Exchange Act”) and used in Sections 13(d) and 14(d) thereof) of “beneficial ownership” (within the meaning of Rule 13d-3 of the Exchange Act) of securities of Company possessing more than 50% of the total combined voting power of all outstanding securities of Company;
 
  (ii)   a merger or consolidation in which Company is not the surviving entity, except for a transaction in which the holders of the outstanding voting securities of Company immediately prior to such merger or consolidation hold, in the aggregate, securities possessing more than 50% of the total combined voting power of all outstanding voting securities of the surviving entity immediately after such merger or consolidation;
 
  (iii)   a reverse merger in which Company is the surviving entity but in which securities possessing more than 50% of the total combined voting power of all outstanding voting securities of Company are transferred to or acquired by a person or persons different from the persons holding those securities immediately prior to such merger;
 
  (iv)   during any period of two (2) consecutive years during the Employment Term or any extensions thereof, individuals, who, at the beginning of such period, constitute the Board, cease for any reason to constitute at least a majority thereof, unless the election of each director who was not a director at the beginning of such period has been approved in advance by directors representing at least two-thirds of the directors then in office who were directors at the beginning of the period;

6


 

   (v)   the sale, transfer or other disposition (in one transaction or a series of related transactions) of assets of Company that have a total fair market value equal to or more than one-third of the total fair market value of all of the assets of Company immediately prior to such sale, transfer or other disposition, other than a sale, transfer or other disposition to an entity (x) which immediately following such sale, transfer or other disposition owns, directly or indirectly, at least 50% of Company’s outstanding voting securities or (y) 50% or more of whose outstanding voting securities is immediately following such sale, transfer or other disposition owned, directly or indirectly, by Company. For purposes of the foregoing clause, the sale of stock of a subsidiary of Company (or the assets of such subsidiary) shall be treated as a sale of assets of Company; or
 
   (vi)   the approval by the stockholders of a plan or proposal for the liquidation or dissolution of Company.
For purposes of this Agreement, no event or transaction that is entered into, is contemplated by, or occurs as a result of the proposed spin-off of the Lender Processing Services division by Fidelity National Information Services, Inc. that was publicly announced on October 25, 2007 shall constitute a Change in Control. In addition, Employee agrees and consents to any conversion or modification of outstanding stock options, restricted stock or other equity-based incentive awards permissible under their corresponding plans (if any) and/or the assignment of this Agreement in connection with that proposed transaction.
   (e)   Six-Month Delay. To the extent Employee is a “specified employee,” as defined in Section 409A(a)(2)(B)(i) of the Code and the regulations and other guidance promulgated thereunder and any elections made by the Company in accordance therewith, notwithstanding the timing of payment provided in any other Section of this Agreement, no payment, distribution or benefit under this Agreement that constitutes a distribution of deferred compensation (within the meaning of Treasury Regulation Section 1.409A-1(b)) upon separation from service (within the meaning of Treasury Regulation Section 1.409A-1(h)), after taking into account all available exemptions, that would otherwise be payable during the six-month period after separation from service, will be made during such six-month period, and any such payment, distribution or benefit will instead be paid on the first business day after such six-month period.
     10. Excise Tax Gross-up Payments.
   (a)   If any payments or benefits paid or provided or to be paid or provided to Employee or for his benefit pursuant to the terms of this Agreement or otherwise in connection with, or arising out of, his employment with Company or its subsidiaries or the termination thereof (a “Payment” and, collectively, the “Payments”) would be subject to the excise tax (the “Excise Tax”) imposed by Section 4999 of the Code, then, except as otherwise provided in this Subsection 10(a), Employee will be entitled to receive an additional payment (a “Gross-Up Payment”) in an amount such that, after payment by Employee of all income

7


 

      taxes, all employment taxes and any Excise Tax imposed upon the Gross-Up Payment (including any related interest and penalties), Employee retains an amount of the Gross-Up Payment equal to the Excise Tax (including any related interest and penalties) imposed upon the Payments. Notwithstanding the foregoing, if the amount of the Payments does not exceed by more than 3% the amount that would be payable to Employee if the Payments were reduced to one dollar less than what would constitute a “parachute payment” under Section 280G of the Code (the “Scaled Back Amount”), then the Payments shall be reduced, in a manner determined by Employee, to the Scaled Back Amount, and Employee shall not be entitled to any Gross-Up Payment.
  (b)   An initial determination of (i) whether a Gross-Up Payment is required pursuant to this Agreement, and, if applicable, the amount of such Gross-Up Payment or (ii) whether the Payments must be reduced to the Scaled Back Amount and, if so, the amount of such reduction, will be made at Company’s expense by an accounting firm selected by Company. The accounting firm will provide its determination, together with detailed supporting calculations and documentation, to Company and Employee within ten (10) business days after the date of termination of Employee’s employment, or such other time as may be reasonably requested by Company or Employee. If the accounting firm determines that no Excise Tax is payable by Employee with respect to a Payment or Payments, it will furnish Employee with an opinion to that effect. If a Gross-Up Payment becomes payable, such Gross-Up Payment will be paid by Company to Employee within thirty (30) business days of the receipt of the accounting firm’s determination. If a reduction in Payments is required, such reduction shall be effectuated within thirty (30) business days of the receipt of the accounting firm’s determination. Within ten (10) business days after the accounting firm delivers its determination to Employee, Employee will have the right to dispute the determination. The existence of a dispute will not in any way affect Employee’s right to receive a Gross-Up Payment in accordance with the determination. If there is no dispute, the determination will be binding, final, and conclusive upon Company and Employee. If there is a dispute, Company and Employee will together select a second accounting firm, which will review the determination and Employee’s basis for the dispute and then will render its own determination, which will be binding, final, and conclusive on Company and on Employee for purposes of determining whether a Gross-Up Payment is required pursuant to this Subsection 10(b) or whether a reduction to the Scaled Back Amount is required, as the case may be. If as a result of any dispute pursuant to this Subsection 10(b) a Gross-Up Payment is made or additional Gross-Up Payments are made, such Gross-Up Payment(s) will be paid by Company to Employee within thirty (30) business days of the receipt of the second accounting firm’s determination. Company will bear all costs associated with the second accounting firm’s determination, unless such determination does not result in additional Gross-Up Payments to Employee or unless such determination does not mitigate the reduction in Payments required to arrive at the Scaled Back Amount, in which case all such costs will be borne by Employee.

8


 

  (c)   For purposes of determining the amount of the Gross-Up Payment and, if applicable, the Scaled Back Amount, Employee will be deemed to pay federal income taxes at the highest marginal rate of federal income taxation in the calendar year in which the Gross-Up Payment is to be made or the Scaled Back Amount is determined, as the case may be, and applicable state and local income taxes at the highest marginal rate of taxation in the state and locality of Employee’s residence on the date of termination of Employee’s employment, net of the maximum reduction in federal income taxes that would be obtained from deduction of those state and local taxes.
 
  (d)   As a result of the uncertainty in the application of Section 4999 of the Code, it is possible that Gross-Up Payments which will not have been made by Company should have been made, Employee’s Payments will be reduced to the Scaled Back Amount when they should not have been or Employee’s Payments are reduced to a greater extent than they should have been (an “Underpayment”) or Gross-Up Payments are made by Company which should not have been made, Employee’s Payments are not reduced to the Scaled Back Amount when they should have been or they are not reduced to the extent they should have been (an “Overpayment”). If it is determined that an Underpayment has occurred, the accounting firm shall determine the amount of the Underpayment that has occurred and any such Underpayment (together with interest at the rate provided in Section 1274(b)(2)(B) of the Code) shall be promptly paid by Company to or for the benefit of Employee. If it is determined that an Overpayment has occurred, the accounting firm shall determine the amount of the Overpayment that has occurred and any such Overpayment (together with interest at the rate provided in Section 1274(b)(2) of the Code) shall be promptly paid by Employee (to the extent he has received a refund if the applicable Excise Tax has been paid to the Internal Revenue Service) to or for the benefit of Company; provided, however, that if Company determines that such repayment obligation would be or result in an unlawful extension of credit under Section 13(k) of the Exchange Act, repayment shall not be required. Employee shall cooperate, to the extent his expenses are reimbursed by Company, with any reasonable requests by Company in connection with any contest or disputes with the Internal Revenue Service in connection with the Excise Tax.
 
  (e)   Employee shall notify Company in writing of any claim by the Internal Revenue Service that, if successful, would require a payment resulting in an Underpayment. Such notification shall be given as soon as practicable but no later than ten (10) business days after Employee is informed in writing of such claim and shall apprise Company of the nature of such claim and the date on which such claim is requested to be paid. Employee shall not pay such claim prior to the expiration of the thirty (30) day period following the date on which he gives such notice to Company (or such shorter period ending on the date that any payment of taxes with respect to such claim is due). If Company notifies Employee in writing prior to the expiration of such period that it desires to contest such claim, Employee shall: (i) give Company any information reasonably requested by Company relating to such claim; (ii) take such action in connection with contesting such claim as Company shall reasonably request in writing from time

9


 

      to time, including, without limitation, accepting legal representation with respect to such claim by an attorney reasonably selected by Company; (iii) cooperate with Company in good faith in order effectively to contest such claim; and (iv) permit Company to participate in any proceeding relating to such claim; provided, however, that Company shall bear and pay directly all costs and expenses (including additional interest and penalties) incurred in connection with such contest and shall indemnify and hold Employee harmless, on an after-tax basis, for any Excise Tax or income tax (including related interest and penalties) imposed as a result of such representation and payment of costs and expenses. Without limitation on the foregoing provisions of this Subsection 10(e), Company shall control all proceedings taken in connection with such contest and, at its sole option, may pursue or forgo any and all administrative appeals, proceedings, hearings and conferences with the taxing authority in respect of such claim and may, at its sole option, either direct Employee to pay the tax claimed and sue for a refund or contest the claim in any permissible manner, and Employee agrees to prosecute such contest to a determination before any administrative tribunal, in a court of initial jurisdiction and in one or more appellate courts, as Company shall determine; provided, however, that if Company directs Employee to pay such claim and sue for a refund, Company shall advance the amount of such payment to Employee, on an interest-free basis and shall indemnify and hold Employee harmless, on an after-tax basis, from any Excise Tax or income tax (including related interest or penalties) imposed with respect to such advance or with respect to any imputed income with respect to such advance. Company’s control of the contest shall be limited to issues that may impact Gross-Up Payments or reduction in Payments under this Section 10, and Employee shall be entitled to settle or contest, as the case may be, any other issue raised by the Internal Revenue Service or any other taxing authority.
  (f)   If, after the receipt by Employee of an amount advanced by Company pursuant to Subsection 10(e), Employee becomes entitled to receive any refund with respect to such claim, Employee shall (subject to Company’s complying with the requirements of Subsection 10(e)) promptly pay to Company the amount of such refund (together with any interest paid or credited thereon after taxes applicable thereto). If, after the receipt by Employee of an amount advanced by Company pursuant to Subsection 10(e), a determination is made that Employee shall not be entitled to any refund with respect to such claim and Company does not notify Employee in writing of its intent to contest such denial of refund prior to the expiration of thirty (30) days after such determination, then such advance shall be forgiven and shall not be required to be repaid.
 
  (g)   Any payment under this Section 10 must be made by Company no later than the end of the Employee’s tax year following the Employee’s tax year in which the Employee remits the related tax payments.
     11. Non-Delegation of Employee’s Rights. The obligations, rights and benefits of Employee hereunder are personal and may not be delegated, assigned or transferred in any manner whatsoever, nor are such obligations, rights or benefits subject to involuntary alienation, assignment or transfer.

10


 

     12. Confidential Information. Employee acknowledges that he will occupy a position of trust and confidence and will have access to and learn substantial information about Company and its affiliates and their operations that is confidential or not generally known in the industry including, without limitation, information that relates to purchasing, sales, customers, marketing, and the financial positions and financing arrangements of Company and its affiliates. Employee agrees that all such information is proprietary or confidential, or constitutes trade secrets and is the sole property of Company and/or its affiliates, as the case may be. Employee will keep confidential, and will not reproduce, copy or disclose to any other person or firm, any such information or any documents or information relating to Company’s or its affiliates’ methods, processes, customers, accounts, analyses, systems, charts, programs, procedures, correspondence or records, or any other documents used or owned by Company or any of its affiliates, nor will Employee advise, discuss with or in any way assist any other person, firm or entity in obtaining or learning about any of the items described in this Section 12. Accordingly, Employee agrees that during the Employment Term and at all times thereafter he will not disclose, or permit or encourage anyone else to disclose, any such information, nor will he utilize any such information, either alone or with others, outside the scope of his duties and responsibilities with Company and its affiliates.
     13. Non-Competition.
  (a)   During Employment Term Employee agrees that, during the Employment Term, he will devote such business time, attention and energies reasonably necessary to the diligent and faithful performance of the services to Company and its affiliates, and he will not engage in any way whatsoever, directly or indirectly, in any business that is a direct competitor with Company’s or its affiliates’ principal business, nor solicit customers, suppliers or employees of Company or affiliates on behalf of, or in any other manner work for or assist any business which is a direct competitor with Company’s or its affiliates’ principal business. In addition, during the Employment Term, Employee will undertake no planning for or organization of any business activity competitive with the work he performs as an employee of Company, and Employee will not combine or conspire with any other employee of Company or any other person for the purpose of organizing any such competitive business activity.
  (b)   After Employment Term. The parties acknowledge that Employee will acquire substantial knowledge and information concerning the business of Company and its affiliates as a result of his employment. The parties further acknowledge that the scope of business in which Company and its affiliates are engaged as of the Effective Date is national and very competitive and one in which few companies can successfully compete. Competition by Employee in that business after the Employment Term would severely injure Company and its affiliates. Accordingly, for a period of one (1) year after Employee’s employment terminates for any reason whatsoever, except as otherwise stated herein below, Employee agrees: (1) not to become an employee, consultant, advisor, principal, partner or substantial shareholder of any firm or business that directly competes with Company or its affiliates in their principal products and markets; and (2), on behalf of any such competitive firm or business, not to solicit any person or business that was at the time of such termination and remains a customer or

11


 

      prospective customer, a supplier or prospective supplier, or an employee of Company or an affiliate. Notwithstanding any of the foregoing provisions to the contrary, Employee shall not be subject to the restrictions set forth in this Subsection 13(b) if: (i) Employee’s employment is terminated by Company without Cause; (ii) Employee terminates employment for Good Reason; or (iii) Employee’s employment is terminated as a result of Company’s unwillingness to extend the Employment Term.
  (c)   Exclusion. Working, directly or indirectly, for any of the following entities shall not be considered competitive to Company or its affiliates for the purpose of this Section 13: (i) Fidelity National Financial, Inc., its affiliates or their successors; (ii) the Lender Processing Services division of Fidelity National Information Services, Inc. or its affiliates following the spin-off publicly announced on October 25, 2007, its affiliates or their successors; or (iii) Fidelity National Information Services, Inc. or its affiliates or their successors if this Agreement is assumed by a third party as contemplated in Section 21.
     14. Return of Company Documents. Upon termination of the Employment Term, Employee shall return immediately to Company all records and documents of or pertaining to Company or its affiliates and shall not make or retain any copy or extract of any such record or document, or any other property of Company or its affiliates.
     15. Improvements and Inventions. Any and all improvements or inventions that Employee may make or participate in during the Employment Term, unless wholly unrelated to the business of Company and its affiliates and not produced within the scope of Employee’s employment hereunder, shall be the sole and exclusive property of Company. Employee shall, whenever requested by Company, execute and deliver any and all documents that Company deems appropriate in order to apply for and obtain patents or copyrights in improvements or inventions or in order to assign and/or convey to Company the sole and exclusive right, title and interest in and to such improvements, inventions, patents, copyrights or applications.
     16. Actions. The parties agree and acknowledge that the rights conveyed by this Agreement are of a unique and special nature and that Company will not have an adequate remedy at law in the event of a failure by Employee to abide by its terms and conditions, nor will money damages adequately compensate for such injury. Therefore, it is agreed between and hereby acknowledged by the parties that, in the event of a breach by Employee of any of the obligations of this Agreement, Company shall have the right, among other rights, to damages sustained thereby and to obtain an injunction or decree of specific performance from any court of competent jurisdiction to restrain or compel Employee to perform as agreed herein. Employee hereby acknowledges that obligations under Sections and Subsections 12, 13(b), 14, 15, 16, 17 and 18 shall survive the termination of employment and be binding by their terms at all times subsequent to the termination of employment for the periods specified therein. Nothing herein shall in any way limit or exclude any other right granted by law or equity to Company.
     17. Release. Notwithstanding any provision herein to the contrary, Company may require that, prior to payment of any amount or provision of any benefit under Section 9 or payment of any Gross-Up Payment pursuant to Section 10 of this Agreement (other than due to Employee’s death), Employee shall have executed a complete release of Company and its

12


 

affiliates and related parties in such form as is reasonably required by Company, and any waiting periods contained in such release shall have expired. With respect to any release required to receive payments owed pursuant to Section 9, Company must provide Employee with the form of release no later than seven (7) days after the Date of Termination and the release must be signed by Employee and returned to Company, unchanged, effective and irrevocable, no later than sixty (60) days after the Date of Termination.
     18. No Mitigation. Company agrees that, if Employee’s employment hereunder is terminated during the Employment Term, Employee is not required to seek other employment or to attempt in any way to reduce any amounts payable to Employee by Company hereunder. Further, the amount of any payment or benefit provided for hereunder (other than pursuant to Subsection 9(a)(v) hereof) shall not be reduced by any compensation earned by Employee as the result of employment by another employer, by retirement benefits or otherwise.
     19. Entire Agreement and Amendment. This Agreement embodies the entire agreement and understanding of the parties hereto in respect of the subject matter of this Agreement, and supersedes and replaces all prior agreements, understandings and commitments with respect to such subject matter. This Agreement may be amended only by a written document signed by both parties to this Agreement.
     20. Governing Law. This Agreement shall be governed by, and construed in accordance with, the laws of the State of Florida, excluding any conflicts or choice of law rule or principle that might otherwise refer construction or interpretation of this Agreement to the substantive law of another jurisdiction. Any litigation pertaining to this Agreement shall be adjudicated in courts located in Duval County, Florida.
     21. Successors. This Agreement may not be assigned by Employee. In addition to any obligations imposed by law upon any successor to Company, Company will require any successor (whether direct or indirect, by purchase, merger, consolidation or otherwise) to all or substantially all of the stock, business and/or assets of Company, to expressly assume and agree to perform this Agreement in the same manner and to the same extent that Company would be required to perform it if no such succession had taken place. Failure of Company to obtain such assumption by a successor shall be a material breach of this Agreement. Employee agrees and consents to any such assumption by a successor of Company, as well as any assignment of this Agreement by Company for that purpose. As used in this Agreement, “Company” shall mean Company as herein before defined as well as any such successor that expressly assumes this Agreement or otherwise becomes bound by all of its terms and provisions by operation of law.
     22. Counterparts. This Agreement may be executed in counterparts, each of which shall be deemed an original, but all of which together shall constitute one and the same instrument.
     23. Attorneys’ Fees. If any party finds it necessary to employ legal counsel or to bring an action at law or other proceedings against the other party to interpret or enforce any of the terms hereof, the party prevailing in any such action or other proceeding shall be promptly paid by the other party its reasonable legal fees, court costs, litigation expenses, all as determined by the court and not a jury, and such payment shall be made by the non-prevailing party no later than the end of the Employee’s tax year following the Employee’s tax year in which the payment

13


 

amount becomes known and payable; provided, however, that on or after a Change in Control, and following Employee’s termination of employment with the Company, if any party finds it necessary to employ legal counsel or to bring an action at law or other proceedings against the other party to interpret or enforce any of the terms hereof, Company shall pay (on an ongoing basis) to Employee to the fullest extent permitted by law, all legal fees, court costs and litigation expenses reasonably incurred by Employee or others on his behalf (such amounts collectively referred to as the “Reimbursed Amounts”); provided, further, that Employee shall reimburse Company for the Reimbursed Amounts if it is determined that a majority of Employee’s claims or defenses were frivolous or without merit. Requests for payment of Reimbursed Amounts, together with all documents required by the Company to substantiate them, must be submitted to Company no later than ninety (90) days after the expense was incurred. The Reimbursed Amounts shall be paid by Company within ninety (90) days after receiving the request and all substantiating documents requested from Employee. The payment of Reimbursed Amounts during Employee’s tax year will not impact the Reimbursed Amounts for any other taxable year. The rights under this Section 23 shall survive the termination of employment and this Agreement until the expiration of the applicable statute of limitations.
     24. Severability. If any section, subsection or provision hereof is found for any reason whatsoever to be invalid or inoperative, that section, subsection or provision shall be deemed severable and shall not affect the force and validity of any other provision of this Agreement. If any covenant herein is determined by a court to be overly broad thereby making the covenant unenforceable, the parties agree and it is their desire that such court shall substitute a reasonable judicially enforceable limitation in place of the offensive part of the covenant and that as so modified the covenant shall be as fully enforceable as if set forth herein by the parties themselves in the modified form. The covenants of Employee in this Agreement shall each be construed as an agreement independent of any other provision in this Agreement, and the existence of any claim or cause of action of Employee against Company, whether predicated on this Agreement or otherwise, shall not constitute a defense to the enforcement by Company of the covenants in this Agreement.
     25. Notices. Any notice, request, or instruction to be given hereunder shall be in writing and shall be deemed given when personally delivered or three (3) days after being sent by United States Certified Mail, postage prepaid, with Return Receipt Requested, to the parties at their respective addresses set forth below:
To Company:
Fidelity National Information Services, Inc.
601 Riverside Avenue
Jacksonville, FL 32204
Attention: General Counsel
To Employee:
Frank R. Sanchez
Fidelity National Information Services, Inc.
601 Riverside Avenue
Jacksonville, FL 32204

14


 

     26. Waiver of Breach. The waiver by any party of any provisions of this Agreement shall not operate or be construed as a waiver of any prior or subsequent breach by the other party.
     27. Tax Withholding. Company or an affiliate may deduct from all compensation and benefits payable under this Agreement any taxes or withholdings Company is required to deduct pursuant to state, federal or local laws.
     28. Code Section 409A. To the extent applicable, it is intended that this Agreement and any payment made hereunder shall comply with the requirements of Section 409A of the Code, and any related regulations or other guidance promulgated with respect to such Section by the U.S. Department of the Treasury or the Internal Revenue Service (“Code Section 409A”). Any provision that would cause the Agreement or any payment hereof to fail to satisfy Code Section 409A shall have no force or effect until amended to comply with Code Section 409A, which amendment may be retroactive to the extent permitted by Code Section 409A.
     IN WITNESS WHEREOF the parties have executed this Agreement to be effective as of the date first set forth above.
         
    FIDELITY NATIONAL INFORMATION SERVICES, INC.
 
       
 
  By:    
 
       
 
  Its:   President and Chief Executive Officer
 
       
    FRANK R. SANCHEZ
 
 
       
     

15

EX-10.58
Exhibit 10.58
AMENDED AND RESTATED
EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT
          THIS AMENDED AND RESTATED EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT (the “Agreement”) is effective as of July 2, 2008 (the “Effective Date”), by and between FIDELITY NATIONAL INFORMATION SERVICES, INC., a Georgia corporation (the “Company”), and WILLIAM P. FOLEY, II (the “Employee”). In consideration of the mutual covenants and agreements set forth herein, the parties agree as follows:
     1. Purpose. This Agreement amends and restates, in its entirety, the obligations of the parties under the agreement between the Company and the Employee, dated as of October 24, 2006 (the “Prior Agreement”). The purpose of this Agreement is to recognize the Employee’s significant contributions to the overall financial performance and success of the Company and to provide a single, integrated document which shall provide the basis for the Employee’s continued employment by the Company.
     2. Employment and Duties. Subject to the terms and conditions of this Agreement, the Company employs the Employee to serve in an executive capacity as Executive Chairman. The Employee accepts such employment and agrees to undertake and discharge the duties, functions and responsibilities set forth in Appendix A attached hereto. In addition to the duties and responsibilities specifically assigned to the Employee pursuant to Appendix A, the Employee will perform such other duties and responsibilities as are from time to time assigned to the Employee by the Board of Directors of the Company (the “Board”) in writing, consistent with the terms and provisions of this Agreement.
     3. Term. The term of this Agreement shall commence on the Effective Date and shall continue for a period of three (3) years ending on the third anniversary of the Effective Date or, if later, ending on the last day of any extension made pursuant to the next sentence, subject to prior termination as set forth in Section 8 (such term, including any extensions pursuant to the next sentence, the “Employment Term”). The Employment Term shall be extended automatically for one (1) additional year on the first anniversary of the Effective Date and for an additional year each anniversary thereafter unless and until either party gives written notice to the other not to extend the Employment Term before such extension would be effectuated. Notwithstanding any termination of the Employment Term or the Employee’s employment, the Employee and the Company agree that Sections 8 through 10 shall remain in effect until all parties’ obligations and benefits are satisfied thereunder.
     4. Salary. During the Employment Term, the Company shall pay the Employee an annual base salary, before deducting all applicable withholdings, of no less than $125,000 per year, payable at the time and in the manner dictated by the Company’s standard payroll policies. Such minimum annual base salary may be periodically reviewed and increased (but not decreased without the Employee’s express written consent) at the discretion of the Board or the Compensation Committee of the Board (the “Committee”) to reflect, among other matters, cost of living increases and performance results (such annual base salary, including any increases pursuant to this Section 4, the “Annual Base Salary”).

 


 

     5. Other Compensation and Fringe Benefits. In addition to any executive bonus, pension, deferred compensation and long-term incentive plans which the Company or an affiliate of the Company may from time to time make available to the Employee, the Employee shall be entitled to the following during the Employment Term:
  (a)   the standard Company benefits enjoyed by the Company’s other top executives as a group;
 
  (b)   medical and other insurance coverage (for the Employee and any covered dependents) provided by the Company to its other top executives as a group, which the Employee has not elected to receive as of the date hereof because he receives such insurance coverage from another employer;
 
  (c)   supplemental disability insurance sufficient to provide two-thirds of the Employee’s pre-disability Annual Base Salary, which the Employee has not elected to receive as of the date hereof because he receives such insurance from another employer;
 
  (d)   an annual incentive bonus opportunity under the Company’s annual incentive plan (“Annual Bonus Plan”) for each calendar year included in the Employment Term, with such opportunity to be earned based upon attainment of performance objectives established by the Committee (“Annual Bonus”). The Employee’s target Annual Bonus under the Annual Bonus Plan shall be no less than 250% of the Employee’s Annual Base Salary (collectively, the target and maximum are referred to as the “Annual Bonus Opportunity”). The Employee’s Annual Bonus Opportunity may be periodically reviewed and increased (but not decreased without the Employee’s express written consent) at the discretion of the Committee. The Annual Bonus shall be paid no later than the March 15th first following the calendar year to which the Annual Bonus relates. Unless provided otherwise herein or the Board determines otherwise, no Annual Bonus shall be paid to the Employee unless the Employee is employed by the Company, or an affiliate thereof, on the Annual Bonus payment date; and
 
  (e)   participation in the Company’s equity incentive plans.
     6. Vacation. For and during each calendar year within the Employment Term, the Employee shall be entitled to reasonable paid vacation periods consistent with the Employee’s position and in accordance with the Company’s standard policies, or as the Board may approve. In addition, the Employee shall be entitled to such holidays consistent with the Company’s standard policies or as the Board or the Committee may approve.
     7. Expense Reimbursement. In addition to the compensation and benefits provided herein, the Company shall, upon receipt of appropriate documentation, reimburse the Employee each month for his reasonable travel, lodging, entertainment, promotion and other ordinary and necessary business expenses to the extent such reimbursement is permitted under the Company’s expense reimbursement policy.

 


 

     8. Termination of Employment. The Company or the Employee may terminate the Employee’s employment at any time and for any reason in accordance with Subsection 8(a) below. The Employment Term shall be deemed to have ended on the last day of the Employee’s employment. The Employment Term shall terminate automatically upon the Employee’s death.
  (a)   Notice of Termination. Any purported termination of the Employee’s employment (other than by reason of death) shall be communicated by written Notice of Termination (as defined herein) from one party to the other in accordance with the notice provisions contained in Section 25. For purposes of this Agreement, a “Notice of Termination” shall mean a notice that indicates the Date of Termination (as that term is defined in Subsection 8(b)) and, with respect to a termination due to Disability (as that term is defined in Subsection 8(e)), Cause (as that term is defined in Subsection 8(d)), or Good Reason (as that term is defined in Subsection 8(f)), sets forth in reasonable detail the facts and circumstances that are alleged to provide a basis for such termination. A Notice of Termination from the Company shall specify whether the termination is with or without Cause or due to the Employee’s Disability. A Notice of Termination from the Employee shall specify whether the termination is with or without Good Reason.
  (b)   Date of Termination. For purposes of this Agreement, “Date of Termination” shall mean the date specified in the Notice of Termination (but in no event shall such date be earlier than the thirtieth (30th) day following the date the Notice of Termination is given) or the date of the Employee’s death.
  (c)   No Waiver. The failure to set forth any fact or circumstance in a Notice of Termination, which fact or circumstance was not known to the party giving the Notice of Termination when the notice was given, shall not constitute a waiver of the right to assert such fact or circumstance in an attempt to enforce any right under or provision of this Agreement.
  (d)   Cause. For purposes of this Agreement, a termination for “Cause” means a termination by the Company based upon the Employee’s: (i) persistent failure to perform duties consistent with a commercially reasonable standard of care (other than due to a physical or mental impairment or due to an action or inaction directed by the Company that would otherwise constitute Good Reason); (ii) willful neglect of duties (other than due to a physical or mental impairment or due to an action or inaction directed by the Company that would otherwise constitute Good Reason); (iii) conviction of, or pleading nolo contendere to, criminal or other illegal activities involving dishonesty; (iv) material breach of this Agreement; or (v) failure to materially cooperate with or impeding an investigation authorized by the Board. The Employee’s termination for Cause shall be effective when and if a resolution is duly adopted by an affirmative vote of at least 3/4 of the Board (less the Employee), stating that, in the good faith opinion of the Board, the Employee is guilty of the conduct described in the Notice of Termination and such conduct constitutes Cause under this Agreement; provided, however, that the Employee shall have been given reasonable

 


 

      opportunity (A) to cure any act or omission that constitutes Cause if capable of cure and (B), together with counsel, during the thirty (30) day period following the receipt by the Employee of the Notice of Termination and prior to the adoption of the Board’s resolution, to be heard by the Board.
  (e)   Disability. For purposes of this Agreement, a termination based upon “Disability” means a termination by the Company based upon the Employee’s entitlement to long-term disability benefits under the Company’s long-term disability plan or policy, as the case may be, as in effect on the Date of Termination; provided, however, that if the Employee is not a participant in the Company’s long-term disability plan or policy on the Date of Termination, he shall still be considered terminated based upon Disability if he would have been entitled to benefits under the Company’s long-term disability plan or policy had he been a participant on his Date of Termination.
  (f)   Good Reason. For purposes of this Agreement, a termination for “Good Reason” means a termination by the Employee during the Employment Term based upon the occurrence (without the Employee’s express written consent) of any of the following:
  (i)   a material diminution in the Employee’s position or title, or the assignment of duties to the Employee that are materially inconsistent with the Employee’s position or title;
 
  (ii)   a material diminution in the Employee’s Annual Base Salary or Annual Bonus Opportunity;
 
  (iii)   within six (6) months immediately preceding or within two (2) years immediately following a Change in Control: (A) a material adverse change in the Employee’s status, authority or responsibility (e.g., the Employee no longer serving as Executive Chairman would constitute such a material adverse change); (B) a material adverse change in the position to whom the Employee reports (including any requirement that the Employee report to a corporate officer or employee instead of reporting directly to the Board) or to the Employee’s service relationship (or the conditions under which the Employee performs his duties) as a result of such reporting structure change, or a material diminution in the authority, duties or responsibilities of the position to whom the Employee reports; (C) a material diminution in the budget over which the Employee has managing authority; or (D) a material change in the geographic location of the Employee’s principal place of employment (e.g., the Company has determined that a relocation of more than thirty-five (35) miles would constitute such a material change); or
 
  (iv)   a material breach by the Company of any of its obligations under this Agreement.

 


 

Notwithstanding the foregoing, the Employee being placed on a paid leave for up to sixty (60) days pending a determination of whether there is a basis to terminate the Employee for Cause shall not constitute Good Reason. The Employee’s continued employment shall not constitute consent to, or a waiver of rights with respect to, any act or failure to act constituting Good Reason hereunder; provided, however, that no such event described above shall constitute Good Reason unless: (1) the Employee gives Notice of Termination to the Company specifying the condition or event relied upon for such termination either: (x) within ninety (90) days of the initial existence of such event; or (y) in the case of an event predating a Change in Control, within ninety (90) days of the Change in Control; and (2) the Company fails to cure the condition or event constituting Good Reason within thirty (30) days following receipt of the Employee’s Notice of Termination.
     9. Obligations of the Company Upon Termination.
  (a)   Termination by the Company for a Reason Other than Cause, Death or Disability and Termination by the Employee for Good Reason or following a Change in Control. If the Employee’s employment is terminated by: (1) the Company for any reason other than Cause, Death or Disability; or (2) the Employee for (x) for Good Reason or (y) for any reason during the period immediately following a Change in Control and ending on the six (6) month anniversary of such Change in Control:
  (i)   the Company shall pay the Employee the following (collectively, the “Accrued Obligations”): (A) within five (5) business days after the Date of Termination, any earned but unpaid Annual Base Salary; (B) within a reasonable time following submission of all applicable documentation, any expense reimbursement payments owed to the Employee for expenses incurred prior to the Date of Termination; and (C) no later than March 15th of the year in which the Date of Termination occurs, any earned but unpaid Annual Bonus payments relating to the prior calendar year;
 
  (ii)   the Company shall pay the Employee no later than March 15th of the calendar year following the year in which the Date of Termination occurs, a prorated Annual Bonus based upon the actual Annual Bonus that would have been earned by the Employee for the year in which the Date of Termination occurs (based upon the target Annual Bonus Opportunity in the year in which the Date of Termination occurred, or the prior year if no target Annual Bonus Opportunity has yet been determined, and the actual satisfaction of the applicable performance measures, but ignoring any requirement under the Annual Bonus plan that the Employee must be employed on the payment date) multiplied by the percentage of the calendar year completed before the Date of Termination;
 
  (iii)   the Company shall pay the Employee, no later than the sixty-fifth (65th) calendar day after the Date of Termination, a lump-sum payment equal to 300% of the sum of: (A) the Employee’s Annual Base Salary in effect

 


 

      immediately prior to the Date of Termination (disregarding any reduction in Annual Base Salary to which the Employee did not expressly consent in writing); and (B) the highest Annual Bonus paid to the Employee by the Company within the three (3) years preceding his termination of employment or, if higher, the target Annual Bonus Opportunity in the year in which the Date of Termination occurs;
  (iv)   all stock option, restricted stock and other equity-based incentive awards granted by the Company that were outstanding but not vested as of the Date of Termination shall become immediately vested and/or payable, as the case may be, unless the equity incentive awards are based upon satisfaction of performance criteria (not based solely on the passage of time); in which case, they will only vest pursuant to their express terms; and
 
  (v)   the Company shall provide the Employee with certain continued welfare benefits as follows:
  (A)   Any life insurance coverage provided by the Company shall terminate at the same time as life insurance coverage would normally terminate for any other employee that terminates employment with the Company, and the Employee shall have the right to convert that life insurance coverage to an individual policy under the regular rules of the Company’s group policy. In addition, if the Employee is covered under or receives life insurance coverage provided by the Company on the Date of Termination, then within thirty (30) business days after the Date of Termination, the Company shall pay the Employee a lump sum cash payment equal to thirty-six (36) monthly life insurance premiums based on the monthly premiums that would be due assuming that the Employee had converted his Company life insurance coverage that was in effect on the Notice of Termination into an individual policy.
 
  (B)   As long as the Employee pays the full monthly premiums for COBRA coverage, the Company shall provide the Employee and, as applicable, the Employee’s eligible dependents with continued medical and dental coverage, on the same basis as provided to the Company’s active executives and their dependents until the earlier of: (i) three (3) years after the Date of Termination; or (ii) the date the Employee is first eligible for medical and dental coverage (without pre-existing condition limitations) with a subsequent employer. In addition, within thirty (30) business days after the Date of Termination, the Company shall pay the Employee a lump sum cash payment equal to thirty-six (36) monthly medical and dental COBRA premiums based on the level of coverage in effect

 


 

      for the Employee (e.g., employee only or family coverage) on the Date of Termination.
  (b)   Termination by the Company for Cause and by the Employee without Good Reason. If the Employee’s employment is terminated (i) by the Company for Cause or (ii) by the Employee without Good Reason (excluding for this purpose the Employee terminating his employment without Good Reason during the six (6) month period immediately following a Change in Control in accordance with Section 9(a)), the Company’s only obligation under this Agreement shall be payment of any Accrued Obligations.
 
  (c)   Termination due to Death or Disability. If the Employee’s employment is terminated due to death or Disability, the Company shall pay the Employee (or to the Employee’s estate or personal representative in the case of death), within thirty (30) business days after the Date of Termination: (i) any Accrued Obligations, plus (ii) a prorated Annual Bonus based upon the target Annual Bonus opportunity in the year in which the Date of Termination occurred (or the prior year if no target Annual Bonus Opportunity has yet been determined) multiplied by the percentage of the calendar year completed before the Date of Termination.
 
  (d)   Definition of Change in Control. For purposes of this Agreement, the term “Change in Control” shall mean that the conditions set forth in any one of the following subsections shall have been satisfied:
  (i)   the acquisition, directly or indirectly, by any “person” (within the meaning of Section 3(a)(9) of the Securities and Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “Exchange Act”) and used in Sections 13(d) and 14(d) thereof) of “beneficial ownership” (within the meaning of Rule 13d-3 of the Exchange Act) of securities of the Company possessing more than fifty percent (50%) of the total combined voting power of all outstanding securities of the Company;
 
  (ii)   a merger or consolidation in which the Company is not the surviving entity, except for a transaction in which the holders of the outstanding voting securities of the Company immediately prior to such merger or consolidation hold, in the aggregate, securities possessing more than fifty percent (50%) of the total combined voting power of all outstanding voting securities of the surviving entity immediately after such merger or consolidation;
 
  (iii)   a reverse merger in which the Company is the surviving entity but in which securities possessing more than fifty percent (50%) of the total combined voting power of all outstanding voting securities of the Company are transferred to or acquired by a person or persons different from the persons holding those securities immediately prior to such merger;

 


 

  (iv)   during any period of two (2) consecutive years during the Employment Term or any extensions thereof, individuals, who, at the beginning of such period, constitute the Board, cease for any reason to constitute at least a majority thereof, unless the election of each director who was not a director at the beginning of such period has been approved in advance by directors representing at least two-thirds of the directors then in office who were directors at the beginning of the period;
 
  (v)   the sale, transfer or other disposition (in one transaction or a series of related transactions) of assets of the Company that have a total fair market value equal to or more than one-third of the total fair market value of all of the assets of the Company immediately prior to such sale, transfer or other disposition, other than a sale, transfer or other disposition to an entity (A) which immediately following such sale, transfer or other disposition owns, directly or indirectly, at least fifty percent (50%) of the Company’s outstanding voting securities or (B) fifty percent (50%) or more of whose outstanding voting securities is immediately following such sale, transfer or other disposition owned, directly or indirectly, by the Company. For purposes of the foregoing clause, the sale of stock of a subsidiary of the Company (or the assets of such subsidiary) shall be treated as a sale of assets of the Company; or
 
  (vi)   the approval by the stockholders of a plan or proposal for the liquidation or dissolution of the Company.
      For purposes of this Agreement, no event or transaction which occurred or occurs as a result of the Contribution and Distribution Agreement dated as of June 13, 2008 by and between the Company and Lender Processing Services, Inc. shall constitute a Change in Control. In addition, the Employee agrees and consents to any conversion or modification of outstanding stock options, restricted stock or other equity-based incentive awards permissible under their corresponding plans (if any) and/or the assignment of this Agreement in connection with that proposed transaction.
(e) Six-Month Delay. To the extent the Employee is a “specified employee,” as defined in Section 409A(a)(2)(B)(i) of the Code and the regulations and other guidance promulgated thereunder and any elections made by the Company in accordance therewith, notwithstanding the timing of payment provided in any other Section of this Agreement, no payment, distribution or benefit under this Agreement that constitutes a distribution of deferred compensation (within the meaning of Treasury Regulation Section 1.409A-1(b)) upon separation from service (within the meaning of Treasury Regulation Section 1.409A-1(h)), after taking into account all available exemptions, that would otherwise be payable during the six (6) month period after separation from service, will be made during such six (6) month period, and any such payment, distribution or benefit will instead be paid on the first business day after such six (6) month period.

 


 

     10. Excise Tax Gross-up Payments.
   (a)   If any payments or benefits paid or provided or to be paid or provided to the Employee or for his benefit pursuant to the terms of this Agreement or otherwise in connection with, or arising out of, his employment with the Company or its subsidiaries or the termination thereof (a “Payment” and, collectively, the “Payments”) would be subject to the excise tax (the “Excise Tax”) imposed by Section 4999 of the Code, then, except as otherwise provided in this Subsection 10(a), the Employee will be entitled to receive an additional payment (a “Gross-Up Payment”) in an amount such that, after payment by the Employee of all income taxes, all employment taxes and any Excise Tax imposed upon the Gross-Up Payment (including any related interest and penalties), the Employee retains an amount of the Gross-Up Payment equal to the Excise Tax (including any related interest and penalties) imposed upon the Payments. Notwithstanding the foregoing, if the amount of the Payments does not exceed by more than three percent (3%) the amount that would be payable to the Employee if the Payments were reduced to one dollar less than what would constitute a “parachute payment” under Section 280G of the Code (the “Scaled Back Amount”), then the Payments shall be reduced, in a manner determined by the Employee, to the Scaled Back Amount, and the Employee shall not be entitled to any Gross-Up Payment.
 
   (b)   An initial determination of (i) whether a Gross-Up Payment is required pursuant to this Agreement, and, if applicable, the amount of such Gross-Up Payment or (ii) whether the Payments must be reduced to the Scaled Back Amount and, if so, the amount of such reduction, will be made at the Company’s expense by an accounting firm selected by the Company. The accounting firm will provide its determination, together with detailed supporting calculations and documentation, to the Company and the Employee within ten (10) business days after the date of termination of the Employee’s employment, or such other time as may be reasonably requested by the Company or the Employee. If the accounting firm determines that no Excise Tax is payable by the Employee with respect to a Payment or Payments, it will furnish the Employee with an opinion to that effect. If a Gross-Up Payment becomes payable, such Gross-Up Payment will be paid by the Company to the Employee within thirty (30) business days of the receipt of the accounting firm’s determination. If a reduction in Payments is required, such reduction shall be effectuated within thirty (30) business days of the receipt of the accounting firm’s determination. Within ten (10) business days after the accounting firm delivers its determination to the Employee, the Employee will have the right to dispute the determination. The existence of a dispute will not in any way affect the Employee’s right to receive a Gross-Up Payment in accordance with the determination. If there is no dispute, the determination will be binding, final, and conclusive upon the Company and the Employee. If there is a dispute, the Company and the Employee will together select a second accounting firm, which will review the determination and the Employee’s basis for the dispute and then will render its own determination, which will be binding, final, and conclusive on the Company and on the Employee for purposes of determining whether a Gross-Up Payment is required pursuant to this Subsection 10(b) or

 


 

      whether a reduction to the Scaled Back Amount is required, as the case may be. If as a result of any dispute pursuant to this Subsection 10(b) a Gross-Up Payment is made or additional Gross-Up Payments are made, such Gross-Up Payment(s) will be paid by the Company to the Employee within thirty (30) business days of the receipt of the second accounting firm’s determination. The Company will bear all costs associated with the second accounting firm’s determination, unless such determination does not result in additional Gross-Up Payments to the Employee or unless such determination does not mitigate the reduction in Payments required to arrive at the Scaled Back Amount, in which case all such costs will be borne by the Employee.
 
  (c)   For purposes of determining the amount of the Gross-Up Payment and, if applicable, the Scaled Back Amount, the Employee will be deemed to pay federal income taxes at the highest marginal rate of federal income taxation in the calendar year in which the Gross-Up Payment is to be made or the Scaled Back Amount is determined, as the case may be, and applicable state and local income taxes at the highest marginal rate of taxation in the state and locality of the Employee’s residence on the date of termination of the Employee’s employment, net of the maximum reduction in federal income taxes that would be obtained from deduction of those state and local taxes.
 
  (d)   As a result of the uncertainty in the application of Section 4999 of the Code, it is possible that Gross-Up Payments which will not have been made by the Company should have been made, the Employee’s Payments will be reduced to the Scaled Back Amount when they should not have been or the Employee’s Payments are reduced to a greater extent than they should have been (an “Underpayment”) or Gross-Up Payments are made by the Company which should not have been made, the Employee’s Payments are not reduced to the Scaled Back Amount when they should have been or they are not reduced to the extent they should have been (an “Overpayment”). If it is determined that an Underpayment has occurred, the accounting firm shall determine the amount of the Underpayment that has occurred and any such Underpayment (together with interest at the rate provided in Section 1274(b)(2)(B) of the Code) shall be promptly paid by the Company to or for the benefit of the Employee. If it is determined that an Overpayment has occurred, the accounting firm shall determine the amount of the Overpayment that has occurred and any such Overpayment (together with interest at the rate provided in Section 1274(b)(2) of the Code) shall be promptly paid by the Employee (to the extent he has received a refund if the applicable Excise Tax has been paid to the Internal Revenue Service) to or for the benefit of the Company; provided, however, that if the Company determines that such repayment obligation would be or result in an unlawful extension of credit under Section 13(k) of the Exchange Act, repayment shall not be required. The Employee shall cooperate, to the extent his expenses are reimbursed by the Company, with any reasonable requests by the Company in connection with any contest or disputes with the Internal Revenue Service in connection with the Excise Tax.

 


 

  (e)   The Employee shall notify the Company in writing of any claim by the Internal Revenue Service that, if successful, would require a payment resulting in an Underpayment. Such notification shall be given as soon as practicable but no later than ten (10) business days after the Employee is informed in writing of such claim and shall apprise the Company of the nature of such claim and the date on which such claim is requested to be paid. The Employee shall not pay such claim prior to the expiration of the thirty (30) day period following the date on which he gives such notice to the Company (or such shorter period ending on the date that any payment of taxes with respect to such claim is due). If the Company notifies the Employee in writing prior to the expiration of such period that it desires to contest such claim, the Employee shall:
  (i)   give the Company any information reasonably requested by the Company relating to such claim,
 
  (ii)   take such action in connection with contesting such claim as the Company shall reasonably request in writing from time to time, including, without limitation, accepting legal representation with respect to such claim by an attorney reasonably selected by the Company,
 
  (iii)   cooperate with the Company in good faith in order to effectively contest such claim, and
 
  (iv)   permit the Company to participate in any proceeding relating to such claim;
      provided, however, that the Company shall bear and pay directly all costs and expenses (including additional interest and penalties) incurred in connection with such contest and shall indemnify and hold the Employee harmless, on an after-tax basis, for any Excise Tax or income tax (including related interest and penalties) imposed as a result of such representation and payment of costs and expenses. Without limitation on the foregoing provisions of this Subsection 10(e), the Company shall control all proceedings taken in connection with such contest and, at its sole option, may pursue or forgo any and all administrative appeals, proceedings, hearings and conferences with the taxing authority in respect of such claim and may, at its sole option, either direct the Employee to pay the tax claimed and sue for a refund or contest the claim in any permissible manner, and the Employee agrees to prosecute such contest to a determination before any administrative tribunal, in a court of initial jurisdiction and in one or more appellate courts, as the Company shall determine; provided, however, that if the Company directs the Employee to pay such claim and sue for a refund, the Company shall advance the amount of such payment to the Employee, on an interest-free basis and shall indemnify and hold the Employee harmless, on an after-tax basis, from any Excise Tax or income tax (including related interest or penalties) imposed with respect to such advance or with respect to any imputed income with respect to such advance. The Company’s control of the contest shall be limited to issues that may impact Gross-Up Payments or reduction in Payments

 


 

      under this Section 10, and the Employee shall be entitled to settle or contest, as the case may be, any other issue raised by the Internal Revenue Service or any other taxing authority.
 
   (f)   If, after the receipt by the Employee of an amount advanced by the Company pursuant to Subsection 10(e), the Employee becomes entitled to receive any refund with respect to such claim, the Employee shall (subject to the Company’s complying with the requirements of Subsection 10(e)) promptly pay to the Company the amount of such refund (together with any interest paid or credited thereon after taxes applicable thereto). If, after the receipt by the Employee of an amount advanced by the Company pursuant to Subsection 10(e), a determination is made that the Employee shall not be entitled to any refund with respect to such claim and the Company does not notify the Employee in writing of its intent to contest such denial of refund prior to the expiration of thirty (30) days after such determination, then such advance shall be forgiven and shall not be required to be repaid.
 
   (g)   Any payment under this Section 10 must be made by the Company no later than the end of the Employee’s tax year following the Employee’s tax year in which the Employee remits the related tax payments.
     11. Non-Delegation of the Employee’s Rights. The obligations, rights and benefits of the Employee hereunder are personal and may not be delegated, assigned or transferred in any manner whatsoever, nor are such obligations, rights or benefits subject to involuntary alienation, assignment or transfer.
     12. Confidential Information. The Employee acknowledges that he will occupy a position of trust and confidence and will have access to and learn substantial information about the Company and its affiliates and their operations that is confidential or not generally known in the industry including, without limitation, information that relates to purchasing, sales, customers, marketing, and the financial positions and financing arrangements of the Company and its affiliates. The Employee agrees that all such information is proprietary or confidential, or constitutes trade secrets and is the sole property of the Company and/or its affiliates, as the case may be. The Employee will keep confidential, and will not reproduce, copy or disclose to any other person or firm, any such information or any documents or information relating to the Company’s or its affiliates’ methods, processes, customers, accounts, analyses, systems, charts, programs, procedures, correspondence or records, or any other documents used or owned by the Company or any of its affiliates, nor will the Employee advise, discuss with or in any way assist any other person, firm or entity in obtaining or learning about any of the items described in this Section 12. Accordingly, the Employee agrees that during the Employment Term and at all times thereafter he will not disclose, or permit or encourage anyone else to disclose, any such information, nor will he utilize any such information, either alone or with others, outside the scope of his duties and responsibilities with the Company and its affiliates.

 


 

     13. Non-Competition.
   (a)   During Employment Term. The Employee agrees that, during the Employment Term, he will devote such business time, attention and energies reasonably necessary to the diligent and faithful performance of the services to the Company and its affiliates, and he will not engage in any way whatsoever, directly or indirectly, in any business that is a direct competitor with the Company’s or its affiliates’ principal business, nor solicit customers, suppliers or employees of the Company or affiliates on behalf of, or in any other manner work for or assist any business which is a direct competitor with the Company’s or its affiliates’ principal business. In addition, during the Employment Term, the Employee will undertake no planning for or organization of any business activity competitive with the work he performs as an employee of the Company, and the Employee will not combine or conspire with any other employee of the Company or any other person for the purpose of organizing any such competitive business activity.
 
   (b)   After Employment Term. The parties acknowledge that the Employee will acquire substantial knowledge and information concerning the business of the Company and its affiliates as a result of his employment. The parties further acknowledge that the scope of business in which the Company and its affiliates are engaged as of the Effective Date is national and very competitive and one in which few companies can successfully compete. Competition by the Employee in that business after the Employment Term would severely injure the Company and its affiliates. Accordingly, for a period of one (1) year after the Employee’s employment terminates for any reason whatsoever, except as otherwise stated herein below, the Employee agrees: (i) not to become an employee, consultant, advisor, principal, partner or substantial shareholder of any firm or business that directly competes with the Company or its affiliates in their principal products and markets; and (ii), on behalf of any such competitive firm or business, not to solicit any person or business that was at the time of such termination and remains a customer or prospective customer, a supplier or prospective supplier, or an employee of the Company or an affiliate. Notwithstanding any of the foregoing provisions to the contrary, the Employee shall not be subject to the restrictions set forth in this Subsection 13(b) if: (A) the Employee’s employment is terminated by the Company without Cause; (B) the Employee terminates employment for Good Reason; (C) the Employee’s employment is terminated as a result of the Company’s unwillingness to extend the Employment Term; or (D) the Employee terminates employment without Good Reason, any time during the six (6) month period beginning on the first day following the six (6) month anniversary of a Change in Control.
 
   (c)   Exclusion. Working, directly or indirectly, for any of the following entities shall not be considered competitive to the Company or its affiliates for the purpose of this Section 13: (i) Fidelity National Financial, Inc., its affiliates or their successors; (ii) Lender Processing Services, Inc., its affiliates or their successors; or (iii) the Company, its affiliates or their successors if this Agreement is assumed by a third party as contemplated in Section 21.

 


 

     14. Return of Company Documents. Upon termination of the Employment Term, the Employee shall return immediately to the Company all records and documents of or pertaining to the Company or its affiliates and shall not make or retain any copy or extract of any such record or document, or any other property of the Company or its affiliates.
     15. Improvements and Inventions. Any and all improvements or inventions that the Employee may make or participate in during the Employment Term, unless wholly unrelated to the business of the Company and its affiliates and not produced within the scope of the Employee’s employment hereunder, shall be the sole and exclusive property of the Company. The Employee shall, whenever requested by the Company, execute and deliver any and all documents that the Company deems appropriate in order to apply for and obtain patents or copyrights in improvements or inventions or in order to assign and/or convey to the Company the sole and exclusive right, title and interest in and to such improvements, inventions, patents, copyrights or applications.
     16. Actions. The parties agree and acknowledge that the rights conveyed by this Agreement are of a unique and special nature and that the Company will not have an adequate remedy at law in the event of a failure by the Employee to abide by its terms and conditions, nor will money damages adequately compensate for such injury. Therefore, it is agreed between and hereby acknowledged by the parties that, in the event of a breach by the Employee of any of the obligations of this Agreement, the Company shall have the right, among other rights, to damages sustained thereby and to obtain an injunction or decree of specific performance from any court of competent jurisdiction to restrain or compel the Employee to perform as agreed herein. The Employee hereby acknowledges that obligations under Sections and Subsections 12, 13(b), 14, 15, 16, 17 and 18 shall survive the termination of employment and be binding by their terms at all times subsequent to the termination of employment for the periods specified therein. Nothing herein shall in any way limit or exclude any other right granted by law or equity to the Company.
     17. Release. Notwithstanding any provision herein to the contrary, the Company may require that, prior to payment of any amount or provision of any benefit under Section 9 or payment of any Gross-Up Payment pursuant to Section 10 of this Agreement (other than due to the Employee’s death), the Employee shall have executed a complete release of the Company and its affiliates and related parties in such form as is reasonably required by the Company, and any waiting periods contained in such release shall have expired; provided, however, that such release relates only to the Employee’s employment relationship with the Company. With respect to any release required to receive payments owed pursuant to Section 9, the Company must provide the Employee with the form of release no later than seven (7) days after the Date of Termination and the release must be signed by the Employee and returned to the Company, unchanged, effective and irrevocable, no later than sixty (60) days after the Date of Termination.
     18. No Mitigation. The Company agrees that, if the Employee’s employment hereunder is terminated during the Employment Term, the Employee is not required to seek other employment or to attempt in any way to reduce any amounts payable to the Employee by the Company hereunder. Further, the amount of any payment or benefit provided for hereunder (other than pursuant to Subsection 9(a)(v) hereof) shall not be reduced by any compensation earned by the Employee as the result of employment by another employer, by retirement benefits or otherwise.

 


 

     19. Entire Agreement and Amendment. This Agreement embodies the entire agreement and understanding of the parties hereto in respect of the subject matter of this Agreement, and supersedes and replaces all prior agreements, understandings and commitments with respect to such subject matter. This Agreement may be amended only by a written document signed by both parties to this Agreement.
     20. Governing Law. This Agreement shall be governed by, and construed in accordance with, the laws of the State of Florida, excluding any conflicts or choice of law rule or principle that might otherwise refer construction or interpretation of this Agreement to the substantive law of another jurisdiction. Any litigation pertaining to this Agreement shall be adjudicated in courts located in Duval County, Florida.
     21. Successors. This Agreement may not be assigned by the Employee. In addition to any obligations imposed by law upon any successor to the Company, the Company will require any successor (whether direct or indirect, by purchase, merger, consolidation or otherwise) to all or substantially all of the stock, business and/or assets of the Company, to expressly assume and agree to perform this Agreement in the same manner and to the same extent that the Company would be required to perform it if no such succession had taken place. Failure of the Company to obtain such assumption by a successor shall be a material breach of this Agreement. The Employee agrees and consents to any such assumption by a successor of the Company, as well as any assignment of this Agreement by the Company for that purpose. As used in this Agreement, “Company” shall mean the Company as herein before defined as well as any such successor that expressly assumes this Agreement or otherwise becomes bound by all of its terms and provisions by operation of law. This Agreement shall be binding upon and inure to the benefit of the parties and their permitted successors or assigns.
     22. Counterparts. This Agreement may be executed in counterparts, each of which shall be deemed an original, but all of which together shall constitute one and the same instrument.
     23. Attorneys’ Fees. If any party finds it necessary to employ legal counsel or to bring an action at law or other proceedings against the other party to interpret or enforce any of the terms hereof, the party prevailing in any such action or other proceeding shall be promptly paid by the other party its reasonable legal fees, court costs, litigation expenses, all as determined by the court and not a jury, and such payment shall be made by the non-prevailing party no later than the end of the Employee’s tax year following the Employee’s tax year in which the payment amount becomes known and payable; provided, however, that on or after a Change in Control, and following the Employee’s termination of employment with the Company, if any party finds it necessary to employ legal counsel or to bring an action at law or other proceedings against the other party to interpret or enforce any of the terms hereof, the Company shall pay (on an ongoing basis) to the Employee to the fullest extent permitted by law, all legal fees, court costs and litigation expenses reasonably incurred by the Employee or others on his behalf (such amounts collectively referred to as the “Reimbursed Amounts”); provided, further, that the Employee shall reimburse the Company for the Reimbursed Amounts if it is determined that a majority of the Employee’s claims or defenses were frivolous or without merit. Requests for payment of Reimbursed Amounts, together with all documents required by the Company to substantiate them, must be submitted to the Company no later than ninety (90) days after the expense was

 


 

incurred. The Reimbursed Amounts shall be paid by the Company within ninety (90) days after receiving the request and all substantiating documents requested from the Employee. The payment of Reimbursed Amounts during the Employee’s tax year will not impact the Reimbursed Amounts for any other taxable year. The rights under this Section 23 shall survive the termination of employment and this Agreement until the expiration of the applicable statute of limitations.
     24. Severability. If any section, subsection or provision hereof is found for any reason whatsoever to be invalid or inoperative, that section, subsection or provision shall be deemed severable and shall not affect the force and validity of any other provision of this Agreement. If any covenant herein is determined by a court to be overly broad thereby making the covenant unenforceable, the parties agree and it is their desire that such court shall substitute a reasonable judicially enforceable limitation in place of the offensive part of the covenant and that as so modified the covenant shall be as fully enforceable as if set forth herein by the parties themselves in the modified form. The covenants of the Employee in this Agreement shall each be construed as an agreement independent of any other provision in this Agreement, and the existence of any claim or cause of action of the Employee against the Company, whether predicated on this Agreement or otherwise, shall not constitute a defense to the enforcement by the Company of the covenants in this Agreement.
     25. Notices. Any notice, request, or instruction to be given hereunder shall be in writing and shall be deemed given when personally delivered or three (3) days after being sent by United States Certified Mail, postage prepaid, with Return Receipt Requested, to the parties at their respective addresses set forth below:
To the Company:
Fidelity National Information Services, Inc.
601 Riverside Avenue
Jacksonville, FL 32204
Attention: General Counsel
To the Employee:
William P. Foley, II
c/o Fidelity National Information Services, Inc.
601 Riverside Avenue
Jacksonville, FL 32204
     26. Waiver of Breach. The waiver by any party of any provisions of this Agreement shall not operate or be construed as a waiver of any prior or subsequent breach by the other party.
     27. Tax Withholding. The Company or an affiliate may deduct from all compensation and benefits payable under this Agreement any taxes or withholdings the Company is required to deduct pursuant to state, federal or local laws.

 


 

     28. Code Section 409A. To the extent applicable, it is intended that this Agreement and any payment made hereunder shall comply with the requirements of Section 409A of the Code, and any related regulations or other guidance promulgated with respect to such Section by the U.S. Department of the Treasury or the Internal Revenue Service (“Code Section 409A”). Any provision that would cause the Agreement or any payment hereof to fail to satisfy Code Section 409A shall have no force or effect until amended to comply with Code Section 409A, which amendment may be retroactive to the extent permitted by Code Section 409A. In addition, the direct payment or reimbursement of expenses permitted under this Agreement or otherwise shall be made no later than the last day of the Employee’s taxable year following the taxable year in which such expense was incurred.
       IN WITNESS WHEREOF the parties have executed this Agreement to be effective as of the date first set forth above.
             
    FIDELITY NATIONAL INFORMATION SERVICES, INC.
 
           
 
  By:        
 
     
 
   
 
           
 
  Its:        
 
           
 
           
 
    WILLIAM P. FOLEY, II    
 
           
 
         

 


 

APPENDIX A
Position Title: Executive Chairman
DUTIES AND RESPONSIBILITIES: Reporting to the Board, the Employee’s duties and responsibilities include:
  1.   member of the Company’s Board as Chairman, if so elected;
 
  2.   strategic planning and initiatives;
 
  3.   mergers and acquisitions;
 
  4.   presiding over meetings of the Board and shareholders, if elected as Chairman of the Board; and
 
  5.   planning the contents and agenda of such meetings with the assistance of the Company’s management.

 

EX-10.59
Exhibit 10.59
AMENDED AND RESTATED
EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT
          THIS AMENDED AND RESTATED EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT (the “Agreement”) is effective as of July 2, 2008 (the “Effective Date”), by and between FIDELITY NATIONAL INFORMATION SERVICES, INC., a Georgia corporation (the “Company”), and BRENT B. BICKETT (the “Employee”). In consideration of the mutual covenants and agreements set forth herein, the parties agree as follows:
     1. Purpose. This Agreement amends and restates, in its entirety, the obligations of the parties under the agreement between the Company and the Employee, dated as of October 24, 2006 (the “Prior Agreement”). The purpose of this Agreement is to recognize the Employee’s significant contributions to the overall financial performance and success of the Company and to provide a single, integrated document which shall provide the basis for the Employee’s continued employment by the Company.
     2. Employment and Duties. Subject to the terms and conditions of this Agreement, the Company employs the Employee to serve in an executive capacity as Executive Vice President, Strategic Planning. The Employee accepts such employment and agrees to undertake and discharge the duties, functions and responsibilities commensurate with the aforesaid position and such other duties and responsibilities as may be prescribed from time to time by the Chief Executive Officer (the “CEO”) or the Board of Directors of the Company (the “Board”). Except as expressly provided in Subsection 13(c), the Employee shall devote substantially all of his business time, attention and effort to the performance of his duties hereunder and shall not engage in any business, profession or occupation, for compensation or otherwise without the express written consent of the CEO, other than personal, personal investment, charitable, or civic activities or other matters that do not conflict with the Employee’s duties.
     3. Term. The term of this Agreement shall commence on the Effective Date and shall continue for a period of three (3) years ending on the third anniversary of the Effective Date or, if later, ending on the last day of any extension made pursuant to the next sentence, subject to prior termination as set forth in Section 8 (such term, including any extensions pursuant to the next sentence, the “Employment Term”). The Employment Term shall be extended automatically for one (1) additional year on the first anniversary of the Effective Date and for an additional year each anniversary thereafter unless and until either party gives written notice to the other not to extend the Employment Term before such extension would be effectuated. Notwithstanding any termination of the Employment Term or the Employee’s employment, the Employee and the Company agree that Sections 8 through 10 shall remain in effect until all parties’ obligations and benefits are satisfied thereunder.
     4. Salary. During the Employment Term, the Company shall pay the Employee an annual base salary, before deducting all applicable withholdings, of no less than $337,500 per year, payable at the time and in the manner dictated by the Company’s standard payroll policies. Such minimum annual base salary may be periodically reviewed and increased (but not decreased without the Employee’s express written consent) at the discretion of the Board or the Compensation Committee of the Board (the “Committee”) to reflect, among other matters, cost

 


 

of living increases and performance results (such annual base salary, including any increases pursuant to this Section 4, the “Annual Base Salary”).
     5. Other Compensation and Fringe Benefits. In addition to any executive bonus, pension, deferred compensation and long-term incentive plans which the Company or an affiliate of the Company may from time to time make available to the Employee, the Employee shall be entitled to the following during the Employment Term:
  (a)   the standard Company benefits enjoyed by the Company’s other top executives as a group;
 
  (b)   medical and other insurance coverage (for the Employee and any covered dependents) provided by the Company to its other top executives as a group, which the Employee has not elected to receive as of the date hereof because he receives such insurance coverage from another employer;
 
  (c)   supplemental disability insurance sufficient to provide two-thirds of the Employee’s pre-disability Annual Base Salary, which the Employee has not elected to receive as of the date hereof because he receives such insurance coverage from another employer;
 
  (d)   an annual incentive bonus opportunity under the Company’s annual incentive plan (“Annual Bonus Plan”) for each calendar year included in the Employment Term, with such opportunity to be earned based upon attainment of performance objectives established by the Committee (“Annual Bonus”). The Employee’s target Annual Bonus under the Annual Bonus Plan shall be no less than 150% of the Employee’s Annual Base Salary (collectively, the target and maximum are referred to as the “Annual Bonus Opportunity”). The Employee’s Annual Bonus Opportunity may be periodically reviewed and increased (but not decreased without the Employee’s express written consent) at the discretion of the Committee. The Annual Bonus shall be paid no later than the March 15th first following the calendar year to which the Annual Bonus relates. Unless provided otherwise herein or the Board determines otherwise, no Annual Bonus shall be paid to the Employee unless the Employee is employed by the Company, or an affiliate thereof, on the Annual Bonus payment date; and
 
  (e)   participation in the Company’s equity incentive plans.
     6. Vacation. For and during each calendar year within the Employment Term, the Employee shall be entitled to reasonable paid vacation periods consistent with the Employee’s position and in accordance with the Company’s standard policies, or as the Board may approve. In addition, the Employee shall be entitled to such holidays consistent with the Company’s standard policies or as the Board or the Committee may approve.
     7. Expense Reimbursement. In addition to the compensation and benefits provided herein, the Company shall, upon receipt of appropriate documentation, reimburse the Employee each month for his reasonable travel, lodging, entertainment, promotion and other ordinary and

2


 

necessary business expenses to the extent such reimbursement is permitted under the Company’s expense reimbursement policy.
     8. Termination of Employment. The Company or the Employee may terminate the Employee’s employment at any time and for any reason in accordance with Subsection 8(a) below. The Employment Term shall be deemed to have ended on the last day of the Employee’s employment. The Employment Term shall terminate automatically upon the Employee’s death.
  (a)   Notice of Termination. Any purported termination of the Employee’s employment (other than by reason of death) shall be communicated by written Notice of Termination (as defined herein) from one party to the other in accordance with the notice provisions contained in Section 25. For purposes of this Agreement, a “Notice of Termination” shall mean a notice that indicates the Date of Termination (as that term is defined in Subsection 8(b)) and, with respect to a termination due to Disability (as that term is defined in Subsection 8(e)), Cause (as that term is defined in Subsection 8(d)), or Good Reason (as that term is defined in Subsection 8(f)), sets forth in reasonable detail the facts and circumstances that are alleged to provide a basis for such termination. A Notice of Termination from the Company shall specify whether the termination is with or without Cause or due to the Employee’s Disability. A Notice of Termination from the Employee shall specify whether the termination is with or without Good Reason.
 
  (b)   Date of Termination. For purposes of this Agreement, “Date of Termination” shall mean the date specified in the Notice of Termination (but in no event shall such date be earlier than the thirtieth (30th) day following the date the Notice of Termination is given) or the date of the Employee’s death.
 
  (c)   No Waiver. The failure to set forth any fact or circumstance in a Notice of Termination, which fact or circumstance was not known to the party giving the Notice of Termination when the notice was given, shall not constitute a waiver of the right to assert such fact or circumstance in an attempt to enforce any right under or provision of this Agreement.
 
  (d)   Cause. For purposes of this Agreement, a termination for “Cause” means a termination by the Company based upon the Employee’s: (i) persistent failure to perform duties consistent with a commercially reasonable standard of care (other than due to a physical or mental impairment or due to an action or inaction directed by the Company that would otherwise constitute Good Reason); (ii) willful neglect of duties (other than due to a physical or mental impairment or due to an action or inaction directed by the Company that would otherwise constitute Good Reason); (iii) conviction of, or pleading nolo contendere to, criminal or other illegal activities involving dishonesty; (iv) material breach of this Agreement; or (v) failure to materially cooperate with or impeding an investigation authorized by the Board. The Employee’s termination for Cause shall be effective when and if a resolution is duly adopted by an affirmative vote of at least 3/4 of the Board (less the Employee), stating that, in the good faith

3


 

      opinion of the Board, the Employee is guilty of the conduct described in the Notice of Termination and such conduct constitutes Cause under this Agreement; provided, however, that the Employee shall have been given reasonable opportunity (A) to cure any act or omission that constitutes Cause if capable of cure and (B), together with counsel, during the thirty (30) day period following the receipt by the Employee of the Notice of Termination and prior to the adoption of the Board’s resolution, to be heard by the Board.
 
  (e)   Disability. For purposes of this Agreement, a termination based upon “Disability” means a termination by the Company based upon the Employee’s entitlement to long-term disability benefits under the Company’s long-term disability plan or policy, as the case may be, as in effect on the Date of Termination; provided, however, that if the Employee is not a participant in the Company’s long-term disability plan or policy on the Date of Termination, he shall still be considered terminated based upon Disability if he would have been entitled to benefits under the Company’s long-term disability plan or policy had he been a participant on his Date of Termination.
 
  (f)   Good Reason. For purposes of this Agreement, a termination for “Good Reason” means a termination by the Employee during the Employment Term based upon the occurrence (without the Employee’s express written consent) of any of the following:
  (i)   a material diminution in the Employee’s position or title, or the assignment of duties to the Employee that are materially inconsistent with the Employee’s position or title;
 
  (ii)   a material diminution in the Employee’s Annual Base Salary or Annual Bonus Opportunity;
 
  (iii)   within six (6) months immediately preceding or within two (2) years immediately following a Change in Control: (A) a material adverse change in the Employee’s status, authority or responsibility (e.g., the Company has determined that a change in the department or functional group over which the Employee has managerial authority would constitute such a material adverse change); (B) a material adverse change in the position to whom the Employee reports (including any requirement that the Employee report to a corporate officer or employee instead of reporting directly to the CEO) or to the Employee’s service relationship (or the conditions under which the Employee performs his duties) as a result of such reporting structure change, or a material diminution in the authority, duties or responsibilities of the position to whom the Employee reports; (C) a material diminution in the budget over which the Employee has managing authority; or (D) a material change in the geographic location of the Employee’s principal place of employment (e.g., the Company has determined that a relocation of more than thirty-five (35) miles would constitute such a material change); or

4


 

  (iv)   a material breach by the Company of any of its obligations under this Agreement.
Notwithstanding the foregoing, the Employee being placed on a paid leave for up to sixty (60) days pending a determination of whether there is a basis to terminate the Employee for Cause shall not constitute Good Reason. The Employee’s continued employment shall not constitute consent to, or a waiver of rights with respect to, any act or failure to act constituting Good Reason hereunder; provided, however, that no such event described above shall constitute Good Reason unless: (1) the Employee gives Notice of Termination to the Company specifying the condition or event relied upon for such termination either: (x) within ninety (90) days of the initial existence of such event; or (y) in the case of an event predating a Change in Control, within ninety (90) days of the Change in Control; and (2) the Company fails to cure the condition or event constituting Good Reason within thirty (30) days following receipt of the Employee’s Notice of Termination.
     9. Obligations of the Company Upon Termination.
  (a)   Termination by the Company for a Reason Other than Cause, Death or Disability and Termination by the Employee for Good Reason. If the Employee’s employment is terminated by: (1) the Company for any reason other than Cause, Death or Disability; or (2) the Employee for Good Reason:
   (i)   the Company shall pay the Employee the following (collectively, the “Accrued Obligations”): (A) within five (5) business days after the Date of Termination, any earned but unpaid Annual Base Salary; (B) within a reasonable time following submission of all applicable documentation, any expense reimbursement payments owed to the Employee for expenses incurred prior to the Date of Termination; and (C) no later than March 15th of the year in which the Date of Termination occurs, any earned but unpaid Annual Bonus payments relating to the prior calendar year;
 
   (ii)   the Company shall pay the Employee no later than March 15th of the calendar year following the year in which the Date of Termination occurs, a prorated Annual Bonus based upon the actual Annual Bonus that would have been earned by the Employee for the year in which the Date of Termination occurs (based upon the target Annual Bonus Opportunity in the year in which the Date of Termination occurred, or the prior year if no target Annual Bonus Opportunity has yet been determined, and the actual satisfaction of the applicable performance measures, but ignoring any requirement under the Annual Bonus plan that the Employee must be employed on the payment date) multiplied by the percentage of the calendar year completed before the Date of Termination;
 
   (iii)   the Company shall pay the Employee, no later than the sixty-fifth (65th) calendar day after the Date of Termination, a lump-sum payment equal to 200% of the sum of: (A) the Employee’s Annual Base Salary in effect immediately prior to the Date of Termination (disregarding any reduction

5


 

      in Annual Base Salary to which the Employee did not expressly consent in writing); and (B) the highest Annual Bonus paid to the Employee by the Company within the three (3) years preceding his termination of employment or, if higher, the target Annual Bonus Opportunity in the year in which the Date of Termination occurs;
 
  (iv)   all stock option, restricted stock and other equity-based incentive awards granted by the Company that were outstanding but not vested as of the Date of Termination shall become immediately vested and/or payable, as the case may be, unless the equity incentive awards are based upon satisfaction of performance criteria (not based solely on the passage of time); in which case, they will only vest pursuant to their express terms; and
 
  (v)   the Company shall provide the Employee with certain continued welfare benefits as follows:
  (A)   Any life insurance coverage provided by the Company shall terminate at the same time as life insurance coverage would normally terminate for any other employee that terminates employment with the Company, and the Employee shall have the right to convert that life insurance coverage to an individual policy under the regular rules of the Company’s group policy. In addition, if the Employee is covered under or receives life insurance coverage provided by the Company on the Date of Termination, then within thirty (30) business days after the Date of Termination, the Company shall pay the Employee a lump sum cash payment equal to thirty-six (36) monthly life insurance premiums based on the monthly premiums that would be due assuming that the Employee had converted his Company life insurance coverage that was in effect on the Notice of Termination into an individual policy.
 
  (B)   As long as the Employee pays the full monthly premiums for COBRA coverage, the Company shall provide the Employee and, as applicable, the Employee’s eligible dependents with continued medical and dental coverage, on the same basis as provided to the Company’s active executives and their dependents until the earlier of: (i) three (3) years after the Date of Termination; or (ii) the date the Employee is first eligible for medical and dental coverage (without pre-existing condition limitations) with a subsequent employer. In addition, within thirty (30) business days after the Date of Termination, the Company shall pay the Employee a lump sum cash payment equal to thirty-six (36) monthly medical and dental COBRA premiums based on the level of coverage in effect for the Employee (e.g., employee only or family coverage) on the Date of Termination.

6


 

  (b)   Termination by the Company for Cause and by the Employee without Good Reason. If the Employee’s employment is terminated (i) by the Company for Cause or (ii) by the Employee without Good Reason, the Company’s only obligation under this Agreement shall be payment of any Accrued Obligations.
 
  (c)   Termination due to Death or Disability. If the Employee’s employment is terminated due to death or Disability, the Company shall pay the Employee (or to the Employee’s estate or personal representative in the case of death), within thirty (30) business days after the Date of Termination: (i) any Accrued Obligations, plus (ii) a prorated Annual Bonus based upon the target Annual Bonus opportunity in the year in which the Date of Termination occurred (or the prior year if no target Annual Bonus Opportunity has yet been determined) multiplied by the percentage of the calendar year completed before the Date of Termination.
 
  (d)   Definition of Change in Control. For purposes of this Agreement, the term “Change in Control” shall mean that the conditions set forth in any one of the following subsections shall have been satisfied:
  (i)   the acquisition, directly or indirectly, by any “person” (within the meaning of Section 3(a)(9) of the Securities and Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “Exchange Act”) and used in Sections 13(d) and 14(d) thereof) of “beneficial ownership” (within the meaning of Rule 13d-3 of the Exchange Act) of securities of the Company possessing more than fifty percent (50%) of the total combined voting power of all outstanding securities of the Company;
 
  (ii)   a merger or consolidation in which the Company is not the surviving entity, except for a transaction in which the holders of the outstanding voting securities of the Company immediately prior to such merger or consolidation hold, in the aggregate, securities possessing more than fifty percent (50%) of the total combined voting power of all outstanding voting securities of the surviving entity immediately after such merger or consolidation;
 
  (iii)   a reverse merger in which the Company is the surviving entity but in which securities possessing more than fifty percent (50%) of the total combined voting power of all outstanding voting securities of the Company are transferred to or acquired by a person or persons different from the persons holding those securities immediately prior to such merger;
 
  (iv)   during any period of two (2) consecutive years during the Employment Term or any extensions thereof, individuals, who, at the beginning of such period, constitute the Board, cease for any reason to constitute at least a majority thereof, unless the election of each director who was not a director at the beginning of such period has been approved in advance by

7


 

      directors representing at least two-thirds of the directors then in office who were directors at the beginning of the period;
 
  (v)   the sale, transfer or other disposition (in one transaction or a series of related transactions) of assets of the Company that have a total fair market value equal to or more than one-third of the total fair market value of all of the assets of the Company immediately prior to such sale, transfer or other disposition, other than a sale, transfer or other disposition to an entity (A) which immediately following such sale, transfer or other disposition owns, directly or indirectly, at least fifty percent (50%) of the Company’s outstanding voting securities or (B) fifty percent (50%) or more of whose outstanding voting securities is immediately following such sale, transfer or other disposition owned, directly or indirectly, by the Company. For purposes of the foregoing clause, the sale of stock of a subsidiary of the Company (or the assets of such subsidiary) shall be treated as a sale of assets of the Company; or
 
  (vi)   the approval by the stockholders of a plan or proposal for the liquidation or dissolution of the Company.
      For purposes of this Agreement, no event or transaction which occurred or occurs as a result of the Contribution and Distribution Agreement dated as of June 13, 2008 by and between the Company and Lender Processing Services, Inc. shall constitute a Change in Control. In addition, the Employee agrees and consents to any conversion or modification of outstanding stock options, restricted stock or other equity-based incentive awards permissible under their corresponding plans (if any) and/or the assignment of this Agreement in connection with that proposed transaction.
(e) Six-Month Delay. To the extent the Employee is a “specified employee,” as defined in Section 409A(a)(2)(B)(i) of the Code and the regulations and other guidance promulgated thereunder and any elections made by the Company in accordance therewith, notwithstanding the timing of payment provided in any other Section of this Agreement, no payment, distribution or benefit under this Agreement that constitutes a distribution of deferred compensation (within the meaning of Treasury Regulation Section 1.409A-1(b)) upon separation from service (within the meaning of Treasury Regulation Section 1.409A-1(h)), after taking into account all available exemptions, that would otherwise be payable during the six (6) month period after separation from service, will be made during such six (6) month period, and any such payment, distribution or benefit will instead be paid on the first business day after such six (6) month period.
     10. Excise Tax Gross-up Payments.
   (a)   If any payments or benefits paid or provided or to be paid or provided to the Employee or for his benefit pursuant to the terms of this Agreement or otherwise in connection with, or arising out of, his employment with the Company or its subsidiaries or the termination thereof (a “Payment” and, collectively, the

8


 

      “Payments”) would be subject to the excise tax (the “Excise Tax”) imposed by Section 4999 of the Code, then, except as otherwise provided in this Subsection 10(a), the Employee will be entitled to receive an additional payment (a “Gross-Up Payment”) in an amount such that, after payment by the Employee of all income taxes, all employment taxes and any Excise Tax imposed upon the Gross-Up Payment (including any related interest and penalties), the Employee retains an amount of the Gross-Up Payment equal to the Excise Tax (including any related interest and penalties) imposed upon the Payments. Notwithstanding the foregoing, if the amount of the Payments does not exceed by more than three percent (3%) the amount that would be payable to the Employee if the Payments were reduced to one dollar less than what would constitute a “parachute payment” under Section 280G of the Code (the “Scaled Back Amount”), then the Payments shall be reduced, in a manner determined by the Employee, to the Scaled Back Amount, and the Employee shall not be entitled to any Gross-Up Payment.
 
  (b)   An initial determination of (i) whether a Gross-Up Payment is required pursuant to this Agreement, and, if applicable, the amount of such Gross-Up Payment or (ii) whether the Payments must be reduced to the Scaled Back Amount and, if so, the amount of such reduction, will be made at the Company’s expense by an accounting firm selected by the Company. The accounting firm will provide its determination, together with detailed supporting calculations and documentation, to the Company and the Employee within ten (10) business days after the date of termination of the Employee’s employment, or such other time as may be reasonably requested by the Company or the Employee. If the accounting firm determines that no Excise Tax is payable by the Employee with respect to a Payment or Payments, it will furnish the Employee with an opinion to that effect. If a Gross-Up Payment becomes payable, such Gross-Up Payment will be paid by the Company to the Employee within thirty (30) business days of the receipt of the accounting firm’s determination. If a reduction in Payments is required, such reduction shall be effectuated within thirty (30) business days of the receipt of the accounting firm’s determination. Within ten (10) business days after the accounting firm delivers its determination to the Employee, the Employee will have the right to dispute the determination. The existence of a dispute will not in any way affect the Employee’s right to receive a Gross-Up Payment in accordance with the determination. If there is no dispute, the determination will be binding, final, and conclusive upon the Company and the Employee. If there is a dispute, the Company and the Employee will together select a second accounting firm, which will review the determination and the Employee’s basis for the dispute and then will render its own determination, which will be binding, final, and conclusive on the Company and on the Employee for purposes of determining whether a Gross-Up Payment is required pursuant to this Subsection 10(b) or whether a reduction to the Scaled Back Amount is required, as the case may be. If as a result of any dispute pursuant to this Subsection 10(b) a Gross-Up Payment is made or additional Gross-Up Payments are made, such Gross-Up Payment(s) will be paid by the Company to the Employee within thirty (30) business days of the receipt of the second accounting firm’s determination. The Company will bear all costs associated with the second accounting firm’s determination, unless such

9


 

      determination does not result in additional Gross-Up Payments to the Employee or unless such determination does not mitigate the reduction in Payments required to arrive at the Scaled Back Amount, in which case all such costs will be borne by the Employee.
 
  (c)   For purposes of determining the amount of the Gross-Up Payment and, if applicable, the Scaled Back Amount, the Employee will be deemed to pay federal income taxes at the highest marginal rate of federal income taxation in the calendar year in which the Gross-Up Payment is to be made or the Scaled Back Amount is determined, as the case may be, and applicable state and local income taxes at the highest marginal rate of taxation in the state and locality of the Employee’s residence on the date of termination of the Employee’s employment, net of the maximum reduction in federal income taxes that would be obtained from deduction of those state and local taxes.
 
  (d)   As a result of the uncertainty in the application of Section 4999 of the Code, it is possible that Gross-Up Payments which will not have been made by the Company should have been made, the Employee’s Payments will be reduced to the Scaled Back Amount when they should not have been or the Employee’s Payments are reduced to a greater extent than they should have been (an “Underpayment”) or Gross-Up Payments are made by the Company which should not have been made, the Employee’s Payments are not reduced to the Scaled Back Amount when they should have been or they are not reduced to the extent they should have been (an “Overpayment”). If it is determined that an Underpayment has occurred, the accounting firm shall determine the amount of the Underpayment that has occurred and any such Underpayment (together with interest at the rate provided in Section 1274(b)(2)(B) of the Code) shall be promptly paid by the Company to or for the benefit of the Employee. If it is determined that an Overpayment has occurred, the accounting firm shall determine the amount of the Overpayment that has occurred and any such Overpayment (together with interest at the rate provided in Section 1274(b)(2) of the Code) shall be promptly paid by the Employee (to the extent he has received a refund if the applicable Excise Tax has been paid to the Internal Revenue Service) to or for the benefit of the Company; provided, however, that if the Company determines that such repayment obligation would be or result in an unlawful extension of credit under Section 13(k) of the Exchange Act, repayment shall not be required. The Employee shall cooperate, to the extent his expenses are reimbursed by the Company, with any reasonable requests by the Company in connection with any contest or disputes with the Internal Revenue Service in connection with the Excise Tax.
 
  (e)   The Employee shall notify the Company in writing of any claim by the Internal Revenue Service that, if successful, would require a payment resulting in an Underpayment. Such notification shall be given as soon as practicable but no later than ten (10) business days after the Employee is informed in writing of such claim and shall apprise the Company of the nature of such claim and the date on which such claim is requested to be paid. The Employee shall not pay such claim prior to the expiration of the thirty (30) day period following the date on which he

10


 

      gives such notice to the Company (or such shorter period ending on the date that any payment of taxes with respect to such claim is due). If the Company notifies the Employee in writing prior to the expiration of such period that it desires to contest such claim, the Employee shall:
  (i)   give the Company any information reasonably requested by the Company relating to such claim,
 
  (ii)   take such action in connection with contesting such claim as the Company shall reasonably request in writing from time to time, including, without limitation, accepting legal representation with respect to such claim by an attorney reasonably selected by the Company,
 
  (iii)   cooperate with the Company in good faith in order to effectively contest such claim, and
 
  (iv)   permit the Company to participate in any proceeding relating to such claim;
      provided, however, that the Company shall bear and pay directly all costs and expenses (including additional interest and penalties) incurred in connection with such contest and shall indemnify and hold the Employee harmless, on an after-tax basis, for any Excise Tax or income tax (including related interest and penalties) imposed as a result of such representation and payment of costs and expenses. Without limitation on the foregoing provisions of this Subsection 10(e), the Company shall control all proceedings taken in connection with such contest and, at its sole option, may pursue or forgo any and all administrative appeals, proceedings, hearings and conferences with the taxing authority in respect of such claim and may, at its sole option, either direct the Employee to pay the tax claimed and sue for a refund or contest the claim in any permissible manner, and the Employee agrees to prosecute such contest to a determination before any administrative tribunal, in a court of initial jurisdiction and in one or more appellate courts, as the Company shall determine; provided, however, that if the Company directs the Employee to pay such claim and sue for a refund, the Company shall advance the amount of such payment to the Employee, on an interest-free basis and shall indemnify and hold the Employee harmless, on an after-tax basis, from any Excise Tax or income tax (including related interest or penalties) imposed with respect to such advance or with respect to any imputed income with respect to such advance. The Company’s control of the contest shall be limited to issues that may impact Gross-Up Payments or reduction in Payments under this Section 10, and the Employee shall be entitled to settle or contest, as the case may be, any other issue raised by the Internal Revenue Service or any other taxing authority.
 
  (f)   If, after the receipt by the Employee of an amount advanced by the Company pursuant to Subsection 10(e), the Employee becomes entitled to receive any refund with respect to such claim, the Employee shall (subject to the Company’s

11


 

      complying with the requirements of Subsection 10(e)) promptly pay to the Company the amount of such refund (together with any interest paid or credited thereon after taxes applicable thereto). If, after the receipt by the Employee of an amount advanced by the Company pursuant to Subsection 10(e), a determination is made that the Employee shall not be entitled to any refund with respect to such claim and the Company does not notify the Employee in writing of its intent to contest such denial of refund prior to the expiration of thirty (30) days after such determination, then such advance shall be forgiven and shall not be required to be repaid.
 
   (g)   Any payment under this Section 10 must be made by the Company no later than the end of the Employee’s tax year following the Employee’s tax year in which the Employee remits the related tax payments.
     11. Non-Delegation of the Employee’s Rights. The obligations, rights and benefits of the Employee hereunder are personal and may not be delegated, assigned or transferred in any manner whatsoever, nor are such obligations, rights or benefits subject to involuntary alienation, assignment or transfer.
     12. Confidential Information. The Employee acknowledges that he will occupy a position of trust and confidence and will have access to and learn substantial information about the Company and its affiliates and their operations that is confidential or not generally known in the industry including, without limitation, information that relates to purchasing, sales, customers, marketing, and the financial positions and financing arrangements of the Company and its affiliates. The Employee agrees that all such information is proprietary or confidential, or constitutes trade secrets and is the sole property of the Company and/or its affiliates, as the case may be. The Employee will keep confidential, and will not reproduce, copy or disclose to any other person or firm, any such information or any documents or information relating to the Company’s or its affiliates’ methods, processes, customers, accounts, analyses, systems, charts, programs, procedures, correspondence or records, or any other documents used or owned by the Company or any of its affiliates, nor will the Employee advise, discuss with or in any way assist any other person, firm or entity in obtaining or learning about any of the items described in this Section 12. Accordingly, the Employee agrees that during the Employment Term and at all times thereafter he will not disclose, or permit or encourage anyone else to disclose, any such information, nor will he utilize any such information, either alone or with others, outside the scope of his duties and responsibilities with the Company and its affiliates.
     13. Non-Competition.
   (a)   During Employment Term. The Employee agrees that, during the Employment Term, he will devote such business time, attention and energies reasonably necessary to the diligent and faithful performance of the services to the Company and its affiliates, and he will not engage in any way whatsoever, directly or indirectly, in any business that is a direct competitor with the Company’s or its affiliates’ principal business, nor solicit customers, suppliers or employees of the Company or affiliates on behalf of, or in any other manner work for or assist any business which is a direct competitor with the Company’s or its affiliates’

12


 

      principal business. In addition, during the Employment Term, the Employee will undertake no planning for or organization of any business activity competitive with the work he performs as an employee of the Company, and the Employee will not combine or conspire with any other employee of the Company or any other person for the purpose of organizing any such competitive business activity.
 
  (b)   After Employment Term. The parties acknowledge that the Employee will acquire substantial knowledge and information concerning the business of the Company and its affiliates as a result of his employment. The parties further acknowledge that the scope of business in which the Company and its affiliates are engaged as of the Effective Date is national and very competitive and one in which few companies can successfully compete. Competition by the Employee in that business after the Employment Term would severely injure the Company and its affiliates. Accordingly, for a period of one (1) year after the Employee’s employment terminates for any reason whatsoever, except as otherwise stated herein below, the Employee agrees: (i) not to become an employee, consultant, advisor, principal, partner or substantial shareholder of any firm or business that directly competes with the Company or its affiliates in their principal products and markets; and (ii), on behalf of any such competitive firm or business, not to solicit any person or business that was at the time of such termination and remains a customer or prospective customer, a supplier or prospective supplier, or an employee of the Company or an affiliate. Notwithstanding any of the foregoing provisions to the contrary, the Employee shall not be subject to the restrictions set forth in this Subsection 13(b) if: (A) the Employee’s employment is terminated by the Company without Cause; (B) the Employee terminates employment for Good Reason; or (C) the Employee’s employment is terminated as a result of the Company’s unwillingness to extend the Employment Term.
 
  (c)   Exclusion. Working, directly or indirectly, for any of the following entities shall not be considered competitive to the Company or its affiliates for the purpose of this Section 13: (i) Fidelity National Financial, Inc., its affiliates or their successors; (ii) Lender Processing Services, Inc., its affiliates or their successors; or (iii) the Company, its affiliates or their successors if this Agreement is assumed by a third party as contemplated in Section 21.
     14. Return of Company Documents. Upon termination of the Employment Term, the Employee shall return immediately to the Company all records and documents of or pertaining to the Company or its affiliates and shall not make or retain any copy or extract of any such record or document, or any other property of the Company or its affiliates.
     15. Improvements and Inventions. Any and all improvements or inventions that the Employee may make or participate in during the Employment Term, unless wholly unrelated to the business of the Company and its affiliates and not produced within the scope of the Employee’s employment hereunder, shall be the sole and exclusive property of the Company. The Employee shall, whenever requested by the Company, execute and deliver any and all documents that the Company deems appropriate in order to apply for and obtain patents or copyrights in improvements or inventions or in order to assign and/or convey to the Company

13


 

the sole and exclusive right, title and interest in and to such improvements, inventions, patents, copyrights or applications.
     16. Actions. The parties agree and acknowledge that the rights conveyed by this Agreement are of a unique and special nature and that the Company will not have an adequate remedy at law in the event of a failure by the Employee to abide by its terms and conditions, nor will money damages adequately compensate for such injury. Therefore, it is agreed between and hereby acknowledged by the parties that, in the event of a breach by the Employee of any of the obligations of this Agreement, the Company shall have the right, among other rights, to damages sustained thereby and to obtain an injunction or decree of specific performance from any court of competent jurisdiction to restrain or compel the Employee to perform as agreed herein. The Employee hereby acknowledges that obligations under Sections and Subsections 12, 13(b), 14, 15, 16, 17 and 18 shall survive the termination of employment and be binding by their terms at all times subsequent to the termination of employment for the periods specified therein. Nothing herein shall in any way limit or exclude any other right granted by law or equity to the Company.
     17. Release. Notwithstanding any provision herein to the contrary, the Company may require that, prior to payment of any amount or provision of any benefit under Section 9 or payment of any Gross-Up Payment pursuant to Section 10 of this Agreement (other than due to the Employee’s death), the Employee shall have executed a complete release of the Company and its affiliates and related parties in such form as is reasonably required by the Company, and any waiting periods contained in such release shall have expired; provided, however, that such release relates only to the Employee’s employment relationship with the Company. With respect to any release required to receive payments owed pursuant to Section 9, the Company must provide the Employee with the form of release no later than seven (7) days after the Date of Termination and the release must be signed by the Employee and returned to the Company, unchanged, effective and irrevocable, no later than sixty (60) days after the Date of Termination.
     18. No Mitigation. The Company agrees that, if the Employee’s employment hereunder is terminated during the Employment Term, the Employee is not required to seek other employment or to attempt in any way to reduce any amounts payable to the Employee by the Company hereunder. Further, the amount of any payment or benefit provided for hereunder (other than pursuant to Subsection 9(a)(v) hereof) shall not be reduced by any compensation earned by the Employee as the result of employment by another employer, by retirement benefits or otherwise.
     19. Entire Agreement and Amendment. This Agreement embodies the entire agreement and understanding of the parties hereto in respect of the subject matter of this Agreement, and supersedes and replaces all prior agreements, understandings and commitments with respect to such subject matter. This Agreement may be amended only by a written document signed by both parties to this Agreement.
     20. Governing Law. This Agreement shall be governed by, and construed in accordance with, the laws of the State of Florida, excluding any conflicts or choice of law rule or principle that might otherwise refer construction or interpretation of this Agreement to the substantive law of another jurisdiction. Any litigation pertaining to this Agreement shall be adjudicated in courts located in Duval County, Florida.

14


 

     21. Successors. This Agreement may not be assigned by the Employee. In addition to any obligations imposed by law upon any successor to the Company, the Company will require any successor (whether direct or indirect, by purchase, merger, consolidation or otherwise) to all or substantially all of the stock, business and/or assets of the Company, to expressly assume and agree to perform this Agreement in the same manner and to the same extent that the Company would be required to perform it if no such succession had taken place. Failure of the Company to obtain such assumption by a successor shall be a material breach of this Agreement. The Employee agrees and consents to any such assumption by a successor of the Company, as well as any assignment of this Agreement by the Company for that purpose. As used in this Agreement, “Company” shall mean the Company as herein before defined as well as any such successor that expressly assumes this Agreement or otherwise becomes bound by all of its terms and provisions by operation of law. This Agreement shall be binding upon and inure to the benefit of the parties and their permitted successors or assigns.
     22. Counterparts. This Agreement may be executed in counterparts, each of which shall be deemed an original, but all of which together shall constitute one and the same instrument.
     23. Attorneys’ Fees. If any party finds it necessary to employ legal counsel or to bring an action at law or other proceedings against the other party to interpret or enforce any of the terms hereof, the party prevailing in any such action or other proceeding shall be promptly paid by the other party its reasonable legal fees, court costs, litigation expenses, all as determined by the court and not a jury, and such payment shall be made by the non-prevailing party no later than the end of the Employee’s tax year following the Employee’s tax year in which the payment amount becomes known and payable; provided, however, that on or after a Change in Control, and following the Employee’s termination of employment with the Company, if any party finds it necessary to employ legal counsel or to bring an action at law or other proceedings against the other party to interpret or enforce any of the terms hereof, the Company shall pay (on an ongoing basis) to the Employee to the fullest extent permitted by law, all legal fees, court costs and litigation expenses reasonably incurred by the Employee or others on his behalf (such amounts collectively referred to as the “Reimbursed Amounts”); provided, further, that the Employee shall reimburse the Company for the Reimbursed Amounts if it is determined that a majority of the Employee’s claims or defenses were frivolous or without merit. Requests for payment of Reimbursed Amounts, together with all documents required by the Company to substantiate them, must be submitted to the Company no later than ninety (90) days after the expense was incurred. The Reimbursed Amounts shall be paid by the Company within ninety (90) days after receiving the request and all substantiating documents requested from the Employee. The payment of Reimbursed Amounts during the Employee’s tax year will not impact the Reimbursed Amounts for any other taxable year. The rights under this Section 23 shall survive the termination of employment and this Agreement until the expiration of the applicable statute of limitations.
     24. Severability. If any section, subsection or provision hereof is found for any reason whatsoever to be invalid or inoperative, that section, subsection or provision shall be deemed severable and shall not affect the force and validity of any other provision of this Agreement. If any covenant herein is determined by a court to be overly broad thereby making the covenant unenforceable, the parties agree and it is their desire that such court shall substitute

15


 

a reasonable judicially enforceable limitation in place of the offensive part of the covenant and that as so modified the covenant shall be as fully enforceable as if set forth herein by the parties themselves in the modified form. The covenants of the Employee in this Agreement shall each be construed as an agreement independent of any other provision in this Agreement, and the existence of any claim or cause of action of the Employee against the Company, whether predicated on this Agreement or otherwise, shall not constitute a defense to the enforcement by the Company of the covenants in this Agreement.
     25. Notices. Any notice, request, or instruction to be given hereunder shall be in writing and shall be deemed given when personally delivered or three (3) days after being sent by United States Certified Mail, postage prepaid, with Return Receipt Requested, to the parties at their respective addresses set forth below:
To the Company:
Fidelity National Information Services, Inc.
601 Riverside Avenue
Jacksonville, FL 32204
Attention: General Counsel
To the Employee:
Brent B. Bickett
c/o Fidelity National Information Services, Inc.
601 Riverside Avenue
Jacksonville, FL 32204
     26. Waiver of Breach. The waiver by any party of any provisions of this Agreement shall not operate or be construed as a waiver of any prior or subsequent breach by the other party.
     27. Tax Withholding. The Company or an affiliate may deduct from all compensation and benefits payable under this Agreement any taxes or withholdings the Company is required to deduct pursuant to state, federal or local laws.
     28. Code Section 409A. To the extent applicable, it is intended that this Agreement and any payment made hereunder shall comply with the requirements of Section 409A of the Code, and any related regulations or other guidance promulgated with respect to such Section by the U.S. Department of the Treasury or the Internal Revenue Service (“Code Section 409A”). Any provision that would cause the Agreement or any payment hereof to fail to satisfy Code Section 409A shall have no force or effect until amended to comply with Code Section 409A, which amendment may be retroactive to the extent permitted by Code Section 409A. In addition, the direct payment or reimbursement of expenses permitted under this Agreement or otherwise shall be made no later than the last day of the Employee’s taxable year following the taxable year in which such expense was incurred.

16


 

     IN WITNESS WHEREOF the parties have executed this Agreement to be effective as of the date first set forth above.
             
    FIDELITY NATIONAL INFORMATION SERVICES, INC.    
 
           
 
  By:        
 
           
 
  Its:        
 
           
 
           
    BRENT B. BICKETT    
 
 
           
         

17

EX-21.1
Exhibit 21.1
Fidelity National Information Services, Inc.
A Georgia Corporation
List of subsidiaries
As of 12/31/2008
7 significant subsidiaries
         
Company
    Incorporation  
eFunds Corporation
    Delaware  
 
Fidelity Information Services, Inc.
    Arkansas  
 
Fidelity National Card Services, Inc.
    Florida  
 
Fidelity Participacoes e Servicos Ltda.
    Brazil  
 
Total Ages Participacoes
    Brazil  
 
Fidelity Processadora & Servicos, S.A.
    Brazil  
 
Fidelity National Information Services, CV
    Netherlands  

 

EX-23.1
Exhibit 23.1
The Board of Directors
Fidelity National Information Services, Inc.:
We consent to the use of our reports dated February 27, 2009, with respect to the consolidated balance sheets of Fidelity National Information Services, Inc. and subsidiaries as of December 31, 2008 and 2007, and the related consolidated statements of earnings, stockholders’ equity, cash flows, and comprehensive earnings, for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2008 and the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2008, incorporated herein by reference.
As discussed in Notes 1 and 4 to the consolidated financial statements, the Company completed a spin-off of its Lender Processing Services segment on July 2, 2008.
February 27, 2009
Jacksonville, Florida
Certified Public Accountants

 

EX-31.1
Exhibit 31.1
CERTIFICATIONS
I, Lee A. Kennedy, certify that:
1. I have reviewed this annual report on Form 10-K of Fidelity National Information Services, Inc.;
2. Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report;
3. Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;
4. The registrant’s other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the registrant and have:
  a)   designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;
 
  b)   designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;
 
  c)   evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and
 
  d)   disclosed in this report any change in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the registrant’s most recent fiscal quarter (the registrant’s fourth fiscal quarter in the case of an annual report) that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting; and
5. The registrant’s other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the registrant’s auditors and the audit committee of registrant’s board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):
  a)   all significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the registrant’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and
 
  b)   any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting.
Date: February 27, 2009
         
By:
  /s/ LEE A. KENNEDY
 
Lee A. Kennedy
   
 
  President and Chief Executive Officer    

 

EX-31.2
Exhibit 31.2
CERTIFICATIONS
I, George P. Scanlon, certify that:
1. I have reviewed this annual report on Form 10-K of Fidelity National Information Services, Inc.;
2. Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report;
3. Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;
4. The registrant’s other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the registrant and have:
  a)   designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;
 
  b)   designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;
 
  c)   evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and
 
  d)   disclosed in this report any change in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the registrant’s most recent fiscal quarter (the registrant’s fourth fiscal quarter in the case of an annual report) that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting; and
5. The registrant’s other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the registrant’s auditors and the audit committee of registrant’s board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):
  a)   all significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the registrant’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and
 
  b)   any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting.
Date: February 27, 2009
         
By:
  /s/ GEORGE P. SCANLON
 
George P. Scanlon
   
 
  Executive Vice President and    
 
  Chief Financial Officer    

 

EX-32.1
Exhibit 32.1
CERTIFICATION OF PERIODIC FINANCIAL REPORTS PURSUANT TO 18 U.S.C. §1350
     The undersigned hereby certifies that he is the duly appointed and acting Chief Executive Officer of Fidelity National Information Services, Inc., a Georgia corporation (the “Company”), and hereby further certifies as follows.
1.   The periodic report containing financial statements to which this certificate is an exhibit fully complies with the requirements of Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.
 
2.   The information contained in the periodic report to which this certificate is an exhibit fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations of the Company.
     In witness whereof, the undersigned has executed and delivered this certificate as of the date set forth opposite his signature below.
Date: February 27, 2009
         
     
  /s/ LEE A. KENNEDY    
  Lee A. Kennedy   
  Chief Executive Officer   

 

EX-32.2
         
Exhibit 32.2
CERTIFICATION OF PERIODIC FINANCIAL REPORTS PURSUANT TO 18 U.S.C. §1350
     The undersigned hereby certifies that he is the duly appointed and acting Chief Financial Officer of Fidelity National Information Services, Inc., a Georgia corporation (the “Company”), and hereby further certifies as follows.
1.   The periodic report containing financial statements to which this certificate is an exhibit fully complies with the requirements of Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.
 
2.   The information contained in the periodic report to which this certificate is an exhibit fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations of the Company.
     In witness whereof, the undersigned has executed and delivered this certificate as of the date set forth opposite his signature below.
Date: February 27, 2009
         
     
  By:   /s/ GEORGE P. SCANLON    
    George P. Scanlon   
    Chief Financial Officer